1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.98"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
54 .set drivernamemax "64"
60 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
61 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
62 . provided in the xfpt library.
63 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
65 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
67 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
69 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
70 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
72 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
73 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
75 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
76 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
77 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
79 . --- Also one for multiple option def headings be grouped in a single
80 . --- table (but without the split capability).
83 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
87 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
98 .orow "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .orow "$+1" "$+2" "$+3" "$+4"
113 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
114 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
115 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
117 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
118 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
122 . --- A macro for a plain variable, including the .vitem and .vindex
128 . --- A macro for a "tainted" marker, done as a one-element table
130 .itable none 0 0 1 10pt left
135 . --- A macro for a tainted variable, adding a taint-marker
141 . --- A macro for a cmdline option, including a .oindex
142 . --- 1st arg is the option name, undecorated (we do that here).
143 . --- 2nd arg, optional, text (decorated as needed) to be appended to the name
145 .vitem &%$1%&$=2+&~$2+
149 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
150 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
151 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
155 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
159 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
167 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
168 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
169 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
170 . --- ID that ties them together.
171 . --- The index entry points to the most-recent chapter head, section or subsection
172 . --- head, or list-item.
175 &<indexterm role="concept">&
176 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
178 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
184 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
185 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
187 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
193 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
197 &<indexterm role="option">&
198 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
200 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
205 . --- The index entry points to the most-recent chapter head, section or subsection
206 . --- head, or varlist item.
209 &<indexterm role="variable">&
210 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
212 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
218 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
222 . use this for a concept-index entry for a header line
224 .cindex "&'$1'& header line"
225 .cindex "header lines" $1
227 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
230 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
231 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
233 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
237 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
238 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
242 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
243 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
244 <revhistory><revision>
246 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
247 </revision></revhistory>
250 </year><holder>The Exim Maintainers</holder></copyright>
255 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
256 . These implement index entries of the form "x, see y" and "x, see also y".
257 . However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
258 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
259 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
261 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
265 <indexterm role="$2">
266 <primary>$3</primary>
268 <secondary>$5</secondary>
270 <$1><emphasis>$4</emphasis></$1>
275 . NB: for the 4-arg variant the ordering is awkward
277 .seeother see "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
280 .seeother seealso "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
283 .see variable "<emphasis>$1</emphasis>, <emphasis>$2</emphasis>, etc." "numerical variables"
284 .see concept address rewriting rewriting
285 .see concept "Bounce Address Tag Validation" BATV
286 .see concept "Client SMTP Authorization" CSA
287 .see concept "CR character" "carriage return"
288 .see concept CRL "certificate revocation list"
289 .seealso concept de-tainting "tainted data"
290 .see concept delivery "bounce message" "failure report"
291 .see concept dialup "intermittently connected hosts"
292 .see concept exiscan "content scanning"
293 .see concept fallover fallback
294 .see concept filter "Sieve filter" Sieve
295 .see concept headers "header lines"
296 .see concept ident "RFC 1413"
297 .see concept "LF character" "linefeed"
298 .seealso concept maximum limit
299 .see concept monitor "Exim monitor"
300 .see concept "no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis>" "entry for xxx"
301 .see concept NUL "binary zero"
302 .see concept "passwd file" "/etc/passwd"
303 .see concept "process id" pid
304 .see concept RBL "DNS list"
305 .see concept redirection "address redirection"
306 .see concept "return path" "envelope sender"
307 .see concept scanning "content scanning"
309 .see concept string expansion expansion
310 .see concept "top bit" "8-bit characters"
311 .see concept variables "expansion, variables"
312 .see concept "zero, binary" "binary zero"
315 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
316 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
317 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
318 . chapter "Introduction"
319 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
321 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
322 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
323 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
324 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
326 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
327 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
328 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
329 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
330 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
331 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
332 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
334 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
335 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
336 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
338 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
339 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
340 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
342 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
343 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
344 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
345 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
346 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
348 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
349 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
350 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
351 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
352 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
354 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
355 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
356 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
357 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
361 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
362 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
365 .cindex "documentation"
366 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
367 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
368 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
369 capable of showing a change indicator.
372 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
373 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
374 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
375 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
376 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
377 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
378 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
381 .cindex "books about Exim"
382 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
383 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
384 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
385 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
387 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
388 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
389 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
390 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
392 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
393 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
394 Debian-specific features in the file
395 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
396 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
399 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
400 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
402 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
403 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
404 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
405 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
406 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
408 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
409 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
410 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
411 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
413 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
414 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
416 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
417 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
418 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
422 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
423 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
424 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
425 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
426 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
427 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
428 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
429 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
432 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
433 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
434 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
438 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
441 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
442 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
443 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
447 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
448 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
449 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
450 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
451 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
452 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
453 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
456 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
457 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
458 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
459 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
462 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
463 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
464 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
467 .row &'exim-announce@lists.exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
468 .row &'exim-users@lists.exim.org'& "General discussion list"
469 .row &'exim-users-de@lists.exim.org'& "General discussion list in German language"
470 .row &'exim-dev@lists.exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
471 .row &'exim-cvs@lists.exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
474 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
475 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
476 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
477 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
478 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
481 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
483 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
486 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
487 .cindex "bug reports"
488 .cindex "reporting bugs"
489 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
490 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
491 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
492 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
496 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
498 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
499 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
500 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
501 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
503 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
505 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
506 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
508 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
509 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
510 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
512 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
513 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
514 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
515 here are top-level directories.
517 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
518 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
520 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
521 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
522 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
523 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
527 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
529 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
530 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
531 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
532 most portable to old systems.
534 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
535 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
536 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
537 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
538 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
539 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
540 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
541 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
542 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
543 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
544 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
546 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
547 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
548 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
549 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
551 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
553 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
554 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
555 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
557 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
558 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
559 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
561 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
562 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
563 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
564 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
566 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
567 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
568 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
569 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
571 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
572 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
575 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
577 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
578 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
579 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
580 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
581 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
582 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
583 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
585 .cindex "domainless addresses"
586 .cindex "address" "without domain"
587 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
588 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
589 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
590 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
593 .cindex "transport" "external"
594 .cindex "external transports"
595 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
596 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
597 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
598 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
599 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
600 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
602 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
603 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
604 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
607 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
608 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
609 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
610 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
611 a number of common scanners are provided.
615 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
616 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
617 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
618 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
619 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
620 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
623 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
624 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
625 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
626 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
627 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
628 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
629 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
630 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
631 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
632 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
633 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
634 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
636 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
637 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
638 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
639 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
643 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
644 .cindex "terminology definitions"
645 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
646 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
647 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
648 below) by a blank line.
650 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
651 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
652 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
653 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
654 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
655 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
656 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
657 rise to further bounce messages.
659 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
660 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
661 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
664 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
665 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
666 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
669 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
670 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
671 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
673 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
674 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
675 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
676 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
677 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
678 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
679 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
680 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
682 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
683 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
684 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
685 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
686 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
687 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
690 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
691 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
692 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
693 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
694 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
696 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
697 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
698 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
699 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
700 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
701 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
703 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
704 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
707 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
708 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
709 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
710 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
711 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
713 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
714 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
715 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
716 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
717 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
719 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
720 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
721 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
722 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
723 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
724 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
731 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
732 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
734 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
735 .cindex "incorporated code"
736 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
739 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
742 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
743 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE2 library, copyright
744 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE2 is not longer shipped with
745 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE2 shipped with your system,
746 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
747 &url(https://github.com/PhilipHazel/pcre2/releases).
749 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
750 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
751 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
752 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
753 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
754 following statements:
757 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
759 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
760 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
761 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
763 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
764 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
765 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
766 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
767 restrictions applied to it).
770 .cindex "SPA authentication"
771 .cindex "Samba project"
772 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
773 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
774 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
775 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
779 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
780 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
781 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
782 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
783 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
784 conditions expressed therein.
787 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
789 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
790 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
794 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
795 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
797 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
798 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
799 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
802 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
803 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
804 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
805 details, please contact
807 Office of Technology Transfer
808 Carnegie Mellon University
810 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
811 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
812 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
815 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
818 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
819 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
821 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
822 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
823 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
824 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
825 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
826 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
827 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
832 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
835 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
836 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
837 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
838 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
841 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
842 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
846 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
847 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
848 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
849 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
850 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
851 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
852 software without specific, written prior permission.
854 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
855 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
856 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
857 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
858 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
859 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
864 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
865 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
866 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
867 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
868 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
872 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
873 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
874 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
881 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
882 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
884 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
885 "Receiving and delivering mail"
888 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
889 .cindex "design philosophy"
890 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
891 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
892 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
893 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
894 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
895 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
898 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
899 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
900 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
901 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
902 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
903 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
904 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
907 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
908 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
909 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
910 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
911 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
912 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
913 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
914 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
915 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
918 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
919 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
921 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
922 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
923 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
924 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
926 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
927 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
928 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
929 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
930 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
932 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
933 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
934 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
936 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
937 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
938 runs at the start of every delivery process.
943 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
944 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
945 .cindex "Sieve filter"
946 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
947 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
948 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
949 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
950 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
951 of filtering are available:
954 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
957 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
958 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
961 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
965 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
966 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
967 .cindex "format" "of message id"
968 .cindex "id of message"
973 .cindex "exim_msgdate"
974 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is 23
975 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
976 example &`16VDhn-000000001bo-D342`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
977 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
978 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
979 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
980 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
981 not always case-sensitive.
983 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
984 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
985 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
986 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
987 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
988 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
992 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
993 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
994 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
995 way of representing the date and time of day).
997 After the first hyphen, the next
999 characters are the id of the process that received the message.
1001 There are two different possibilities for the final four characters:
1003 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1004 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1005 time of reception, normally in units of
1008 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1009 systems), the units are
1012 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by
1013 500000 (250000) and added to
1014 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 2 us (4 us).
1018 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1019 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1020 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1021 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1022 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1024 The exim_msgdate utility (see section &<<SECTexim_msgdate>>&) can be
1025 used to display the date, and optionally the process id, of an Exim
1029 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1030 .cindex "receiving mail"
1031 .cindex "message" "reception"
1032 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1033 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1034 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1035 there are several possibilities:
1038 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1039 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1040 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1042 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1043 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1044 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1045 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1046 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1047 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1049 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1050 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1051 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1052 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1053 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1055 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1056 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1057 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1058 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1062 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1063 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1064 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1065 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1066 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1067 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1068 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1069 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1070 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1071 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1072 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1073 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1074 users to change sender addresses.
1076 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1077 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1078 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1079 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1080 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1081 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1082 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1084 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1085 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1086 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1087 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1088 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1089 message is received.
1095 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1096 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1097 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1098 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1099 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1100 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1101 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1102 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1104 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1105 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1106 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1107 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1108 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1109 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1110 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1111 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1112 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1113 affect file system performance.
1115 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1116 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1117 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1118 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1119 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1121 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1122 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1123 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1124 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1125 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1126 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1127 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1128 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1129 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1130 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1131 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1132 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1136 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1137 .cindex "message" "life of"
1138 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1139 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1140 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1141 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1142 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1143 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1144 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1146 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1147 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1148 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1149 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1150 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1153 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1154 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1155 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1156 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1157 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1159 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1160 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1161 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1162 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1163 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1164 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1165 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1166 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1167 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1168 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1171 .cindex "journal file"
1172 .cindex "file" "journal"
1173 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1174 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1175 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1176 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1177 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1178 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1179 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1180 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1182 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1183 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1184 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1185 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1186 deliveries caused by crashes.
1190 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1191 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1193 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1194 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1195 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1196 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1197 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1198 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1200 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1201 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1202 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1203 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1204 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1205 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1206 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1207 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1208 the driver's features in general.
1210 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1211 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1212 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1213 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1216 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1217 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1218 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1219 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1220 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1221 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1223 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1224 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1225 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1226 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1227 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1228 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1230 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1231 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1232 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1235 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1236 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1237 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1238 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1239 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1240 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1241 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1242 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1243 configured to fail the address.
1245 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1246 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1247 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1248 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1249 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1250 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1252 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1253 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1254 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1255 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1256 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1257 the address is bounced.
1261 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1262 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1263 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1264 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1265 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1266 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1267 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1268 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1270 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1271 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1272 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1273 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1274 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1275 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1276 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1277 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1282 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1283 .cindex "router" "running details"
1284 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1285 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1286 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1287 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1288 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1289 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1293 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1294 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1295 original address ceases
1296 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1297 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1298 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1299 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1300 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1303 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1304 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1305 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1306 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1307 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1309 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1310 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1311 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1312 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1313 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1315 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1316 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1317 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1318 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1319 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1321 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1322 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1323 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1325 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1326 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1327 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1328 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1330 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1331 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1334 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1335 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1336 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1337 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1338 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1340 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1341 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1342 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1343 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1344 facility for this purpose.
1347 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1348 .cindex "case of local parts"
1349 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1350 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1351 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1352 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1353 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1354 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1355 routed addresses are shown.
1359 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1360 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1361 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1362 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1363 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1364 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1367 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1368 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1369 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1370 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1371 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1372 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1373 of any other conditions.
1375 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1376 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1377 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1379 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1380 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1381 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1382 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1383 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1385 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1386 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1387 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1388 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1389 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1391 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1392 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1393 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1395 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1396 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1399 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1400 of domains that it defines.
1401 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
1402 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router domains option"
1403 A match verifies the variable &$domain$& (which carries tainted data)
1404 and assigns an untainted value to the &$domain_data$& variable.
1405 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1406 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1407 refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&.
1409 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1410 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1413 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1414 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
1415 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1416 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1417 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
1418 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1419 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1420 the set of local parts that it defines.
1421 A match verifies the variable &$local_part$& (which carries tainted data)
1422 and assigns an untainted value to the &$local_part_data$& variable.
1423 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1424 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1425 refer to section &<<SECTlocparlis>>&.
1427 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1428 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1430 If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1431 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1432 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1433 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1434 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&,
1435 &$local_part_prefix_v$&, &$local_part_suffix$&
1436 and &$local_part_suffix_v$& as necessary.
1439 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1440 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1442 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1443 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1444 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1445 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1446 remaining preconditions.
1449 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1450 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1451 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1452 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1453 could lead to confusion.
1456 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1457 set of addresses that it defines.
1460 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1461 specified files is tested.
1464 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1465 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1466 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1467 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1469 Note that while using
1470 this option for address matching technically works,
1471 it does not set any de-tainted values.
1472 Such values are often needed, either for router-specific options or
1473 for transport options.
1474 Using the &%domains%& and &%local_parts%& options is usually the most
1475 convenient way to obtain them.
1479 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1480 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1481 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1482 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1483 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1484 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1485 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1489 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1490 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1491 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1494 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1495 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1496 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1497 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1498 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1500 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1501 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1503 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1504 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1505 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1506 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1507 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1508 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1511 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1512 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1513 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1514 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1515 processed entirely independently of each other.
1517 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1518 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1519 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1520 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1521 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1522 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1523 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1524 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1525 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1527 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1528 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1529 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1530 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1531 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1532 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1533 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1534 addresses to the same domain.
1536 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1537 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1538 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1539 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1540 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1541 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1542 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1543 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1545 .cindex "queue runner"
1546 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1547 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1548 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1549 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1550 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1551 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1552 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1553 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1554 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1556 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1557 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1558 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1559 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1560 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1561 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1563 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1564 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1565 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1566 messages to other addresses.
1568 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1569 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1570 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1573 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1574 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1575 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1581 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1582 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1583 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1584 .cindex "queue runner"
1585 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1586 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1587 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1588 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1589 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1590 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1591 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1592 passed its retry time.
1593 You can run several queue runners at once.
1595 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1596 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1597 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1598 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1599 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1604 .subsection "Temporary delivery failure" SECID20
1605 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1606 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1607 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1608 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1609 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1610 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1611 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1612 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1615 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1616 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1617 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1619 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1620 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1621 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1622 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1623 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1628 .subsection "Permanent delivery failure" SECID21
1629 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1630 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1631 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1632 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1633 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1634 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1635 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1636 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1637 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1638 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1640 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1641 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1642 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1645 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1646 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1647 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1648 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1649 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1650 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1651 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1656 .subsection "Failures to deliver bounce messages" SECID22
1657 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1658 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1659 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1660 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1661 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1662 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1663 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1669 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1670 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1672 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1673 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1675 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1676 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1677 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1678 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1681 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1682 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1684 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1685 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1686 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1687 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1691 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1692 following subdirectories are created:
1695 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1696 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1697 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1698 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1699 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1700 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1701 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1704 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1705 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1706 that may be useful to some sites.
1709 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1710 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1711 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1712 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1713 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1714 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1716 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1717 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1718 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1719 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1720 overridden if necessary.
1721 .cindex compiler requirements
1722 .cindex compiler version
1723 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1726 .section "PCRE2 library" "SECTpcre"
1727 .cindex "PCRE2 library"
1728 Exim no longer has an embedded regular-expression library as the vast majority of
1729 modern systems include PCRE2 as a system library, although you may need to
1730 install the PCRE2 package or the PCRE2 development package for your operating
1731 system. If your system has a normal PCRE2 installation the Exim build
1732 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1733 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE2_LIBS
1734 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1735 or set PCRE2_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1736 If your operating system has no
1737 PCRE2 support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE2
1738 from &url(https://github.com/PhilipHazel/pcre2/releases).
1739 More information on PCRE2 is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1741 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1742 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1743 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1744 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1745 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1746 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1747 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1749 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1750 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1751 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1752 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1753 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1754 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1755 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1756 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1758 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1759 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1760 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1761 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1762 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1763 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1764 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1765 Berkeley DB library.
1768 Ownership of the Berkeley DB library has moved to a major corporation;
1769 development seems to have stalled and documentation is not freely available.
1770 This is probably not tenable for the long term use by Exim.
1773 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1774 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1778 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1779 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1781 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1782 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1783 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1784 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1785 filename is used unmodified.
1787 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1788 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1789 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1790 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1792 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1793 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1794 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1796 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1797 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1798 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while,
1799 but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 5.&'x'&.
1800 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased,
1801 and Exim no longer supports versions before 3.&'x'&.
1802 All versions of Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1803 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1804 page with far newer versions listed.
1805 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1806 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1807 suited to Exim's usage model.
1809 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1810 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1811 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1812 operates on a single file.
1814 It is possible to use sqlite3 (&url(https://www.sqlite.org/index.html))
1815 for the DBM library.
1819 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1820 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1821 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1822 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1823 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1827 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, for tdb you set USE_TDB,
1828 and for sqlite3 you set USE_SQLITE.
1829 An error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1830 You can set USE_NDBM if needed to override an operating system default.
1832 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1833 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1834 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1835 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1836 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1837 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1839 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1840 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1841 in one of these lines:
1846 DBMLIB = -lgdbm -lgdbm_compat
1848 The last of those was for a Linux having GDBM provide emulated NDBM facilities.
1849 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1850 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1851 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1852 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1855 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1856 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1858 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1859 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1862 When moving from one DBM library to another,
1863 for the hints databases it suffices to just remove all the files in the
1864 directory named &"db/"& under the spool directory.
1865 This is because hints are only for optimisation and will be rebuilt
1866 during normal operations.
1867 Non-hints DBM databases (used by &"dbm"& lookups in the configuration)
1868 will need individual rebuilds for the new DBM library.
1869 This is not done automatically
1874 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1875 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1876 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1877 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1878 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1879 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1880 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1881 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1882 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1883 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1884 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1885 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1887 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1888 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1889 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1890 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1891 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1892 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1894 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1895 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1896 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1897 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1898 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1899 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1902 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1903 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1904 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1905 facilities, you need to set
1907 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1909 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1910 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1913 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1914 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1915 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1916 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1917 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1918 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1919 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1921 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1922 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1923 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1924 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1925 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1930 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1931 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1933 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1934 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1935 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1936 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1937 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1938 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1939 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1941 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1942 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1943 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1944 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1945 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1949 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1953 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1954 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1955 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1956 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1957 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1958 Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1959 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support clients that expect to
1960 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1961 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1964 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1965 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1968 If you do not want TLS support you should set
1972 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1974 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1977 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1979 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1980 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1983 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1984 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1986 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1987 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1990 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1992 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1993 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1996 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1998 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1999 library and include files. For example:
2002 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
2003 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
2005 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
2006 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
2009 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
2012 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
2013 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
2014 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
2019 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
2021 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
2022 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
2023 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
2024 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
2025 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
2026 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
2027 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
2028 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
2029 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
2030 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
2031 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
2032 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
2035 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
2036 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
2037 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
2039 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
2040 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
2042 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
2044 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
2045 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
2046 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
2047 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
2048 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
2049 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
2053 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
2054 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
2055 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
2056 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
2057 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
2058 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
2061 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
2062 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
2063 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
2064 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2065 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2067 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2072 .section "Dynamically loaded module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2073 .cindex "lookup modules"
2074 .cindex "router modules"
2075 .cindex "transport modules"
2076 .cindex "authenticator modules"
2077 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2078 .cindex ".so building"
2079 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2080 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2082 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2083 library dependencies without requiring all systems to install all of those
2085 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2088 Similarly, authenticator, router and transport drivers can be built
2089 as external modules.
2090 This permits a smaller exim binary, growing only as needed for the
2091 runtime cofiguration.
2094 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2095 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2096 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2097 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2098 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2099 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2101 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2102 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2103 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2104 only if each is installed:
2112 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2113 .cindex "build directory"
2114 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2115 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2116 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2117 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2118 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2119 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2120 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2122 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2123 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2124 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2125 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2126 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2127 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2128 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2129 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2131 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2132 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2133 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2137 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2138 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2139 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2140 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2141 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2142 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2143 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2147 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2148 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2149 given in addition to the short output.
2153 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2154 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2155 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2156 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2157 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2158 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2159 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2162 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2163 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2165 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2166 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2167 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2168 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2170 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2171 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2172 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2173 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2174 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2175 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2176 and are often not needed.
2178 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2179 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2180 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2181 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2182 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2183 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2184 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2185 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2186 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2189 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2190 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2191 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2192 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2196 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2197 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2198 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2199 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2200 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2201 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2202 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2203 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2204 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2205 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2206 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2207 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2208 containing the lines
2213 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2214 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2216 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2217 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2218 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2221 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2222 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2223 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2224 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2225 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2226 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2227 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2228 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2229 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2230 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2236 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2237 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2238 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2239 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2240 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2241 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2242 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2243 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2246 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2247 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2248 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2249 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2250 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2251 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2252 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2253 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2254 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2255 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2256 syntax. For instance:
2259 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2261 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2262 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2263 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2266 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2267 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2268 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2272 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2273 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2275 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2276 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2277 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2278 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2279 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2280 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2283 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2284 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2286 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2287 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2290 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2291 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2293 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2294 definition of all three of these variables into your
2295 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2298 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2299 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2300 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2301 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2303 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2304 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2305 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2306 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2307 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2310 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2311 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2312 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2313 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2314 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2317 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2319 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2320 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2321 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2322 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2323 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2324 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2328 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2329 .cindex "building Eximon"
2330 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2331 where the files that are involved are
2333 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2334 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2335 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2336 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2337 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2338 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2340 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2341 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2342 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2343 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2344 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2345 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2346 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2350 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2351 .cindex "installing Exim"
2352 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2353 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2354 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2355 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2356 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2357 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2358 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2359 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2360 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2361 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2362 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2363 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2365 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2366 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2367 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2368 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2369 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2370 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2371 alternative files, no default is installed.
2373 .cindex "system aliases file"
2374 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2375 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2376 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2377 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2378 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2379 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2380 and outputs a comment to the user.
2382 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2383 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2384 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2385 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2386 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2388 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2389 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2390 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2391 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2392 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2395 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2396 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2399 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2401 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2402 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2403 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2404 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2405 but this usage is deprecated.
2407 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2408 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2409 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2410 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2411 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2412 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2414 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2415 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2416 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2417 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2418 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2419 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2420 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2422 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2423 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2424 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2427 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2429 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2430 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2431 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2432 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2435 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2437 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2438 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2441 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2442 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2444 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2448 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2450 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2452 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2453 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2454 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2456 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2461 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2462 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2463 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2464 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2465 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2468 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2469 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2470 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2474 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2475 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2476 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2477 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2478 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2484 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2485 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2486 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2487 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2488 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2492 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2493 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2494 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2495 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2496 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2499 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2501 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2503 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2505 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2506 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2507 user agent. For example:
2509 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2510 From: user@your.domain.example
2511 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2512 Subject: Testing Exim
2514 This is a test message.
2517 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2518 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2519 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2521 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2522 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2523 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2524 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2525 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2526 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2528 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2530 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2531 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2532 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2533 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2534 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2536 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2537 .cindex "lock files"
2538 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2539 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2540 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2541 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2542 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2543 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2544 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2545 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2546 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2547 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2548 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2549 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2551 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2552 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2553 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2554 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2555 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2558 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2559 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2560 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2561 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2565 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2566 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2567 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2568 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2569 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2570 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2571 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2572 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2573 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2574 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2575 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2576 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2577 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2579 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2580 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2581 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2582 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2583 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2584 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2587 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2588 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2589 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2590 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2592 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2593 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2594 favourite user agent.
2596 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2597 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2598 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2599 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2600 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2601 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2605 .section "Running the daemon" SECTdaemonLaunch
2606 The most common command line for launching the Exim daemon looks like
2610 This starts a daemon which
2612 listens for incoming smtp connections, launching handler processes for
2615 starts a queue-runner process every five minutes, to inspect queued messages
2616 and run delivery attempts on any that have arrived at their retry time
2618 Should a queue run take longer than the time between queue-runner starts,
2619 they will run in parallel.
2620 Numbers of jobs of the various types are subject to policy controls
2621 defined in the configuration.
2624 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2625 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2626 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2627 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2628 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2629 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2630 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2631 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2632 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2633 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2639 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2640 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2641 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2643 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2645 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2646 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2647 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2648 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2649 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2651 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2653 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2655 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2656 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2657 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2662 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2665 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2666 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2667 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2668 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2669 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2670 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2671 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2672 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2673 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2676 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2678 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2679 were present before any other options.
2680 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2682 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2683 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2684 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2687 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2688 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2689 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2693 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2694 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2695 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2698 .cindex "queue runner"
2699 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2700 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2701 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2703 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2704 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2705 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2706 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2707 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2708 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2709 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2710 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2713 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2714 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2715 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2716 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2717 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2718 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2721 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2722 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2723 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2724 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2725 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2726 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2728 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2729 .cindex "envelope from"
2730 .cindex "envelope sender"
2731 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2732 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2733 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2734 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2735 users to set envelope senders.
2739 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2740 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2741 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2743 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2744 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2745 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2746 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2747 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2748 that are available to trusted users.
2750 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2751 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2752 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2753 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2754 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2756 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2757 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2758 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2759 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2761 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2762 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2763 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2764 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2766 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2767 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2772 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2773 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2774 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2780 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2781 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2782 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2783 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2784 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2785 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2786 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2787 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2789 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2790 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2791 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2792 . creates a man page for the options.
2793 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2796 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2802 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2803 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2804 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2805 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2808 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2809 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2813 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2820 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2823 .cmdopt -B <&'type'&>
2825 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2826 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2827 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2828 clean; it ignores this option.
2832 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2833 .cindex "queue runner"
2834 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2835 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2836 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2838 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2839 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2840 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2841 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2843 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2844 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2845 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2846 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2848 When a listening daemon
2849 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2850 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2851 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2852 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2853 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2854 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2857 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2858 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2859 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2863 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2864 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2865 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2866 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2867 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2868 .cindex reload configuration
2869 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2870 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2871 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2872 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2873 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2874 because these are reread each time they are used.
2876 Either a SIGTERM or a SIGINT signal should be used to cause the daemon
2877 to cleanly shut down.
2878 Subprocesses handling recceiving or delivering messages,
2879 or for scanning the queue,
2880 will not be affected by the termination of the daemon process.
2883 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2884 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2887 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2888 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2889 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2890 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2891 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2892 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2894 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2895 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2896 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2897 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2898 test data. A line history is supported.
2900 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2901 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2902 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2903 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2904 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2905 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2906 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2908 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2909 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2910 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2911 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2913 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2914 defined and macros will be expanded.
2915 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2916 available to admin users.
2918 The word &"set"& at the start of a line, followed by a single space,
2919 is recognised specially as defining a value for a variable.
2920 .cindex "tainted data" "expansion testing"
2921 If the sequence &",t"& is inserted before the space,
2922 the value is marked as tainted.
2923 The syntax is otherwise the same as the ACL modifier &"set ="&.
2925 .cmdopt -bem <&'filename'&>
2926 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2927 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2928 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2929 of a file. For example:
2931 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2933 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2934 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2935 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2936 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2937 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2938 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2939 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2942 .cmdopt -bF <&'filename'&>
2943 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2944 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2945 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2946 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2947 system filters are recognized.
2949 .cmdopt -bf <&'filename'&>
2950 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2951 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2952 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2953 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2954 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2955 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2956 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2957 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2960 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2961 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2962 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2964 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2966 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2967 variables that are used by the user filter.
2969 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2974 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2975 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2976 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2979 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2980 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2981 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2982 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2984 When testing a filter file,
2985 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2986 .cindex "envelope from"
2987 .cindex "envelope sender"
2988 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2989 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2990 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2991 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2992 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2995 .cmdopt -bfd <&'domain'&>
2996 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2997 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2998 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
3001 .cmdopt -bfl <&'local&~part'&>
3002 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
3003 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
3004 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
3005 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
3006 actually being delivered.
3008 .cmdopt -bfp <&'prefix'&>
3009 .cindex affix "filter testing"
3010 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
3011 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
3014 .cmdopt -bfs <&'suffix'&>
3015 .cindex affix "filter testing"
3016 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
3017 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
3020 .cmdopt -bh <&'IP&~address'&>
3021 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
3022 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
3023 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
3024 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
3025 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
3026 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
3027 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
3028 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
3029 after a full stop. For example:
3031 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
3032 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
3034 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
3035 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
3036 conversion to the canonical form is
3037 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
3039 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
3040 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
3041 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
3042 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
3043 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
3047 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
3048 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
3049 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
3052 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
3053 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
3054 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
3056 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
3057 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
3058 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
3059 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
3060 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
3061 session were authenticated.
3063 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
3064 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
3065 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
3067 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
3068 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
3069 specialized SMTP test program such as
3070 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
3072 .cmdopt -bhc <&'IP&~address'&>
3073 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
3074 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
3075 updating the callout cache database.
3078 .cindex "alias file" "building"
3079 .cindex "building alias file"
3080 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
3081 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
3082 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
3083 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
3084 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
3087 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
3088 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3089 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3090 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3091 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3092 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3095 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3097 .cindex "querying exim information"
3098 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3099 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3100 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3101 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3102 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3105 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3106 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3107 recognised DSCP names.
3110 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3111 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3112 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3113 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3114 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3115 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3116 way to guarantee a correct response.
3119 .cindex "local message reception"
3120 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3121 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3122 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3123 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3124 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3125 if no other conflicting option is present.
3127 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3128 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3129 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3130 suppressing this for special cases.
3132 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3133 the non-SMTP ACL. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for details.
3135 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3136 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3137 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3140 .cindex "message" "format"
3141 .cindex "format" "message"
3142 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3143 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3144 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3145 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3146 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3148 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3149 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3151 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3152 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3153 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3154 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3155 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3157 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3158 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3159 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3160 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3161 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3163 .cmdopt -bmalware <&'filename'&>
3164 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3165 .cindex "malware scan test"
3166 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3167 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3168 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3169 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3170 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3171 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3172 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3174 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3175 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3176 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3177 This option requires admin privileges.
3179 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3180 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3181 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3184 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3185 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3186 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3187 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3188 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3189 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3190 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3192 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3193 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3194 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3195 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3196 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3198 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3199 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3200 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3201 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3205 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3206 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3207 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3208 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3209 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3210 arguments, for example:
3212 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3214 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3215 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3216 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3217 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3218 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3219 users, the output is as in this example:
3221 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3223 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3224 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3226 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3227 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3228 backward compatibility.)
3229 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3230 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3232 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3233 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3234 name will not be output.
3236 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3237 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3238 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3239 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3240 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3241 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3242 written directly into the spool directory.
3244 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3246 exim -bP +local_domains
3248 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3249 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3251 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3252 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3253 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3254 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3255 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3256 that driver are output. For example:
3258 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3260 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3261 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3262 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3263 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3264 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3267 .cindex "environment"
3268 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3269 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3272 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3273 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3274 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3275 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3276 The output format is one item per line.
3277 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3278 the exit status will be nonzero.
3281 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3282 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3283 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3284 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3285 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3286 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3287 to allow any user to see the queue.
3289 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3291 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3292 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3295 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3296 .cindex "size" "of message"
3297 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3298 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3299 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3300 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3301 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3302 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3303 before the sender address.
3305 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3306 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3307 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3309 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3310 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3311 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3312 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3313 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3318 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3319 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3320 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3325 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3326 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3327 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3328 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3332 .cindex queue "list of message IDs"
3333 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but only outputs message ids
3338 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3339 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3340 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3341 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3344 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3347 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpi%&.
3350 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3354 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3355 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3356 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3357 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3361 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3362 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3363 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3364 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3365 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3367 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3368 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3370 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3371 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3372 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3373 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3374 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3375 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3376 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3377 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3378 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3380 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3381 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3385 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3386 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3387 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3388 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3389 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3390 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3391 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3394 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3395 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3396 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3397 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3398 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3399 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3400 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3401 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3402 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3404 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3405 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3406 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3408 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3409 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see section &<<SECnonSMTP>>&).
3410 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3411 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3413 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3414 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3415 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3417 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3418 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3419 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3420 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3421 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3423 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3424 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3427 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3428 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3429 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3430 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3431 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3432 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3433 messages to the MTA.
3436 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3437 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3438 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3439 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3440 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3441 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3442 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3446 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3447 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3448 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3449 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3450 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3451 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3452 the listening daemon.
3455 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3456 .cindex "address" "testing"
3457 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3458 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3459 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3460 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3461 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3463 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3464 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3466 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3467 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3470 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3471 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3472 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3473 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3474 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3477 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3478 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3479 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3480 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3482 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3483 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3484 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3485 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3488 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3489 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3491 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3492 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3493 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3494 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3495 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3496 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3500 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3501 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3502 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3503 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3504 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3505 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3507 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3508 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3509 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3510 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3511 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3512 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3513 dynamic testing facilities.
3516 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3517 .cindex "address" "verification"
3518 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3519 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3520 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3521 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3522 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3523 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3525 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3526 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3527 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3529 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3530 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3532 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3533 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3536 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3537 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3538 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3539 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3540 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3542 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3543 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3544 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3545 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3546 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3547 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3550 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3551 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3552 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3555 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3556 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3557 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3558 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3560 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3561 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3562 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3563 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3566 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3567 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3573 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3574 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3575 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3576 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3578 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3579 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3580 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3581 each port only when the first connection is received.
3583 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3584 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3586 .cmdopt -C <&'filelist'&>
3587 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3588 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3589 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3590 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3591 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3592 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3593 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3594 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3595 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3597 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3598 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3599 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3600 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3601 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3602 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3603 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3604 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3605 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3607 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3608 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3609 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3610 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3611 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3612 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3613 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3615 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3616 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3617 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3618 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3619 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3620 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3621 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3623 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3624 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3625 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3628 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3629 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3630 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3631 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3632 specified by this option.
3635 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3637 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3638 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3639 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3640 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3641 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3642 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3644 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3645 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3646 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3647 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3648 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3649 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3650 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3652 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3653 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3654 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3660 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3661 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3664 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3666 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3667 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3670 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3672 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3673 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3674 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3675 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3676 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3677 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3678 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3681 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3682 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3683 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3684 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3685 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3686 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3687 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3689 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
3690 .irow acl "ACL interpretation"
3691 .irow auth "authenticators"
3692 .irow deliver "general delivery logic"
3693 .irow dns "DNS lookups (see also resolver)"
3694 .irow dnsbl "DNS black list (aka RBL) code"
3695 .irow exec "arguments for &[execv()]& calls"
3696 .irow expand "detailed debugging for string expansions"
3697 .irow filter "filter handling"
3698 .irow hints_lookup "hints data lookups"
3699 .irow host_lookup "all types of name-to-IP address handling"
3700 .irow ident "ident lookup"
3701 .irow interface "lists of local interfaces"
3702 .irow lists "matching things in lists"
3703 .irow load "system load checks"
3704 .irow local_scan "can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3705 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)"
3706 .irow lookup "general lookup code and all lookups"
3707 .irow memory "memory handling"
3708 .irow noutf8 "modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing"
3709 .irow pid "modifier: add pid to debug output lines"
3710 .irow process_info "setting info for the process log"
3711 .irow queue_run "queue runs"
3712 .irow receive "general message reception logic"
3713 .irow resolver "turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output"
3714 .irow retry "retry handling"
3715 .irow rewrite "address rewriting""
3716 .irow route "address routing"
3717 .irow timestamp "modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines"
3718 .irow tls "TLS logic"
3719 .irow transport "transports"
3720 .irow uid "changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid"
3721 .irow verify "address verification logic"
3722 .irow all "almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&"
3724 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3725 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3726 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3727 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3728 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3729 turn everything off.
3731 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3732 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3733 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3734 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3735 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3738 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3739 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3740 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3741 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3742 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3745 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3746 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3749 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3750 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3751 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3752 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3753 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3754 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3756 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3757 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3759 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3761 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3762 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3763 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3764 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3767 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3768 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3769 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3772 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3773 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3774 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3775 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3776 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3777 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3778 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3779 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3782 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3783 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3784 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3785 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3786 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3788 .cmdopt -F <&'string'&>
3789 .cindex "sender" "name"
3790 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3791 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3792 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3793 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3794 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3795 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3797 .cmdopt -f <&'address'&>
3798 .cindex "sender" "address"
3799 .cindex "address" "sender"
3800 .cindex "trusted users"
3801 .cindex "envelope from"
3802 .cindex "envelope sender"
3803 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3804 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3805 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3806 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3809 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3810 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3811 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3812 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3815 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3816 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3817 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3818 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3819 examples of shell commands:
3821 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3822 exim -f "" user@domain
3824 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3825 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3828 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3829 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3830 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3831 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3834 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3835 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3836 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3837 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3838 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3839 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3842 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3843 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3845 control = suppress_local_fixups
3847 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3848 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3851 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3854 .cmdopt -h <&'number'&>
3855 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3856 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3857 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3861 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3862 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3863 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3864 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message.
3865 Solaris 2.4 (SunOS 5.4) Sendmail has a similar &%-i%& processing option
3866 &url(https://docs.oracle.com/cd/E19457-01/801-6680-1M/801-6680-1M.pdf),
3867 p. 1M-529), and therefore a &%-oi%& command line option, which both are used
3868 by its &'mailx'& command.
3870 .cmdopt -L <&'tag'&>
3871 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3872 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3873 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3874 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3875 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3876 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3878 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3880 .cmdopt -M <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3881 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3882 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3883 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3884 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3885 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3886 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3887 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3890 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3891 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3892 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3893 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3894 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3895 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3897 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3898 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3899 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3900 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3902 .cmdopt -Mar <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3903 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3904 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3905 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3906 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3907 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3908 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3909 can be used only by an admin user.
3911 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&&&
3913 &~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3914 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3916 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3917 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3918 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3919 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3920 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3921 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3922 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3923 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3926 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3927 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3928 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3931 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3932 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3933 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3936 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3937 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-d%& option
3938 to pass on an information string on the purpose of the process.
3940 .cmdopt -MCG <&'queue&~name'&>
3941 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3942 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3943 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3946 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3947 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3948 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3951 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3952 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3953 which Exim is connected advertised limits on numbers of mails, recipients or
3955 The limits are given by the following three arguments.
3958 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3959 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3960 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3963 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3964 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the connection
3965 t a remote server is via a SOCKS proxy, using addresses and ports given by
3966 the following four arguments.
3968 .cmdopt -MCQ <&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3969 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3970 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3971 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3972 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3973 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3974 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3976 .cmdopt -MCq <&'recipient&~address'&>&~<&'size'&>
3977 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3978 by Exim to implement quota checking for local users.
3981 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3982 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3983 ESMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3987 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3988 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3989 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3991 .vitem &%-MCr%&&~<&'SNI'&> &&&
3995 These options are not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3996 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MCt%& option, and passes on the fact that
3997 a TLS Server Name Indication was sent as part of the channel establishment.
3998 The argument gives the SNI string.
3999 The "r" variant indicates a DANE-verified connection.
4001 .cmdopt -MCt <&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
4002 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4003 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
4004 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
4005 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
4007 .cmdopt -Mc <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4008 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
4009 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
4010 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
4011 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
4012 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
4013 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
4014 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
4015 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
4016 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
4017 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
4018 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
4019 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
4020 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
4022 .cmdopt -Mes <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
4023 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
4024 .cindex "sender" "changing"
4025 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
4026 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
4027 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
4028 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
4029 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
4030 This option can be used only by an admin user.
4032 .cmdopt -Mf <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4033 .cindex "freezing messages"
4034 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
4035 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
4036 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
4037 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
4038 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
4039 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
4042 .cmdopt -Mg <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4043 .cindex "giving up on messages"
4044 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
4045 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
4046 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
4047 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
4048 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
4049 is sent to the sender.
4050 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
4053 .cmdopt -MG <&'queue&~name'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4055 .cindex "named queues" "moving messages"
4056 .cindex "queue" "moving messages"
4057 This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
4058 queue to the given named queue.
4059 The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
4060 string to define the default queue.
4061 If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
4062 a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
4064 .cmdopt -Mmad <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4065 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
4066 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
4067 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
4068 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
4069 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4071 .cmdopt -Mmd <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
4072 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
4073 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
4074 .cindex "removing recipients"
4075 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
4076 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
4077 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
4078 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
4079 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
4080 can be used only by an admin user.
4082 .cmdopt -Mrm <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4083 .cindex "removing messages"
4084 .cindex "abandoning mail"
4085 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4086 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4087 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4088 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4089 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4090 placed in the queue.
4095 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
4096 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4097 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4101 .cmdopt -Mset <&'message&~id'&>
4102 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4103 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4104 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4105 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4106 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4107 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4108 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4109 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4110 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4112 .cmdopt -Mt <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4113 .cindex "thawing messages"
4114 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4115 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4116 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4117 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4118 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4119 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4122 .cmdopt -Mvb <&'message&~id'&>
4123 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4124 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4125 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4126 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4128 .cmdopt -Mvc <&'message&~id'&>
4129 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4130 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4131 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4132 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4133 only by an admin user.
4135 .cmdopt -Mvh <&'message&~id'&>
4136 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4137 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4138 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4139 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4140 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4142 .cmdopt -Mvl <&'message&~id'&>
4143 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4144 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4145 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4146 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4149 This is a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail
4150 (&url(https://docs.oracle.com/cd/E19457-01/801-6680-1M/801-6680-1M.pdf)
4151 p. 1M-258), so Exim treats it that way too.
4154 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4155 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4156 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4157 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4158 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4159 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4160 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4163 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4164 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4165 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4166 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4167 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4168 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4169 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4173 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4174 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4175 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4176 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4178 .cmdopt -O <&'data'&>
4179 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4182 .cmdopt -oA <&'file&~name'&>
4183 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4184 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4185 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4189 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4190 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4191 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4192 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4193 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4194 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4197 .cindex "background delivery"
4198 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4199 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4200 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4201 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4202 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4203 processes to finish.
4205 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4206 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4207 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4208 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4210 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4211 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4212 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4213 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4216 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4217 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4218 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4219 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4220 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4221 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4223 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4224 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4227 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4228 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4230 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4231 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4232 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4233 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4237 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4241 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4242 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4243 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4244 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4245 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4246 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4247 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4248 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4249 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4250 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4254 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4255 .cindex "first pass routing"
4256 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4257 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4258 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4259 configuration file is in effect.
4261 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4262 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4263 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4264 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4265 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4266 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4267 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4268 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4269 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4273 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4274 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4275 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4278 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4280 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4281 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4282 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4283 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4286 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4287 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4288 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4289 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4290 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4293 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4294 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4295 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4296 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4297 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4300 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4301 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4305 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4306 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4310 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4311 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4312 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4313 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4314 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4315 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4318 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4320 .cmdopt -oMa <&'host&~address'&>
4321 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4322 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4323 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4324 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4325 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4326 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4328 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4329 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4331 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4333 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4334 followed by a colon and the port number:
4336 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4338 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4339 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4340 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4341 whichever one is last.
4343 .cmdopt -oMaa <&'name'&>
4344 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4345 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4346 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4347 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4348 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4349 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4351 .cmdopt -oMai <&'string'&>
4352 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4353 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4354 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4355 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4356 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4357 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4359 .cmdopt -oMas <&'address'&>
4360 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4361 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4362 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4363 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4364 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4365 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4366 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4367 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4369 .cmdopt -oMi <&'interface&~address'&>
4370 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4371 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4372 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4373 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4374 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4376 .cmdopt -oMm <&'message&~reference'&>
4377 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4378 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4379 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4380 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4381 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4382 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4383 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4385 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4386 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4387 is sending the bounce.
4389 .cmdopt -oMr <&'protocol&~name'&>
4390 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4391 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4392 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4393 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4394 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4395 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4396 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4397 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4398 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4399 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4401 .cmdopt -oMs <&'host&~name'&>
4402 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4403 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4404 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4405 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4406 uses the name it is given.
4408 .cmdopt -oMt <&'ident&~string'&>
4409 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4410 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4411 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4412 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4413 used, when there is no default.
4416 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4417 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4418 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4419 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4422 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4423 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4424 whatever that means.
4426 .cmdopt -oP <&'path'&>
4427 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4428 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4429 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4430 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4431 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4432 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4433 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4436 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4437 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4438 This option is not intended for general use.
4439 The daemon uses it when terminating due to a SIGTEM, possibly in
4440 combination with &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>.
4441 It causes the pid file to be removed.
4443 .cmdopt -or <&'time'&>
4444 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4445 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4446 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4447 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4448 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4450 .cmdopt -os <&'time'&>
4451 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4452 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4453 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4454 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4455 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4456 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4459 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4461 .cmdopt -oX <&'number&~or&~string'&>
4462 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4463 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4464 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4465 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4466 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4467 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4468 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4469 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4472 .cindex "daemon notifier socket"
4473 This option controls the creation of an inter-process communications endpoint
4475 It is only relevant when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option is also
4477 Normally the daemon creates this socket, unless a &%-oX%& and &*no*& &%-oP%&
4478 option is also present.
4479 If this option is given then the socket will not be created. This is required
4480 if the system is running multiple daemons, in which case it should
4482 The features supported by the socket will not be available in such cases.
4484 The socket is currently used for
4486 fast ramp-up of queue runner processes
4488 caching compiled regexes
4490 obtaining a current queue size
4494 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4495 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4496 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4497 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4501 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4502 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4503 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4504 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4507 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4509 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4511 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4513 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4514 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4515 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4516 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4517 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4518 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4521 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4522 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4523 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4524 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4525 and &%-S%& options).
4527 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4528 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4529 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4530 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4531 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4532 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4533 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4536 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4537 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4538 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4539 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4540 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4543 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4544 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4545 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4546 this to be repeated periodically.
4548 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4549 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4550 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4551 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4553 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4554 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4555 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4557 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4558 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4559 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4560 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4564 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4565 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4566 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4567 .cindex "first pass routing"
4568 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
4569 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4570 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4571 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4574 Performance will be best if the &%queue_run_in_order%& option is false.
4576 the &%queue_fast_ramp%& option is true
4577 and a daemon-notifier socket is available
4578 then in the first phase of the run,
4579 once a threshold number of messages are routed for a given host,
4580 a delivery process is forked in parallel with the rest of the scan.
4582 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4583 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4584 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred.
4586 After the first queue scan complete,
4587 a second, normal queue scan is done, with routing and delivery taking
4589 Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4590 delivered down a single SMTP
4591 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4592 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4593 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4594 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4596 Two-phase queue runs should be used on systems which, even intermittently,
4597 have a large queue (such as mailing-list operators).
4598 They may also be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4601 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4603 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4604 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4605 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4606 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4607 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4609 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4611 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4612 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4613 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4614 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4615 their retry times are tried.
4617 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4619 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4620 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4623 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4625 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4626 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4627 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4630 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4633 .cindex "named queues" "deliver from"
4634 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4635 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4636 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4637 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4638 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4639 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4641 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4642 will specify a queue to operate on.
4645 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4647 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4650 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4651 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4652 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4653 starting message id. For example:
4655 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4657 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4658 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4659 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4661 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4663 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4664 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4665 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4666 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4667 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4668 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4670 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4671 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4672 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4673 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4674 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4675 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4676 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4677 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4678 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4680 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4682 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4683 process every 30 minutes.
4685 .cindex "named queues" "queue runners"
4686 It is possible to set up runners for multiple named queues within one daemon,
4689 exim -qGhipri/2m -q10m -qqGmailinglist/1h
4692 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4693 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4695 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4697 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4700 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4702 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4704 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4706 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4707 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4708 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4709 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4710 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4711 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4712 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4714 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4715 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4716 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4717 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4718 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4719 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4721 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4722 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4724 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4726 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4727 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4728 applied to each queue run.
4730 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4731 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4732 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4733 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4734 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4735 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4736 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4737 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4738 address will be skipped.
4740 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4741 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4742 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4745 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4746 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4747 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&), its default
4748 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4749 an arbitrary command instead.
4752 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4754 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4756 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4757 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4758 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4759 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4760 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4761 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4763 .cmdopt -Tqt <&'times'&>
4764 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4765 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4766 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4769 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4773 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4774 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4775 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4776 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4777 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4779 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4780 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4781 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4782 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4783 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4784 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4785 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4786 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4787 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4788 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4789 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4791 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4792 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4793 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4794 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4795 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4796 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4798 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4799 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4800 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4801 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4802 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4803 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4804 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4805 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4806 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4809 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4810 compatibility with Sendmail.
4812 .cmdopt -tls-on-connect
4813 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4814 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4815 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4816 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4817 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4818 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4822 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4823 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4824 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4825 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4826 set. Exim ignores this option.
4829 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4830 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4831 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4832 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4833 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4834 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4838 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4839 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4840 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4843 .cmdopt -X <&'logfile'&>
4844 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4845 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4847 .cmdopt -z <&'log-line'&>
4848 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4849 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4850 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4858 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4859 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4860 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4861 . creates a man page for the options.
4862 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4865 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4872 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4873 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4876 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4877 "The runtime configuration file"
4879 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4880 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4881 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4882 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4883 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4884 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4885 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4886 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4887 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4890 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4891 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4892 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4893 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4894 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4895 actually alter the string.
4897 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4898 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4899 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4900 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4901 existing file in the list.
4904 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4905 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4906 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4907 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4908 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4909 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4910 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4911 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4912 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4913 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4915 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4916 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4917 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4918 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4919 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4921 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4922 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4923 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4924 compromise the Exim user account.
4926 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4927 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4928 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4929 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4930 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4931 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4936 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4937 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4938 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4939 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4940 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4941 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4942 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4943 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4944 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4945 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4946 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4948 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4949 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4950 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4951 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4952 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4953 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4954 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4955 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4956 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4959 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4960 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4961 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4962 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4963 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4965 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4966 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4967 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4968 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4969 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4970 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4972 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4973 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4974 necessarily be discarded.
4975 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4976 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4977 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4978 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4979 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4980 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4982 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4983 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4984 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4985 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4986 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4987 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4988 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4990 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4991 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4992 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4996 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4997 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4998 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4999 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
5000 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
5001 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
5002 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
5003 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
5006 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
5009 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5010 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
5011 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
5013 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
5014 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
5015 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
5017 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
5018 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
5019 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
5021 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
5022 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
5023 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
5024 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
5027 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
5028 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
5029 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
5031 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
5032 want to use this feature, you must set
5034 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
5036 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
5037 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
5040 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
5041 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
5042 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
5043 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
5045 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
5046 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
5047 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
5048 and does not introduce a comment.
5050 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
5051 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
5052 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
5053 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
5054 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
5056 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
5057 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
5058 change settings as required.
5060 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
5061 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
5062 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
5063 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
5064 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
5069 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
5070 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
5071 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
5072 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
5073 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
5074 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
5077 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
5078 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
5080 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
5081 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
5082 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5083 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5084 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5087 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5088 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5089 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5090 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5092 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5093 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5096 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5099 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5100 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5105 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5106 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5107 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5108 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5109 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5110 definition, and must be of the form
5112 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5114 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5115 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5116 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5117 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5118 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5120 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5121 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5122 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5124 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5125 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5126 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5127 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5128 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5129 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5130 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5133 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5134 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5136 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5137 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5138 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5139 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5140 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5141 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5144 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5145 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5146 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5151 MAC == updated value
5153 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5154 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5155 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5156 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5160 MAC == MAC and something added
5162 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5163 from a number of other files.
5165 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5166 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5167 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5168 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5169 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5174 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5175 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5176 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5177 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5179 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5180 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5182 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5184 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5186 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5187 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5188 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5191 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5192 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5193 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5194 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5195 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5198 The following classes of macros are defined:
5200 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5201 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5202 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5203 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5204 &` _EXP_COND_* `& expansion conditions
5205 &` _EXP_ITEM_* `& expansion items
5206 &` _EXP_OP_* `& expansion operators
5207 &` _EXP_VAR_* `& expansion variables
5208 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5209 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5210 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5211 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5212 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5213 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5214 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5215 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5218 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5221 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5222 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5223 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5224 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5225 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5226 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5227 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5229 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5230 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5231 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5235 message_size_limit = 50M
5237 message_size_limit = 100M
5240 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5241 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5242 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5243 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5244 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5246 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5247 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5248 in this line"& will always be true.
5250 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5251 to clarify complicated nestings.
5255 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5256 .cindex "common option syntax"
5257 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5258 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5259 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5260 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5261 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5262 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5263 space) and then the value. For example:
5265 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5267 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5268 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5269 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5270 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5271 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5272 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5273 word &"hide"&. For example:
5275 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5277 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5279 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5281 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5282 all instances of the same driver.
5284 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5285 that are found in option settings.
5288 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5289 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5290 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5291 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5292 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5293 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5294 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5295 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5296 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5297 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5298 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5299 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5304 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5309 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5314 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5315 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5316 .cindex "format" "integer"
5317 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5318 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5319 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5320 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5323 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5324 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5325 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5327 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5328 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5329 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5333 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5334 .cindex "integer format"
5335 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5336 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5337 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5338 Such options are always output in octal.
5341 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5342 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5343 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5344 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5345 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5349 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5350 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5351 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5352 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5353 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5363 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5364 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5365 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5369 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5370 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5371 .cindex "format" "string"
5372 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5373 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5374 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5375 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5376 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5377 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5378 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5379 therefore equivalent:
5381 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5382 trusted_users = uucp:\
5383 # This comment line is ignored
5386 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5387 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5388 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5389 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5390 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5393 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5394 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5395 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5397 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5398 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5402 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5403 character, that character replaces the pair.
5405 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5406 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5407 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5408 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5409 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5410 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5413 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5414 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5415 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5416 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5417 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5418 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5419 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5420 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5421 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5422 within a quoted configuration string.
5425 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5426 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5427 .cindex "format" "user name"
5428 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5429 .cindex "format" "group name"
5430 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5431 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5432 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5433 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5436 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5437 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5438 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5439 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5440 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5441 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5442 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5443 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5444 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5445 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5446 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5448 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5449 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5450 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5451 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5452 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5453 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5456 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5458 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5460 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5461 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The spaces around the first
5462 colon in the example above are necessary. If they were not there, the list would
5463 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5465 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5466 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5467 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5468 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5469 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5470 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5471 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5472 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5474 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5476 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5477 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5478 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5480 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5481 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5482 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5483 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5484 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5485 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5486 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5487 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5488 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5490 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5492 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5493 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5494 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5495 the value in quotes. For example:
5497 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5499 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5500 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5501 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5502 enclosing an empty list item.
5506 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5507 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5508 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5509 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5511 senders = user@domain :
5513 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5514 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5515 items, the second of which is empty:
5517 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5519 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5520 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5521 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5522 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5526 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5527 is at the end of the list.
5532 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5533 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5534 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5535 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5536 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5537 a sequence of lines like this:
5539 <&'instance name'&>:
5544 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5545 followed by three options settings:
5550 transport = local_delivery
5552 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5553 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5554 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5555 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5556 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5557 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5559 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5560 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5562 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5563 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5564 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5565 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5566 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5569 .cindex "generic options"
5570 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5571 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5572 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5573 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5574 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5575 .cindex "private options"
5576 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5577 they all have default values.
5579 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5580 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5581 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5583 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5584 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5585 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5586 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5587 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5588 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5589 configuration lines:
5594 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5595 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5596 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5597 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5603 command_timeout = 10s
5605 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5606 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5609 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5610 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5611 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5620 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5622 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5623 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5624 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5625 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5626 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5627 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5628 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5629 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5630 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5631 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5632 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5636 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5637 All macros should be defined before any options.
5639 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5641 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5643 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5644 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5645 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5646 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5648 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5649 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5650 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5653 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5654 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5655 in the file, after the macros.
5656 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5658 # primary_hostname =
5660 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5661 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5662 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5663 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5665 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5667 domainlist local_domains = @
5668 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5669 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5671 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5672 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5673 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5674 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5676 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5677 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5680 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5681 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5682 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5683 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5684 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5685 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5687 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5688 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5689 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5690 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5691 domain is permitted.
5693 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5694 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5695 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5696 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5697 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5698 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5700 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5701 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5702 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5704 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5706 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5707 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5709 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5710 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5711 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5712 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5713 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5714 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5715 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5716 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5717 contents of a message to be checked.
5719 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5721 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5722 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5724 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5725 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5726 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5727 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5729 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5731 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5732 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5733 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5735 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5736 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5737 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5738 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5739 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5740 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5741 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5743 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5745 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5746 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5748 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5749 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5750 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5751 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5752 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5753 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5754 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5755 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5756 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5757 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5758 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5759 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5760 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5761 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5762 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5763 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5765 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5766 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5767 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5768 which should be used in preference to 587.
5769 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5771 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5773 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5776 # qualify_recipient =
5778 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5779 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5780 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5781 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5782 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5783 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5785 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5786 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5787 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5788 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5790 # allow_domain_literals
5792 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5793 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5794 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5795 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5796 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5797 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5799 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5803 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5804 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5805 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5806 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5807 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5808 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5809 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5810 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5812 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5813 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5818 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5819 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5820 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5821 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5822 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5823 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5826 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5827 1413 (hence their names):
5830 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5832 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5833 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5834 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5835 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5836 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5837 information, you can change this.
5839 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5840 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5845 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5846 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5847 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5848 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5850 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5851 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5853 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5854 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5856 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5859 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5860 +tls_certificate_verified
5863 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5865 # percent_hack_domains =
5867 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5868 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5869 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5871 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5872 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5873 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5874 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5875 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5876 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5877 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5878 always bounce messages.
5880 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5881 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5883 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5884 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5885 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5886 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5887 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5889 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5890 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5891 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5892 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5893 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5896 # split_spool_directory = true
5899 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5900 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5901 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5902 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5903 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5904 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5905 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5907 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5910 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5911 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5912 that are not 8-bit clean.
5914 # accept_8bitmime = false
5917 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5918 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5919 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5920 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5921 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the &%timezone%& runtime
5922 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5924 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5925 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5929 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5930 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5931 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5932 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5933 It starts with the line
5937 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5938 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5939 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5941 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5942 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5943 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5944 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5945 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5946 result of the ACL processing.
5950 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5955 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5956 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5957 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5958 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5959 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5960 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5962 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5963 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5964 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5967 deny domains = +local_domains
5968 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5969 message = Restricted characters in address
5971 deny domains = !+local_domains
5972 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5973 message = Restricted characters in address
5975 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5976 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5977 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5978 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5979 in Internet mail addresses.
5981 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5982 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5983 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5984 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5985 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5986 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5987 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5988 policy of being as safe as possible.
5990 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5991 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5992 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5993 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5994 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5995 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5997 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5998 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5999 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
6000 have to modify this rule.
6002 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
6003 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
6004 common convention of local parts constructed as
6005 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
6006 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
6007 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
6008 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
6009 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
6010 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
6012 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
6013 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
6014 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
6015 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
6016 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
6017 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
6018 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
6020 accept local_parts = postmaster
6021 domains = +local_domains
6023 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
6024 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
6025 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
6026 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
6027 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
6029 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
6030 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
6031 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
6033 require verify = sender
6035 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
6036 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
6037 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
6038 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
6039 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
6040 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
6041 discusses the details of address verification.
6043 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
6044 control = submission
6046 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
6047 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
6048 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
6049 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
6050 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
6051 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
6052 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
6053 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
6054 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
6056 accept authenticated = *
6057 control = submission
6059 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
6060 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
6061 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
6062 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
6063 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
6064 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
6066 require message = relay not permitted
6067 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
6069 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
6070 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
6072 require verify = recipient
6074 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
6075 fails, the address is rejected.
6077 # deny dnslists = black.list.example
6078 # message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
6079 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
6082 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
6083 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
6084 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
6085 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
6087 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6088 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6089 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6092 # require verify = csa
6094 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6095 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6100 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6101 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6105 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6106 of this ACL are commented out:
6109 # message = This message contains a virus \
6112 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6113 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6114 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6115 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6117 # warn spam = nobody
6118 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6119 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6120 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6121 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6123 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6124 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6125 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6126 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6127 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6128 whatever the spam score.
6132 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6135 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6136 .cindex "default" "routers"
6137 .cindex "routers" "default"
6138 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6143 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6144 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6145 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6146 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6147 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6150 # driver = ipliteral
6151 # domains = !+local_domains
6152 # transport = remote_smtp
6154 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6155 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6156 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6157 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6158 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6160 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6161 macro has been defined, per
6163 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6172 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6173 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6174 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6175 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6179 driver = manualroute
6180 domains = ! +local_domains
6181 transport = smarthost_smtp
6182 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6183 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6186 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6187 specified by the line
6189 domains = ! +local_domains
6191 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6192 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6193 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6194 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6195 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6196 passed on to the following routers.
6198 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6199 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6200 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6201 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6203 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6204 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6205 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6206 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6207 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6208 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6209 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6214 domains = ! +local_domains
6215 transport = remote_smtp
6216 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6219 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6221 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6222 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6223 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6224 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6225 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6227 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6228 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6229 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6230 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6231 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6232 the address fails and is bounced.
6234 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6235 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6236 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6237 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6238 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6239 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6240 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6247 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6249 file_transport = address_file
6250 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6252 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6253 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6254 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6255 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6256 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6259 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6260 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6261 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6262 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6267 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6268 # local_part_suffix_optional
6269 file = $home/.forward
6274 file_transport = address_file
6275 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6276 reply_transport = address_reply
6278 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6279 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6280 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6281 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6282 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6285 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6286 # local_part_suffix_optional
6288 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6289 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6290 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6291 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6292 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6293 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6294 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6296 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6297 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6298 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6299 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6301 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6302 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6303 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6304 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6305 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6306 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6307 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6309 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6310 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6311 There are two reasons for doing this:
6314 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6315 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6318 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6319 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6320 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6321 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6325 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6326 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6327 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6328 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6330 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6331 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6332 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6334 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6336 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6342 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6343 # local_part_suffix_optional
6344 transport = local_delivery
6346 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6347 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6348 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6349 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6350 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6353 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6354 .cindex "default" "transports"
6355 .cindex "transports" "default"
6356 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6357 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6358 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6362 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6366 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6371 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6372 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6373 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6374 with over-long lines.
6376 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6377 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6378 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6379 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6381 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6382 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6383 usual federated system.
6388 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6392 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6393 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6394 hosts_require_tls = *
6395 tls_verify_hosts = *
6396 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this this will have no effect,
6397 # but if you have to comment it out then this will at least log whether
6398 # you succeed or not:
6399 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6401 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6402 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6403 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6404 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6405 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6406 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6408 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6409 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6412 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6419 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6420 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6421 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6422 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6423 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6424 then no other options are defined.
6425 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6426 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6427 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6428 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6429 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6430 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6431 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6432 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6433 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6434 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6435 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6437 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6439 All other options are defaulted.
6443 file = /var/mail/$local_part_data
6450 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6451 traditional BSD mailbox format.
6453 We prefer to avoid using &$local_part$& directly to define the mailbox filename,
6454 as it is provided by a potential bad actor.
6455 Instead we use &$local_part_data$&,
6456 the result of looking up &$local_part$& in the user database
6457 (done by using &%check_local_user%& in the the router).
6459 By default &(appendfile)& runs under the uid and gid of the
6460 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6461 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6462 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6463 show how this can be done.
6465 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6466 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6467 similarly-named options above.
6473 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6474 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6475 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6476 be returned to the sender.
6484 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6485 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6486 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6491 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6496 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6497 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6498 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6499 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6500 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6501 introduced by the line
6505 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6508 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6510 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6511 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6512 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6513 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6514 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6516 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6517 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6518 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6521 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6522 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6526 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6527 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6531 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6532 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6533 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6535 begin authenticators
6537 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6538 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6539 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6540 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6541 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6542 to support most MUA software.
6544 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6547 # driver = plaintext
6548 # server_set_id = $auth2
6549 # server_prompts = :
6550 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6551 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6553 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6556 # driver = plaintext
6557 # server_set_id = $auth1
6558 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6559 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6560 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6563 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6564 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6565 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6566 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6567 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6568 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6569 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6570 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6572 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6573 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6574 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6575 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6577 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6578 usercode and password are in different positions.
6579 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6581 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6585 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6586 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6588 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6590 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6592 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6593 uses the PCRE2 regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6594 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6595 regular expressions is discussed in
6596 online Perl manpages, in
6597 many Perl reference books, and also in
6598 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6599 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6600 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6601 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6602 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6604 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6605 are supported by PCRE2 is included in the PCRE2 distribution, and no further
6606 description is included here. The PCRE2 functions are called from Exim using
6607 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE2 options set), except that
6608 the PCRE2_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6611 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6612 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6613 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6614 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6616 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6618 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6619 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6620 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6621 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6622 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6623 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6626 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6627 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6628 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6629 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6630 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6631 match anywhere in the subject string.
6633 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6634 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6636 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6638 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6641 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6643 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6644 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6648 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6649 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6651 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6652 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6653 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6654 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6655 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6656 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6659 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6660 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6661 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6662 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6663 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6664 The key for the lookup is &*specified*& as part of the string to be expanded.
6666 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6667 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6668 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6669 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6670 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6671 Depending on the lookup type (see below)
6672 the key for the lookup may need to be &*specified*& as above
6673 or may be &*implicit*&,
6674 given by the context in which the list is being checked.
6677 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6678 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6679 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6680 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6681 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6682 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6684 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6685 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6686 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6687 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6688 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6690 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6691 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6694 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6695 The key for an expansion-style lookup must be given explicitly.
6696 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6697 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6698 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6699 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6701 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6702 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6704 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6705 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6706 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6707 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a lookup expansion"
6708 The result of the expansion is not tainted.
6711 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6712 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6714 The file could contains lines like this:
6719 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6720 matches the list item.
6722 The key for a list-style lookup is implicit, from the lookup context, if
6723 the lookup is a single-key type (see below).
6724 For query-style lookup types the query must be given explicitly.
6727 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6728 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6730 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6732 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6733 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6734 causes a second lookup to occur.
6736 The lookup type may optionally be followed by a comma
6737 and a comma-separated list of options.
6738 Each option is a &"name=value"& pair.
6739 Whether an option is meaningful depends on the lookup type.
6741 All lookups support the option &"cache=no_rd"&.
6742 If this is given then the cache that Exim manages for lookup results
6743 is not checked before doing the lookup.
6744 The result of the lookup is still written to the cache.
6746 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6747 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6748 lookup is permitted.
6751 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6752 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6753 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6754 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6757 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6758 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6759 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6760 .cindex "tainted data" "single-key lookups"
6761 The file string may not be tainted.
6763 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6764 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a single-key lookup"
6765 All single-key lookups support the option &"ret=key"&.
6766 If this is given and the lookup
6767 (either underlying implementation or cached value)
6768 returns data, the result is replaced with a non-tainted
6769 version of the lookup key.
6772 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6773 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6774 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6775 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6777 For the string-expansion kind of lookups, the query is given in the first
6778 bracketed argument of the &${lookup ...}$& expansion.
6779 For the list-argument kind of lookup the query is given by the remainder of the
6780 list item after the first semicolon.
6782 .cindex "tainted data" "quoting for lookups"
6783 If tainted data is used in the query then it should be quoted by
6784 using the &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& expansion operator
6785 appropriate for the lookup.
6788 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6789 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6790 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6795 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6796 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6797 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6802 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6803 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6804 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6805 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6808 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6809 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6810 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6811 The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6812 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6813 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6814 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6815 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6816 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6818 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6819 &url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6820 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6821 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6823 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6824 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6825 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6826 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6829 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6830 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6831 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6832 Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6833 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6834 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6835 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6837 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6838 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6839 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6840 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6841 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6842 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6843 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6846 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6847 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6849 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6850 This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6851 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6852 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6853 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6854 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6855 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6858 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6859 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6860 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6862 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6863 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6864 This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6865 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6866 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6867 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6868 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6869 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6870 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6871 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6874 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6875 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6876 The given file must be an absolute directory path; this is searched for an entry
6877 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function.
6878 Unless the options (below) permit a path,
6879 the key may not contain any forward slash characters.
6880 If &[lstat()]& succeeds then so does the lookup.
6881 .cindex "tainted data" "dsearch result"
6882 The result is regarded as untainted.
6884 Options for the lookup can be given by appending them after the word "dsearch",
6885 separated by a comma. Options, if present, are a comma-separated list having
6886 each element starting with a tag name and an equals.
6888 Three options are supported, for the return value and for filtering match
6890 The "ret" option requests an alternate result value of
6891 the entire path for the entry. Example:
6893 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,ret=full {/etc}}
6895 The default result is just the requested entry.
6897 The "filter" option requests that only directory entries of a given type
6898 are matched. The match value is one of "file", "dir" or "subdir" (the latter
6899 not matching "." or ".."). Example:
6901 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,filter=file {/etc}}
6903 The default matching is for any entry type, including directories
6906 The "key" option relaxes the restriction that only a simple path component can
6907 be searched for, to permit a sequence of path components. Example:
6909 ${lookup {foo/bar} dsearch,key=path {/etc}}
6911 If this option is used, a ".." component in the key is specifically disallowed.
6912 The default operation is that the key may only be a single path component.
6914 An example of how this
6915 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6916 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6918 .subsection iplsearch
6919 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6920 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6921 The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6922 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6923 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6924 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6925 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6927 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6928 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6929 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6930 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6932 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6933 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6934 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6935 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6936 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6938 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6939 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6940 lookup types support only literal keys.
6942 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6943 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name
6944 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6946 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6947 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6948 notation before executing the lookup.)
6950 One option is supported, "ret=full", to request the return of the entire line
6951 rather than omitting the key portion.
6952 Note however that the key portion will have been de-quoted.
6956 .cindex json "lookup type"
6957 .cindex JSON expansions
6958 The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6959 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6960 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6961 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6962 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6963 of the JSON structure.
6964 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6965 nunbered array element is selected.
6966 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6967 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6968 or array; for the latter two a string-representation of the JSON
6970 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6976 .cindex database lmdb
6977 The given file is an LMDB database.
6978 LMDB is a memory-mapped key-value store,
6979 with API modeled loosely on that of BerkeleyDB.
6980 See &url(https://symas.com/products/lightning-memory-mapped-database/)
6981 for the feature set and operation modes.
6983 Exim provides read-only access via the LMDB C library.
6984 The library can be obtained from &url(https://github.com/LMDB/lmdb)
6985 or your operating system package repository.
6986 To enable LMDB support in Exim set LOOKUP_LMDB=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
6988 You will need to separately create the LMDB database file,
6989 possibly using the &"mdb_load"& utility.
6993 .cindex "linear search"
6994 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6995 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6996 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6997 The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6998 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6999 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
7000 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
7001 in the file is used.
7003 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
7004 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
7005 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
7006 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
7007 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
7012 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
7013 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
7014 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
7015 wildcarding of any kind.
7017 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
7018 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
7019 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
7020 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
7021 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
7022 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
7023 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
7024 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
7025 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
7028 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
7029 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
7030 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
7031 The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
7032 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
7033 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
7034 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
7035 aliases; the full map names must be used.
7037 .subsection (n)wildlsearch
7038 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
7039 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
7040 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
7041 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
7042 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
7043 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
7044 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
7045 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
7046 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
7048 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
7049 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
7050 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
7051 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
7054 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
7056 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
7057 *fish data for anythingfish
7060 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
7061 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
7063 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
7065 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
7066 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
7067 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
7069 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
7071 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
7072 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
7073 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
7075 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
7078 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
7079 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
7080 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
7081 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
7082 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
7084 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
7085 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
7086 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
7087 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
7088 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
7091 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
7092 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
7093 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
7096 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
7098 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
7101 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
7102 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
7103 be followed by optional colons.
7105 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
7106 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
7107 lookup types support only literal keys.
7110 .cindex "spf lookup type"
7111 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
7112 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
7113 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method).
7114 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
7117 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
7118 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
7119 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
7120 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
7121 many of them are given in later sections.
7124 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7125 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
7126 This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
7127 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
7128 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
7131 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7132 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7133 This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
7136 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
7137 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7138 This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
7139 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
7140 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
7141 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
7142 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
7145 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7146 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7147 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7148 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7151 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7152 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7153 This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
7154 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
7157 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7158 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7159 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
7160 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7163 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
7164 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
7165 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
7166 This is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
7167 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
7168 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
7169 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
7170 password value. For example:
7172 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
7176 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7177 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7178 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7179 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7182 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7183 .cindex lookup Redis
7184 The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
7185 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7188 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7189 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
7190 The format of the query is
7191 an SQL statement that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
7194 This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
7195 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
7198 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
7199 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
7200 &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
7201 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
7202 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
7203 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7204 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7205 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7206 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7208 require condition = \
7209 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7211 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7212 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7213 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7214 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7218 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7219 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7220 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7221 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7222 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7223 options such as a list of local domains.
7225 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7226 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7227 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7228 or may give up altogether.
7232 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7233 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7234 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7235 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7236 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7237 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7238 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7239 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7241 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7242 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7243 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7245 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7246 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7247 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7249 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7250 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7251 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7252 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7253 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7254 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7255 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7256 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7257 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7258 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7260 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7262 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7263 looks up these keys, in this order:
7269 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7270 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7271 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7272 Exim move on to try the next key.
7276 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7277 .cindex "partial matching"
7278 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7279 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7280 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7281 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7282 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7283 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7284 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7285 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7286 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7287 a key in a DBM file is
7289 *.dates.fict.example
7291 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7292 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7293 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7296 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7297 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7298 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7300 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7301 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7302 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7303 partial matching keys
7304 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7305 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7306 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7308 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7309 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7310 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7311 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7312 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7313 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7316 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7317 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7318 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7319 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7320 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7321 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7323 2250.dates.fict.example
7324 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7325 *.dates.fict.example
7328 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7331 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7332 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7333 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7334 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7335 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7336 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7338 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7340 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7341 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7342 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7343 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7345 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7347 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7348 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7350 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7351 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7352 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7355 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7357 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7358 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7360 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7361 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7362 for &"*"& on its own.
7364 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7368 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7369 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7370 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7371 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7372 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7373 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7374 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7376 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7377 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7378 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7379 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7380 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7382 When the lookup is done from a string-expansion,
7383 the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild and non-wild parts of the key
7384 during the expansion of the replacement text.
7385 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
7390 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7391 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7392 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7393 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7394 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7395 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7396 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7398 If an option &"cache=no_rd"& is used on the lookup then
7399 the cache is only written to, cached data is not used for the operation
7400 and a real lookup is done.
7402 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7403 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7404 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7405 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7406 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7407 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7409 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7410 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7416 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7417 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7418 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7419 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7420 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7421 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7425 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7426 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7428 [name="$local_part"]
7430 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7431 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7432 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7433 of the following form is provided:
7435 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7437 For example, the way to write the NIS+ query is
7439 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7441 .cindex "tainted data" "in lookups"
7442 &*All*& tainted data used in a query-style lookup must be quoted
7443 using a mechanism appropriate for the lookup type.
7444 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7445 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7446 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7451 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7452 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7453 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7454 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7455 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7456 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7457 an expansion string could contain:
7459 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7461 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7462 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7463 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7464 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7466 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7467 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7468 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7470 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7471 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7472 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7473 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7474 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7476 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7478 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7479 white space is ignored.
7480 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7481 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7482 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7484 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7485 When the type is PTR,
7486 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7487 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7489 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7491 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7492 altered and nothing is added.
7494 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7495 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7496 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7497 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7498 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7499 The field separator can be modified as above.
7501 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7502 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7503 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7504 unless a field separator is specified.
7505 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7507 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7509 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7510 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7511 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7513 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7514 white space is ignored.
7516 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7517 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7518 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7519 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7522 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7525 .subsection "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" SECTdnsdb_mod
7526 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7527 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7528 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7529 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7530 each followed by a comma,
7531 that may appear before the record type.
7533 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7534 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7535 a defer-option modifier.
7536 The possible keywords are
7537 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7538 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7539 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7540 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7541 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7542 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7543 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7545 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7546 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7548 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7549 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7551 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7552 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7553 The possible keywords are
7554 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7555 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7557 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7558 is not labelled as authenticated data
7559 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7560 The default is &"lax"&.
7562 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7564 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7565 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7566 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7567 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7569 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7571 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7572 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7573 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7575 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7576 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7578 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7579 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7580 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7583 .subsection "Pseudo dnsdb record types" SECID66
7584 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7585 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7586 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7587 the pseudo-type MXH:
7589 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7591 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7594 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7595 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7596 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7597 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7598 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7599 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7600 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7601 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7603 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7604 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7606 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7607 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7608 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7610 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7611 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7612 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7613 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7614 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7617 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7618 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7619 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7620 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7621 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7622 result of a successful lookup such as:
7624 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7626 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7627 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7628 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7630 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7631 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7632 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7633 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7635 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7639 .subsection "Multiple dnsdb lookups" SECID67
7640 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7641 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7642 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7643 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7645 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7646 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7647 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7649 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7650 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7651 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7652 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7654 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7655 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7656 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7661 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7662 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7663 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7664 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7665 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7666 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7667 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7668 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7669 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7670 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7671 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7672 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7674 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7675 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7676 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7677 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7678 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7680 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7681 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7683 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7684 the way they handle the results of a query:
7687 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7690 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7691 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7693 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7694 from all of them are returned.
7698 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7699 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7700 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7701 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7704 .subsection "Format of LDAP queries" SECTforldaque
7705 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7706 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7707 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7709 data = ${lookup ldap \
7710 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7711 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7713 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7714 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7715 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7716 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7718 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7719 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7720 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7722 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7723 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7724 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7725 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7726 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7727 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7728 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7729 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7733 .subsection "LDAP quoting" SECID68
7734 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7735 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7736 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7737 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7738 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7740 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7741 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7749 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7750 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7754 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7756 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7760 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7762 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7764 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7766 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7767 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7768 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7772 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7773 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7774 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7776 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7780 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7782 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7784 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7786 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7787 authentication below.
7790 .subsection "LDAP connections" SECID69
7791 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7792 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7793 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7794 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7797 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7799 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7800 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7801 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7802 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7803 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7804 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7805 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7806 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7807 failures, and timeouts.
7809 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7810 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7811 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7812 doubled. For example
7814 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7816 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7817 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7818 the local host) is used.
7820 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7821 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7822 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7823 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7826 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7827 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7828 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7829 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7831 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7833 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7834 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7836 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7838 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7839 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7840 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7841 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7842 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7843 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7844 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7847 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7848 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7849 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7852 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7855 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7859 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7860 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7864 .subsection "LDAP authentication and control information" SECID70
7865 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7866 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7867 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7868 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7869 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7870 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7871 them. The following names are recognized:
7872 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
7873 .irow DEREFERENCE "set the dereferencing parameter"
7874 .irow NETTIME "set a timeout for a network operation"
7875 .irow USER "set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind"
7876 .irow PASS "set the password, likewise"
7877 .irow REFERRALS "set the referrals parameter"
7878 .irow SERVERS "set alternate server list for this query only"
7879 .irow SIZE "set the limit for the number of entries returned"
7880 .irow TIME "set the maximum waiting time for a query"
7882 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7883 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7884 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7885 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7887 .cindex LDAP timeout
7888 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7889 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7890 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7891 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7892 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7893 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7894 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7895 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7896 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7897 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7899 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7900 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7902 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7903 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7904 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7905 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7906 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7907 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7908 alternate list (colon-separated).
7910 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7911 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7914 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7915 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7918 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7919 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7920 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7921 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7923 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7924 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7925 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7927 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7928 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it to the LDAP library.
7930 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7931 quoting has two advantages:
7934 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7935 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7937 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7940 For example, a setting such as
7942 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7944 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7946 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7947 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7948 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7949 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7953 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7954 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7959 .subsection "Format of data returned by LDAP" SECID71
7960 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7961 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7962 as a sequence of values, for example
7964 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7966 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7967 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7968 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7969 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7970 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7973 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7974 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7975 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7976 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7978 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7979 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7980 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7981 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7982 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7983 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7984 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7985 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7986 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7988 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7989 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7990 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7991 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7992 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7995 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7998 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
8001 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
8002 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
8004 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
8005 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
8007 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
8008 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
8011 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
8012 results of LDAP lookups.
8013 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
8014 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
8015 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
8016 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
8017 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
8018 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
8023 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
8024 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
8025 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
8026 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
8027 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
8028 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
8029 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
8030 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
8032 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
8034 might return the string
8036 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
8037 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
8039 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
8041 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
8047 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
8048 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
8049 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
8053 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
8054 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
8055 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
8056 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
8057 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
8058 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
8059 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
8060 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
8061 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
8062 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
8063 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
8064 .cindex lookup Redis
8065 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
8067 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
8070 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
8073 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
8074 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
8076 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
8081 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
8083 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
8084 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
8085 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
8089 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
8090 with a newline between the data for each row.
8093 .subsection "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" SECID72
8094 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
8095 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
8096 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
8097 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
8098 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
8099 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
8100 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
8101 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
8102 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
8103 .cindex lookup Redis
8104 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
8105 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
8106 or &%redis_servers%&
8107 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8109 .oindex &%mysql_servers%&
8110 .oindex &%pgsql_servers%&
8111 .oindex &%oracle_servers%&
8112 .oindex &%ibase_servers%&
8113 .oindex &%redis_servers%&
8114 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
8115 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
8116 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
8118 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
8119 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
8120 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
8121 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
8123 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
8125 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
8126 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
8127 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
8129 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
8130 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
8132 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
8133 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
8134 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
8135 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
8136 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
8137 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
8139 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
8140 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
8141 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8143 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
8144 host, database number, and password.
8146 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
8147 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
8148 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
8150 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
8152 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
8155 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
8156 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
8157 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
8158 itself are escaped with backslashes.
8160 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
8161 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
8163 .subsection "Specifying the server in the query" SECTspeserque
8164 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
8165 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
8166 done by appending a comma-separated option to the query type:
8168 &`,servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&
8170 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
8172 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
8173 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
8174 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
8177 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
8179 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
8180 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
8181 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
8183 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
8184 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
8185 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
8188 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
8192 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
8194 ${lookup mysql,servers=master {UPDATE ...} }
8196 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
8197 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
8198 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
8200 ${lookup pgsql,servers=master/db/name/pw {UPDATE ...} }
8203 A now-deprecated syntax places the servers specification before the query,
8204 semicolon separated:
8206 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
8208 The new version avoids issues with tainted
8209 arguments explicitly expanded as part of the query.
8210 The entire string within the braces becomes tainted,
8211 including the server sepcification - which is not permissible.
8212 If the older sytax is used, a warning message will be logged.
8213 This syntax will be removed in a future release.
8215 &*Note*&: server specifications in list-style lookups are still problematic.
8218 .subsection "Special MySQL features" SECID73
8219 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
8220 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
8221 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
8222 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
8223 the default value is &"exim"&.
8224 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
8226 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
8227 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
8229 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
8230 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
8232 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8235 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8236 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8238 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8239 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8240 is zero because no rows are affected.
8242 To get an encryted connection, use a Mysql option file with the required
8243 parameters for the connection.
8246 .subsection "Special PostgreSQL features" SECID74
8247 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8248 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8249 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8250 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8253 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8255 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8256 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8257 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8259 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8260 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8263 .subsection "More about SQLite" SECTsqlite
8264 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8265 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8266 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8267 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8268 daemon as in the other SQL databases.
8270 .oindex &%sqlite_dbfile%&
8271 There are two ways of
8272 specifying the file.
8273 The first is by using the &%sqlite_dbfile%& main option.
8274 The second, which allows separate files for each query,
8275 is to use an option appended, comma-separated, to the &"sqlite"&
8276 lookup type word. The option is the word &"file"&, then an equals,
8278 The filename in this case cannot contain whitespace or open-brace charachters.
8280 A deprecated method is available, prefixing the query with the filename
8281 separated by white space.
8283 .cindex "tainted data" "sqlite file"
8284 the query cannot use any tainted values, as that taints
8285 the entire query including the filename - resulting in a refusal to open
8288 In all the above cases the filename must be an absolute path.
8290 Here is a lookup expansion example:
8292 sqlite_dbfile = /some/thing/sqlitedb
8294 ${lookup sqlite {select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8296 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8298 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;\
8299 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8301 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8302 quote, which it doubles.
8304 .cindex timeout SQLite
8305 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8306 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8307 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8308 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8309 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8310 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8311 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8314 .subsection "More about Redis" SECTredis
8315 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8316 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8317 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8320 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8321 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8324 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8325 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8326 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8327 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8330 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8331 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8332 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8339 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8340 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8342 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8343 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8344 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8345 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8346 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8347 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8348 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8349 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8350 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8352 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8353 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8354 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8355 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8357 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8358 support all the complexity available in
8359 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8363 .section "Results of list checking" SECTlistresults
8364 The primary result of doing a list check is a truth value.
8365 In some contexts additional information is stored
8366 about the list element that matched:
8369 A &%hosts%& ACL condition
8370 will store a result in the &$host_data$& variable.
8372 A &%local_parts%& router option or &%local_parts%& ACL condition
8373 will store a result in the &$local_part_data$& variable.
8375 A &%domains%& router option or &%domains%& ACL condition
8376 will store a result in the &$domain_data$& variable.
8378 A &%senders%& router option or &%senders%& ACL condition
8379 will store a result in the &$sender_data$& variable.
8381 A &%recipients%& ACL condition
8382 will store a result in the &$recipient_data$& variable.
8385 The detail of the additional information depends on the
8386 type of match and is given below as the &*value*& information.
8391 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8392 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8393 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8394 .cindex "tainted data" tracking
8395 &*Note*&: As a result, if any componend was tainted then the
8396 entire result string becomes tainted.
8398 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8399 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8402 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8403 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8404 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8405 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8406 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8409 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8410 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8411 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8413 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8414 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8415 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8416 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8417 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8419 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8420 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8422 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8423 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8424 senders based on the receiving domain.
8429 .subsection "Negated items in lists" SECID76
8430 .cindex "list" "negation"
8431 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8432 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8433 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8434 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8435 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8436 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8438 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8439 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8440 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8441 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8442 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8444 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8446 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8447 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8448 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8450 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8452 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8453 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8454 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8456 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8457 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8462 .subsection "File names in lists" SECTfilnamlis
8463 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8464 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8465 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8466 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8467 filenames are not allowed,
8468 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8469 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8473 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8474 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8476 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8477 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8478 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8480 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8484 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8485 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8486 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8487 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8489 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8490 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8492 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8494 and the file contains the lines
8499 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8500 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8504 .subsection "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" SECID77
8505 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8506 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8507 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8508 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8509 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8510 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8511 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8513 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8514 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8515 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8516 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8521 .subsection "Named lists" SECTnamedlists
8522 .cindex "named lists"
8523 .cindex "list" "named"
8524 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8525 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8526 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8527 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8528 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8529 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8530 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8532 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8534 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8535 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8536 configured with the line
8538 domains = +local_domains
8540 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8541 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8545 domains = ! +local_domains
8546 transport = remote_smtp
8549 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8550 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8551 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8552 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8554 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8555 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8557 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8559 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8560 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8561 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8563 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8564 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8565 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8567 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8568 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8570 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8571 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8572 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8574 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8576 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8577 referenced lists if you can.
8579 .cindex "hiding named list values"
8580 .cindex "named lists" "hiding value of"
8581 Some named list definitions may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
8582 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
8583 line option to read these values, you can precede the definition with the
8584 word &"hide"&. For example:
8586 hide domainlist filter_for_domains = ldap;PASS=secret ldap::/// ...
8590 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8591 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8592 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8594 domains = +local_domains
8596 on several of your routers
8597 or in several ACL statements,
8598 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8599 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8600 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8601 the same each time they are referenced.
8603 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8604 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8605 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8606 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8610 .subsection "Named lists compared with macros" SECID78
8611 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8612 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8613 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8614 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8617 ALIST = host1 : host2
8618 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8620 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8622 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8624 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8627 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8628 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8630 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8632 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8636 .subsection "Named list caching" SECID79
8637 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8638 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8639 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8640 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8641 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8642 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8643 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8644 message. For example:
8646 domainlist special_domains = \
8647 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8649 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8650 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8651 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8652 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8653 same list each time.
8655 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8656 cache the result anyway. For example:
8658 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8660 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8661 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8665 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8666 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8667 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8668 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8669 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8672 .cindex "primary host name"
8673 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8674 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8675 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8676 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8677 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8678 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8679 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8680 differ only in their names.
8682 The value for a match will be the primary host name.
8686 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8687 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8688 .cindex "domain literal"
8689 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8690 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8691 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8692 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8693 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8694 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial;
8695 see the &%allow_domain_literals%& main option.
8697 The value for a match will be the string &`@[]`&.
8702 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8703 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8704 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8705 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8706 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8707 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8708 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8709 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8710 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8711 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8712 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8714 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8715 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8716 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8717 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8718 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8720 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8721 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8722 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8723 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8724 on a router). For example:
8726 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8728 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8729 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8731 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8732 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8733 contain negative items.
8735 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8736 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8737 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8739 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8740 an.other.domain : ...
8742 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8743 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8745 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8746 an.other.domain ? ...
8748 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting &`@mx_`&).
8752 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8753 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8754 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8755 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8756 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8757 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8758 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8759 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8760 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8763 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the asterisk).
8764 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the matched string
8765 and &$1$& to the variable portion which the asterisk matched.
8768 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8769 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8770 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8771 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8772 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8773 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8774 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8775 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8776 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8778 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8779 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8780 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8781 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8782 expression by expansion, of course).
8784 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the circumflex).
8785 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the string matching the regular expression,
8786 and &$1$& (onwards) to any submatches identified by parentheses.
8791 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8792 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8793 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8794 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8795 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8796 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8798 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8800 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8801 key. In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used; Exim is interested
8802 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8803 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8804 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the value is preserved in the
8805 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8806 other statements in the same ACL.
8807 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8808 .cindex "de-tainting" "using ACL domains condition"
8809 The value will be untainted.
8811 &*Note*&: If the data result of the lookup (as opposed to the key)
8812 is empty, then this empty value is stored in &$domain_data$&.
8813 The option to return the key for the lookup, as the value,
8814 may be what is wanted.
8818 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8819 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8821 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8823 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8824 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8827 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8828 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8829 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8830 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8831 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8832 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8836 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8837 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8838 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8839 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8841 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8842 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8844 In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8845 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8846 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8847 &%domains%& option on a router, the value is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8848 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8849 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8850 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router domains option"
8851 The value will be untainted.
8854 If the pattern starts with the name of a lookup type
8855 of either kind (single-key or query-style) it may be
8856 followed by a comma and options,
8857 The options are lookup-type specific and consist of a comma-separated list.
8858 Each item starts with a tag and and equals "=" sign.
8861 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8862 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8863 between the pattern and the domain.
8865 The value for a match will be the list element string.
8866 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8867 Note that this is commonly untainted
8868 (depending on the way the list was created).
8869 Specifically, explicit text in the configuration file in not tainted.
8870 This is a useful way of obtaining an untainted equivalent to
8871 the domain, for later operations.
8873 However if the list (including one-element lists)
8874 is created by expanding a variable containing tainted data,
8875 it is tainted and so will the match value be.
8879 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8881 domainlist funny_domains = \
8884 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8885 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8886 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8887 nis;domains.byname : \
8888 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8890 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8891 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8892 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8893 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8894 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8899 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8900 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8901 .cindex "list" "host list"
8902 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8903 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8904 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8905 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8906 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8907 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8908 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8911 .subsection "Special host list patterns" SECID80
8912 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8913 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8914 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8915 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8916 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8919 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8920 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8921 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8925 .subsection "Host list patterns that match by IP address" SECThoslispatip
8926 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8927 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8928 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8929 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8930 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8931 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8934 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8935 inspecting its IP address:
8938 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8939 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8940 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8941 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8942 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8943 with the IP address of the subject host.
8945 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8946 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8947 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8948 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8949 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8952 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8953 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8954 domain name, as just described.
8957 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8958 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8959 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8960 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8961 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8962 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8963 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8964 that can never match a client host.
8967 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8968 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8969 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8970 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8972 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8976 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8977 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length, for
8982 , it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8983 host under the given mask. This allows an entire network of hosts to be
8984 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8985 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8986 significant end of the address.
8988 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8989 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8990 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8991 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8995 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8996 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8999 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
9001 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
9002 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
9004 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
9005 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
9008 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
9010 could make use of a file containing
9015 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
9016 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
9017 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
9019 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
9022 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
9028 .subsection "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
9030 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
9031 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
9032 address, the pattern takes this form:
9034 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
9038 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
9040 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
9041 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
9042 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
9043 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
9044 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
9045 returned by the lookup is not used.
9047 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9048 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
9049 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
9050 patterns of this form:
9052 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
9056 net24-dbm;/networks.db
9058 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
9059 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
9060 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
9061 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
9062 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
9064 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
9065 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
9066 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
9067 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
9068 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
9069 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
9070 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
9071 converted using colons and not dots.
9072 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
9073 addresses are always used.
9074 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
9076 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
9077 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
9078 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
9081 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
9082 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
9083 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
9084 case the IP address is used on its own.
9088 .subsection "Host list patterns that match by host name" SECThoslispatnam
9089 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
9090 .cindex "unknown host name"
9091 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9092 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
9093 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
9094 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
9095 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
9098 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
9099 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
9100 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
9101 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
9102 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
9103 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
9104 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
9106 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
9107 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
9109 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
9110 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
9111 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
9112 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
9113 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
9114 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
9115 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
9116 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
9117 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
9119 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
9120 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
9122 .cindex "host" "alias for"
9123 .cindex "alias for host"
9124 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
9125 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
9128 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
9129 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
9130 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
9131 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
9132 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
9135 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
9136 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
9137 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
9138 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
9139 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
9140 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
9141 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
9146 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
9147 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
9148 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
9149 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
9150 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9152 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
9154 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
9155 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
9156 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
9163 .subsection "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" SECTbehipnot
9164 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
9165 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
9166 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
9167 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
9168 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
9170 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
9171 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
9173 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
9174 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
9175 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
9176 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
9177 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
9178 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
9179 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
9180 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
9181 not recognized in an indirected file).
9184 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
9185 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
9187 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
9189 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
9190 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
9193 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
9194 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
9197 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
9200 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
9201 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
9202 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
9205 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
9206 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
9209 .subsection "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
9211 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
9213 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
9214 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
9215 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
9218 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
9219 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
9220 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
9222 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
9224 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
9225 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
9226 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
9227 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
9228 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
9229 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
9230 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
9233 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
9234 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
9236 accept hosts = *.friend.example
9237 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
9239 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
9240 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
9241 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
9246 .subsection "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
9248 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
9249 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
9250 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
9251 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
9252 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
9253 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
9254 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
9255 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
9256 host lists such as whitelists.
9260 .subsection "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
9262 .cindex "unknown host name"
9263 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9264 If a pattern is of the form
9266 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
9270 dbm;/host/accept/list
9272 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
9273 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
9276 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
9277 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
9278 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"&
9279 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
9280 There is, however, no reason why you could not use
9281 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
9282 lookup, both using the same file.
9286 .subsection "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" SECID81
9287 If a pattern is of the form
9289 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
9291 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
9292 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
9293 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
9295 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
9296 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
9298 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
9299 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
9300 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
9303 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
9304 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
9305 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
9307 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
9308 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
9309 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
9310 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
9311 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
9312 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
9318 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
9319 .cindex "list" "address list"
9320 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
9321 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
9322 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
9323 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
9324 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
9325 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
9326 using this option setting:
9330 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
9331 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
9332 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
9333 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
9335 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
9338 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
9340 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
9341 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
9342 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
9343 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
9344 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
9345 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
9346 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
9348 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
9349 *@+hostile_domains:\
9350 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
9351 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
9353 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9354 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
9355 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
9356 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
9357 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
9359 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9360 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9361 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9362 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9363 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9365 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9368 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9369 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9373 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9374 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9375 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9376 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9377 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9378 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9379 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9381 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9382 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9384 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9385 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9388 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9389 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9390 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9393 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9394 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9395 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9397 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9398 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9399 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9400 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9402 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9403 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9405 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9406 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9407 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9408 default. For example, with this lookup:
9410 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9412 the file could contains lines like this:
9414 user1@domain1.example
9417 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9420 nimrod@jaeger.example
9424 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9425 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9427 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9429 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9430 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9432 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9433 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9434 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9438 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9439 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9444 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9445 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9446 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9447 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9448 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9449 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9450 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9451 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9452 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9454 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9455 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9456 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9457 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9458 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9461 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9463 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9465 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9467 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9469 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9470 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9471 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9472 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9473 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9474 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9476 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9479 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9482 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9483 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9484 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9485 might have entries like
9487 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9488 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9491 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9492 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9493 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9494 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9496 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9497 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9498 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9501 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9502 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9503 can only return a single list of local parts.
9506 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9507 in these two examples:
9510 senders = *@+my_list
9512 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9513 example it is a named domain list.
9518 .subsection "Case of letters in address lists" SECTcasletadd
9519 .cindex "case of local parts"
9520 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9521 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9522 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9523 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9524 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9525 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9526 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9527 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9530 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9531 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9532 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9533 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9534 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9535 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9536 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9539 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9540 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9541 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9542 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9543 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9544 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9545 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9546 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9550 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9551 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9552 .cindex "local part" "list"
9553 These behave in the same way as domain and host lists, with the following
9556 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9557 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9558 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9559 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9560 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9561 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9562 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9563 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9565 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9566 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9567 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9568 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9569 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9570 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9571 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9573 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9578 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9579 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9581 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9582 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9583 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9584 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9586 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9587 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9588 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9589 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9590 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9591 escape character, as described in the following section.
9593 .cindex "tainted data" tracking
9594 If any porttion of the result string is tainted, the entire result is.
9596 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9597 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9598 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9599 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9600 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9602 .cindex "tainted data" expansion
9603 .cindex "tainted data" definition
9604 .cindex expansion "tainted data"
9605 and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9606 is not permitted (including acessing a file using a tainted name).
9608 Common ways of obtaining untainted equivalents of variables with
9610 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
9611 come down to using the tainted value as a lookup key in a trusted database.
9612 This database could be the filesystem structure,
9613 or the password file,
9614 or accessed via a DBMS.
9615 Specific methods are indexed under &"de-tainting"&.
9619 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9620 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9621 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9622 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9623 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9624 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9625 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9626 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9628 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9629 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9630 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9631 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9633 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9635 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9636 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9641 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9642 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9643 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9644 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9645 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9646 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9647 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9650 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9651 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9652 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9655 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9656 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9657 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9659 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9660 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9661 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9662 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9663 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9664 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9665 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9668 When reading lines from the standard input,
9669 macros can be defined and ACL variables can be set.
9673 set acl_m_myvar = bar
9675 Such macros and variables can then be used in later input lines.
9677 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9678 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9679 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9682 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9683 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9684 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9685 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9687 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9689 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9690 Exim message identifier. For example:
9692 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9694 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9695 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9698 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9699 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9700 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9701 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9702 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9703 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9704 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9705 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9706 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9707 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9708 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9709 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9715 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9716 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9717 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9718 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9719 white space is significant.
9722 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9723 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9724 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9729 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9730 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9731 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9732 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9733 given, the expansion fails.
9735 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9736 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9737 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9738 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9742 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9743 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9744 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9745 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9746 string easier to understand.
9748 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9749 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9750 expansion item below.
9753 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9754 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9755 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9756 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9757 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9758 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9759 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9760 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9761 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9762 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9763 the result of the expansion.
9764 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9765 the expansion result is an empty string.
9766 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9769 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9770 .cindex authentication "results header"
9771 .chindex Authentication-Results:
9772 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9773 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9774 &'Authentication-Results:'&
9776 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9777 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9778 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9787 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9789 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9791 This is safe even if no authentication results are available
9792 and would generally be placed in the DATA ACL.
9795 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9796 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9797 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9798 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9799 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9800 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9801 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9802 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9806 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9807 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9812 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9816 If the field is found,
9817 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9818 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9819 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9820 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9822 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9823 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9826 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9828 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9829 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9831 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9832 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9833 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9834 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9835 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9836 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9837 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9838 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9840 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9841 take an optional modifier of "int"
9842 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9843 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9844 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9846 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9847 newline-separated by default,
9848 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9849 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9850 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9852 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9853 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9854 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9855 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9856 if so the element tags are omitted.
9858 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9860 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9861 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9863 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9864 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9868 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9869 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9870 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9872 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9875 a local function that is to be called in this way,
9876 first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9877 and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9878 The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9879 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9880 must have the following type:
9882 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9884 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9885 function should return one of the following values:
9887 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9888 into the expanded string that is being built.
9890 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9891 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9893 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9894 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9896 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9898 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9899 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9900 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9903 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9904 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9905 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9906 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9908 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9909 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9910 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9912 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9913 appear, for example:
9915 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9917 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9918 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9920 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9922 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9925 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9926 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9929 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9930 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9931 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9932 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9933 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9934 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9935 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9936 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9938 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9941 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9942 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9943 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9944 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9945 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9946 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9947 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9948 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9949 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9951 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9952 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9953 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9956 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9957 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9959 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9960 appear, for example:
9962 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9964 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9965 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9967 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9968 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9969 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9970 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9971 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9972 .cindex JSON expansions
9973 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9974 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9975 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9976 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9978 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9981 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9982 the spaces are optional.
9983 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9984 For the &"json"& variant,
9985 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9987 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9988 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9989 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9991 The results of matching are handled as above.
9994 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9995 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9996 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9997 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9998 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9999 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
10000 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
10001 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
10002 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
10003 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
10004 <&'string3'&> as before.
10006 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
10007 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
10008 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
10009 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
10010 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
10011 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
10012 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
10013 provided. For example:
10015 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
10019 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
10021 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
10022 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
10025 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
10026 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10027 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
10028 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10029 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
10030 .cindex JSON expansions
10031 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10032 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
10034 Field selection and result handling is as above;
10035 there is no choice of field separator.
10036 For the &"json"& variant,
10037 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
10039 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
10040 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
10043 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
10044 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
10045 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
10047 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10048 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10050 in this list, its value is placed in &$item$&, and then the condition is
10052 Any modification of &$value$& by this evaluation is discarded.
10053 If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
10054 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
10055 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
10056 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
10058 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
10060 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
10061 to what it was before.
10062 See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10065 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10066 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10067 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10068 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
10069 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
10070 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
10072 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
10073 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
10074 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
10075 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10077 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10079 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
10080 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
10081 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
10082 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
10083 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
10085 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
10087 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
10088 letters appear. For example:
10090 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
10091 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
10092 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
10095 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10096 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10097 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10098 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10099 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10100 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10101 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10102 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10103 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
10104 .vindex "&$header_$&"
10105 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
10106 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
10107 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
10108 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
10109 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
10110 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
10111 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
10115 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
10116 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
10117 lines) may be present.
10119 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
10120 the data in the header line is interpreted.
10123 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
10124 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
10125 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
10128 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
10129 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
10130 are multiple headers with a given name.
10131 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
10132 list-processing facilities can be used.
10133 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
10134 the content is &"raw"&.
10137 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
10138 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
10139 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
10140 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
10141 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
10142 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
10143 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
10144 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
10147 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
10148 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
10149 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
10150 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
10151 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
10152 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
10155 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
10156 command of the following form:
10158 headers charset "UTF-8"
10160 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
10161 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
10162 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
10163 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
10164 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
10167 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
10168 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
10169 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
10170 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
10172 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
10173 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
10174 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
10175 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
10176 router or transport are not accessible.
10178 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
10179 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
10180 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
10181 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
10182 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
10183 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
10184 point they are added.
10185 When any of the above ACLs are
10186 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
10188 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
10189 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
10190 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
10191 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
10192 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
10193 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
10194 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
10197 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
10198 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
10199 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
10200 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
10201 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
10202 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
10203 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
10204 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
10206 .cindex "tainted data" "message headers"
10207 When the headers are from an incoming message,
10208 the result of expanding any of these variables is tainted.
10211 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10212 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
10214 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
10215 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
10216 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
10217 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
10218 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
10219 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
10220 present. For example:
10222 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
10224 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
10227 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
10229 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
10230 an Exim configuration:
10232 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
10234 In a router or a transport you could then have:
10237 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
10238 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
10239 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
10241 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
10242 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
10243 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
10244 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
10245 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
10246 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
10249 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10250 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
10251 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
10252 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
10253 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
10254 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
10256 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
10258 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
10259 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
10260 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
10261 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
10262 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
10264 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
10265 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
10266 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
10268 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
10272 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
10277 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
10278 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
10279 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
10280 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
10281 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
10282 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
10286 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10287 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10288 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10289 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
10290 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
10291 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
10292 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
10293 some of the braces:
10295 ${length_<n>:<string>}
10297 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
10298 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
10299 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
10300 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10303 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
10304 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10305 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
10306 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
10307 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
10308 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10309 apart from an optional leading minus,
10310 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
10312 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10313 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10315 The first field of the list is numbered one.
10316 If the number is negative, the fields are
10317 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
10318 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
10319 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
10321 If the modulus of the
10322 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
10323 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
10327 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
10331 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
10333 yields &"result: 42"&.
10335 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
10336 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
10338 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
10341 .vitem &*${listquote{*&<&'separator'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10342 .cindex quoting "for list"
10343 .cindex list quoting
10344 This item doubles any occurrence of the separator character
10345 in the given string.
10346 An empty string is replaced with a single space.
10347 This converts the string into a safe form for use as a list element,
10348 in a list using the given separator.
10351 .vitem "&*${lookup&~{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
10352 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10353 "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
10354 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10355 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
10356 .cindex "file" "lookups"
10357 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
10358 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
10359 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
10360 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
10361 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
10363 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
10364 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
10365 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
10366 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
10367 out by the system administrator.
10369 .vindex "&$value$&"
10370 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
10371 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
10372 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
10373 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
10374 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
10375 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
10376 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
10377 original lookup fails.
10379 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
10380 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
10381 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
10382 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
10383 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
10384 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
10385 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
10386 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
10388 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
10389 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
10390 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
10391 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
10393 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
10394 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
10395 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
10396 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
10398 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10400 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10402 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10403 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10405 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10410 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10411 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10413 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10414 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10416 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10417 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10418 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10419 setting is not included in the output. For example:
10421 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10423 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10424 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10425 and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10427 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10428 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10429 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10430 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10431 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10432 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10433 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10435 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10437 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10438 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10439 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10440 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10443 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10445 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10449 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10450 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10451 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10452 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10453 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10454 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10455 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10456 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10458 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10459 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the entire expansion is
10460 forced to fail, in the same way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item
10461 does (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). Whatever you return is evaluated
10462 in a scalar context, thus the return value is a scalar. For example, if you
10463 return a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10466 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10467 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10468 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10470 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10471 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10474 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10475 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10476 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10477 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10478 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10479 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10480 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10481 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10483 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10484 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10485 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10486 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10487 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10488 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10489 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10490 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10491 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10492 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10494 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10495 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10496 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10497 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10499 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10500 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10501 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10502 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10503 is the expansion of the third argument.
10505 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10506 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10507 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10509 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10510 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10511 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10512 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10513 The filename and end-of-line (eol) string are first expanded separately. The file is
10514 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10515 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10516 newlines are left in the string.
10517 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10518 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10519 the string expansion fails.
10521 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10522 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10526 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10527 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10528 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10529 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10530 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10531 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10532 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10535 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10536 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10538 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10539 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10540 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10541 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10542 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10545 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10547 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10548 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10549 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10550 (unless it is an empty string; no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10551 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10552 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10553 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10555 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10558 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10559 and must be present if any options are given.
10560 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10563 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10566 The following option names are recognised:
10569 Defines if the result data can be cached for use by a later identical
10570 request in the same process.
10571 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10572 If not, all cached results for this connection specification
10573 will be invalidated.
10577 Defines whether or not a write-shutdown is done on the connection after
10578 sending the request. Values are &"yes"& (the default) or &"no"&
10579 (preferred, eg. by some webservers).
10583 Controls the use of Server Name Identification on the connection.
10584 Any nonempty value will be the SNI sent; TLS will be forced.
10588 Controls the use of TLS on the connection.
10589 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10590 If it is enabled, a shutdown as described above is never done.
10594 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10595 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10596 turns them into spaces:
10598 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10600 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10601 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10602 addition, the following errors can occur:
10605 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10607 Failure to connect the socket;
10609 Failure to write the request string;
10611 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10614 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10615 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10616 errors occurs. For example:
10618 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10621 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10622 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10623 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10624 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10625 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10627 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10628 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10631 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10632 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10633 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10634 .vindex "&$value$&"
10636 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10637 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10638 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10639 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10640 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10641 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10642 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10643 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10644 added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10645 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10647 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10649 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10652 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10654 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10655 restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10658 . A bit of a special-case logic error in writing an expansion;
10659 . probably not worth including in the mainline of documentation.
10660 . If only we had footnotes (the html output variant is the problem).
10663 . &*Note*&: if an &'expansion condition'& is used in <&'string3'&>
10664 . and that condition modifies &$value$&,
10665 . then the string expansions dependent on the condition cannot use
10666 . the &$value$& of the reduce iteration.
10669 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10670 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10671 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10673 .vitem "&*${run<&'options'&> {*&<&'command&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10674 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10675 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10676 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10677 This item runs an external command, as a subprocess.
10678 One option is supported after the word &'run'&, comma-separated
10679 and without whitespace.
10681 If the option &'preexpand'& is not used,
10682 the command string before expansion is split into individual arguments by spaces
10683 and then each argument is separately expanded.
10684 Then the command is run
10685 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10686 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10687 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10688 The command name may not be tainted, but the remaining arguments can be.
10690 &*Note*&: if tainted arguments are used, they are supplied by a
10691 potential attacker;
10692 a careful assessment for security vulnerabilities should be done.
10694 If the option &'preexpand'& is used,
10695 the command string is first expanded as a whole.
10696 The expansion result is split apart into individual arguments by spaces,
10697 and then the command is run as above.
10698 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10699 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10700 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10701 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10702 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10703 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10704 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10705 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10706 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10708 Neither the command nor any argument may be tainted.
10710 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10711 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10712 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10713 .vindex "&$value$&"
10714 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10715 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10716 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10717 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10718 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10721 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10722 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10723 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10724 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10726 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10727 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10728 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10731 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10732 log_message = Output of id: $value
10734 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10735 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10737 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10739 Note that &$value$& will not persist beyond the reception of a single message.
10741 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10742 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10743 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10745 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10746 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10750 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10751 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10754 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10755 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10756 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10757 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10759 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10760 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10763 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10764 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10765 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10766 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10767 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10768 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10769 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10770 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10772 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10774 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10775 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10776 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10778 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10780 yields &"defabc"&, and
10782 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10784 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10785 the regular expression from string expansion.
10787 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10788 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10791 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10792 .cindex sorting "a list"
10793 .cindex list sorting
10794 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10795 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10796 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10797 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10798 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10799 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10800 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10801 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10802 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10803 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10804 to give values for comparison.
10806 The item result is a sorted list,
10807 with the original list separator,
10808 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10812 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10814 sorts a list of numbers, and
10816 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10818 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10822 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
10823 SRS encoding. See SECT &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
10827 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'start'&>&*}{*&<&'len'&>&*}{*&<&'subject'&>&*}}*&
10828 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10829 .cindex "substring extraction"
10830 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10831 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10832 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10833 if <&'start'&> and <&'len'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10834 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10836 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<subject>}
10838 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10839 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10842 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10843 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10844 length required. For example
10846 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10848 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10849 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10850 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10851 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10853 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10854 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10855 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10857 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10859 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10860 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10861 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10863 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10865 yields an empty string, but
10867 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10871 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10872 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10873 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10874 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10877 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10879 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10881 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10885 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10886 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10887 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10888 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10889 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10890 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10891 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10892 replacement list. For example
10894 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10896 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10897 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10898 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10901 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10907 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10908 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10909 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10910 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10911 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10912 following operations can be performed:
10915 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10916 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10917 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10918 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10919 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10920 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10922 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10925 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10926 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10927 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10928 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10929 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10930 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10931 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10932 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10933 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10935 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10936 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10937 character. For example:
10939 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10941 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10942 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10943 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10944 separator explicitly:
10946 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10949 Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10950 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10951 address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10954 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10955 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10956 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10957 email address separator. For the example header line:
10959 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10961 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10962 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10963 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10964 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10965 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10966 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10967 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10969 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10970 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10972 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10973 Last:user@example.com
10974 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10976 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10980 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10981 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10982 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10983 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10984 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10985 Only lowercase letters are used.
10987 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10988 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10989 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10990 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10991 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10993 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10994 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10995 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10996 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10997 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10998 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10999 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
11000 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
11001 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
11003 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
11004 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
11005 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
11006 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
11007 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
11008 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
11011 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11012 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
11013 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
11014 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
11015 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
11016 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
11018 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11019 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
11022 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11023 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
11024 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
11025 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
11026 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
11029 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11030 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
11031 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
11032 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
11033 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
11036 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11037 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
11038 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
11039 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
11040 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
11041 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
11042 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
11044 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11045 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
11046 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
11047 If the string contains any characters with the most significant bit set,
11048 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
11049 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
11052 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11053 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
11054 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
11055 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
11056 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
11057 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
11058 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
11059 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
11060 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
11061 C programming language):
11063 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
11064 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
11065 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
11066 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
11067 .irow "" "and (&&)"
11069 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
11071 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
11072 space is permitted before or after operators.
11074 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
11075 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
11076 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
11077 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
11078 times, which often do have leading zeros.
11080 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
11082 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
11083 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
11086 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
11087 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
11088 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
11089 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
11090 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
11091 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
11092 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
11093 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
11094 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
11095 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
11096 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
11099 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
11103 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
11106 {$recipients_count} \
11107 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
11110 message = Too many bad recipients
11112 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
11113 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
11116 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11117 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
11118 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
11121 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
11123 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
11124 and then re-expands what it has found.
11127 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11129 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
11130 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
11131 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
11132 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
11133 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
11134 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
11135 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
11136 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
11137 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
11139 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
11140 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
11141 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
11142 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
11143 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
11144 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
11145 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
11148 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11149 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
11150 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
11151 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
11152 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
11153 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11155 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11157 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
11158 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
11162 .vitem &*${headerwrap_*&<&'cols'&>&*_*&<&'limit'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11163 .cindex header "wrapping operator"
11164 .cindex expansion "header wrapping"
11165 This operator line-wraps its argument in a way useful for headers.
11166 The &'cols'& value gives the column number to wrap after,
11167 the &'limit'& gives a limit number of result characters to truncate at.
11168 Either just the &'limit'& and the preceding underbar, or both, can be omitted;
11169 the defaults are 80 and 998.
11170 Wrapping will be inserted at a space if possible before the
11171 column number is reached.
11172 Whitespace at a chosen wrap point is removed.
11173 A line-wrap consists of a newline followed by a tab,
11174 and the tab is counted as 8 columns.
11178 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
11179 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
11180 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
11181 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
11182 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
11183 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
11187 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11188 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
11189 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
11190 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
11191 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
11192 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
11193 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
11196 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11197 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
11198 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11199 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
11200 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
11201 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11202 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11204 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11205 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
11206 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11207 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
11208 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
11209 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
11210 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
11211 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11212 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11215 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11216 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11217 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11218 .cindex "lower casing"
11219 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11220 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
11221 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
11225 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11227 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11228 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
11229 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
11230 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
11231 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
11232 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
11234 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
11236 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
11237 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
11238 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
11239 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11242 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11243 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
11244 .cindex "list" "item count"
11245 .cindex "list" "count of items"
11246 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
11247 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
11250 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
11251 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
11252 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
11253 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
11254 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
11255 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
11256 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
11257 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
11258 matching list is returned.
11259 &*Note*&: Neither string-expansion of lists referenced by named-list syntax elements,
11260 nor expansion of lookup elements, is done by the &%listnamed%& operator.
11263 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11264 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
11265 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
11266 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
11267 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
11269 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
11272 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*& &&&
11273 &*${mask_n:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
11274 .cindex "masked IP address"
11275 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
11276 .cindex "CIDR notation"
11277 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
11278 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
11279 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
11280 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
11281 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
11282 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
11283 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
11285 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
11287 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&.
11289 Since this operation is expected to
11290 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the
11293 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
11294 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
11296 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
11300 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
11302 If the optional form &*mask_n*& is used, IPv6 address result are instead
11303 returned in normailsed form, using colons and with zero-compression.
11304 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
11307 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11309 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
11310 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11311 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
11312 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
11313 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
11315 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11316 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11319 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11320 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
11321 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
11322 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
11323 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
11324 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11326 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11328 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
11331 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11332 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
11333 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
11334 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
11335 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
11336 is an empty string or
11337 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
11338 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
11339 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
11340 respectively For example,
11348 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
11349 variable or a message header.
11351 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11352 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
11353 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
11354 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
11355 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
11356 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
11357 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
11359 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
11360 will likely use the quoting form.
11361 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
11364 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11365 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
11366 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
11367 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
11368 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
11370 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
11376 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
11377 yields an unchanged string.
11380 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
11381 .cindex "random number"
11382 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
11383 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
11384 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
11385 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
11386 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
11387 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
11388 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
11389 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
11393 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
11394 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
11395 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
11396 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
11397 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
11398 for DNS. For example,
11400 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
11401 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
11406 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
11410 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11411 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11412 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
11413 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
11414 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
11415 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
11416 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
11417 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
11418 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
11421 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
11423 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
11424 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
11428 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11429 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11430 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
11431 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
11432 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
11433 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
11434 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
11435 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
11437 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
11438 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
11439 to use this operator as well.
11443 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11444 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
11445 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
11446 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
11447 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
11448 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
11449 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
11452 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11453 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11454 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
11455 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11456 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
11457 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
11458 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11460 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11461 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11464 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11465 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11466 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11467 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
11468 .cindex "SHA-2 hash"
11469 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11470 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
11471 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
11472 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
11473 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
11475 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11477 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11478 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11480 The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11481 (except for certificates, which are not supported).
11482 Finally, if an underbar
11483 and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11484 member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11485 Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11488 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11489 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11490 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
11491 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11492 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11493 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11495 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11497 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11498 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11499 with 256 being the default.
11501 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11502 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11503 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11504 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11507 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11508 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11509 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11510 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11511 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11512 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11513 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11514 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11515 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11516 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11517 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11518 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11519 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11521 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11522 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11523 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11525 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11526 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11527 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11531 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11532 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11533 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11534 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11535 The item is replaced by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11536 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11537 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11540 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11541 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11542 .cindex "substring extraction"
11543 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11544 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11545 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11546 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11548 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11550 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11551 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11552 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11554 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11555 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11556 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11557 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11560 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11561 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11562 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11563 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11564 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11565 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11568 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11569 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11570 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11571 .cindex "upper casing"
11572 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11573 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11574 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11575 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11577 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11578 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11579 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11580 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11581 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11582 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11583 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11584 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11585 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11586 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11587 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11588 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11589 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11590 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11592 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11594 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11595 literal question mark).
11597 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11598 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11599 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11600 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11601 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11602 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11604 .cindex internationalisation
11605 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11606 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11607 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11608 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11609 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11610 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11613 .vitem &*${xtextd:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11614 .cindex "text forcing in strings"
11615 .cindex "string" "xtext decoding"
11617 .cindex "&%xtextd%& expansion item"
11618 This performs xtext decoding of the string (per RFC 3461 section 4).
11629 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11630 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11631 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11632 while expanding strings:
11635 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11636 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11637 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11638 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11641 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11642 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11643 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11644 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11646 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
11648 .irow "== " "equal"
11649 .irow "> " "greater"
11650 .irow ">= " "greater or equal"
11652 .irow "<= " "less or equal"
11656 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11658 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11659 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11660 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11661 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11662 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11665 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11666 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11667 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11670 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11671 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11672 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11673 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11674 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11675 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11676 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11677 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11678 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11679 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11680 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11681 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11682 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11683 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11685 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11686 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11687 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11688 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11689 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11690 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11692 An empty string is treated as false.
11693 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11694 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11695 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11697 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11698 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11701 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11705 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11706 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11707 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11708 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11709 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11710 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11711 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11712 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11714 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11716 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11717 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11718 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11719 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11720 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11721 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11722 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11723 included in the binary.
11725 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11726 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11727 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11728 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11729 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11730 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11731 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11732 string in LDAP form is:
11734 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11736 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11737 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11739 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11741 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11746 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11747 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11748 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11749 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11750 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11751 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11755 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11756 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11757 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11758 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11759 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11760 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11763 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11764 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11765 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11766 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11767 whatever its length.
11770 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11771 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11772 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11773 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11775 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11776 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11777 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11778 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11779 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11780 support &[crypt16()]&.
11782 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11783 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11784 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11785 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11786 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11788 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11789 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11790 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11792 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11793 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11794 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11795 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11796 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11798 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11799 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11800 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11801 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11802 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11803 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11805 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11807 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11808 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11810 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11811 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11812 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11813 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11814 exists in the message. For example,
11816 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11818 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11819 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11821 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11822 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11823 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11824 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11825 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11826 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11827 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11828 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11829 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11830 case is defined per the system C locale.
11832 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11833 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11834 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11835 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11836 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11837 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11838 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11839 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11841 &*Note:*& Testing a path using this condition is not a sufficient way of
11843 Consider using a dsearch lookup.
11845 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11846 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11847 .cindex "first delivery"
11848 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11849 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11850 .cindex retry condition
11851 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11852 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11855 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11856 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11857 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11858 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11859 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11861 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11862 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11863 the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11864 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11865 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11866 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11868 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11869 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11870 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11872 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11873 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11874 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11876 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11877 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11878 that the condition must be false for at least one item.
11882 ${if forany{$recipients_list}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11884 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11885 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11887 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11889 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11890 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11891 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11892 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11893 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11894 .cindex JSON expansions
11895 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11896 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11897 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11898 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11899 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11901 The array separator is not changeable.
11902 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11903 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11907 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11908 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11909 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11910 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11911 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11912 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11913 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11914 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11915 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11917 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11919 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11920 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11921 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11922 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11923 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11924 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11925 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11926 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11927 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11929 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11932 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
11933 SRS decode. See SECT &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
11936 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'list'&>&*}*& &&&
11937 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'list'&>&*}*&
11938 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11939 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11940 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11941 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11943 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11945 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11946 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11948 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11949 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11950 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11951 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11954 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
11955 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
11956 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
11957 .cindex "de-tainting" "using an inlist expansion condition"
11958 It will have the same taint status as the list; expansions such as
11960 ${if inlist {$h_mycode:} {0 : 1 : 42} {$value}}
11962 can be used for de-tainting.
11963 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
11966 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11967 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11968 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11969 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11970 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11971 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11972 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11973 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11974 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11975 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11976 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11978 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11979 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11980 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11981 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11982 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11984 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11985 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11987 This is no longer the case.
11989 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11990 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11992 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11994 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11996 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11997 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11998 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11999 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
12000 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
12001 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
12002 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
12003 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
12004 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
12005 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
12006 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
12007 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
12008 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
12012 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
12013 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12014 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12015 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
12016 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
12017 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
12018 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
12019 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
12020 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
12022 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
12024 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
12025 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12026 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12027 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
12028 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
12029 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
12030 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
12031 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
12032 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
12034 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
12037 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12038 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
12039 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
12040 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
12041 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
12042 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
12043 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
12044 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
12045 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
12046 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
12047 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
12050 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
12052 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
12053 backslashes is also required.
12055 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
12056 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
12057 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
12058 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
12059 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
12060 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
12061 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
12062 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
12064 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
12065 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
12066 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
12067 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
12068 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
12069 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
12070 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
12071 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
12073 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12074 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
12075 See &*match_local_part*&.
12077 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12078 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
12079 See &*match_local_part*&.
12081 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12082 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
12083 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
12084 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
12085 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
12086 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
12088 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
12090 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
12093 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
12095 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
12097 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
12098 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
12099 in a single test such as
12100 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12101 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
12102 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
12103 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
12105 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
12107 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
12109 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
12111 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists
12112 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&),
12113 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
12114 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
12115 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
12116 masks. For example:
12118 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
12120 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
12121 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
12122 address mask, for example:
12124 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
12126 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
12127 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
12129 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
12133 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
12134 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
12136 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
12138 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12139 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12140 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12142 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12143 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
12144 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
12145 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
12146 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
12147 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
12148 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
12149 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
12152 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
12154 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
12155 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
12156 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
12157 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
12159 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
12161 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
12162 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
12163 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
12164 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
12167 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12168 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12169 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
12170 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a match_local_part expansion condition"
12171 It will have the same taint status as the list; expansions such as
12173 ${if match_local_part {$local_part} {alice : bill : charlotte : dave} {$value}}
12175 can be used for de-tainting.
12176 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12178 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
12179 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
12181 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
12182 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
12183 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
12184 matched using &%match_ip%&.
12186 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
12187 .cindex "PAM authentication"
12188 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
12189 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
12190 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
12191 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
12192 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
12193 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
12194 available in Solaris
12195 and in some GNU/Linux distributions.
12196 The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
12197 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
12201 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
12202 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
12204 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
12205 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
12206 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
12207 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
12208 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
12209 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
12210 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
12212 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
12213 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
12215 The &%listquote%& expansion item can be used for this.
12216 For example, the configuration
12217 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
12219 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${listquote{:}{$auth2}}}}
12221 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
12222 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
12223 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
12224 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
12227 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12228 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
12230 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
12231 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
12232 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
12233 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
12234 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
12235 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
12237 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12238 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12239 building Exim. For example:
12241 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
12243 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12244 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12245 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
12246 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
12248 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
12249 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
12250 configuration, you might have this:
12252 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
12254 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
12256 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
12258 .vitem &*queue_running*&
12259 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
12260 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
12261 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
12262 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
12263 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
12266 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
12268 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
12269 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
12270 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
12271 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
12272 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
12275 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
12276 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
12277 this library, you need to set
12279 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
12281 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
12282 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
12284 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
12286 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
12287 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
12288 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
12290 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
12291 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
12292 the authentication is successful. For example:
12294 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
12298 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
12299 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
12300 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
12302 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
12303 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
12304 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
12305 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
12306 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
12307 by a process that is not running as root.
12309 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12310 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12311 building Exim. For example:
12313 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
12315 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12316 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12317 from the Cyrus SASL library.
12319 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
12320 two are mandatory. For example:
12322 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
12324 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
12325 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
12326 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
12331 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
12332 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
12333 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
12334 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
12335 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
12336 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
12337 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
12341 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12342 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
12343 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
12344 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12345 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
12348 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
12350 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
12351 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
12352 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
12354 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12355 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
12356 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
12357 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12358 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
12359 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
12360 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
12361 parsed but not evaluated.
12363 .ecindex IIDexpcond
12368 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
12369 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
12370 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
12371 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
12372 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
12373 .cindex "tainted data"
12374 Variables marked as &'tainted'& are likely to carry data supplied by
12375 a potential attacker.
12376 Variables without such marking may also, depending on how their
12377 values are created.
12378 Such variables should not be further expanded,
12380 or used as command-line arguments for external commands.
12383 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
12384 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
12385 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
12386 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
12387 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
12388 In the expansion condition case
12389 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
12390 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
12391 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
12392 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
12393 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
12394 matching condition.
12395 If the subject string was tainted then any captured substring will also be.
12397 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
12398 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12399 any arguments are copied to these variables,
12400 any unused variables being made empty.
12402 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
12403 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
12404 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
12405 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
12406 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
12407 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
12408 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
12409 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
12410 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
12411 during subsequent delivery.
12413 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
12414 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
12415 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
12416 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
12417 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
12418 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
12419 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
12420 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
12423 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
12424 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12425 this variable has the number of arguments.
12427 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
12428 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
12429 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
12430 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers of the verb.
12431 The message can be preserved by coding like this:
12433 warn !verify = sender
12434 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
12436 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
12437 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
12439 &*Note*&: The variable is cleared at the end of processing the ACL verb.
12441 .vitem &$address_data$&
12442 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12443 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
12444 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
12445 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
12446 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
12447 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
12450 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
12451 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
12452 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
12453 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
12454 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
12455 from the child's routing.
12457 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12458 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
12459 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
12462 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
12463 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
12464 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
12466 .vitem &$address_file$&
12467 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
12468 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
12469 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
12470 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
12471 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
12473 /home/r2d2/savemail
12475 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
12476 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
12477 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
12478 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
12479 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
12480 to the relevant file.
12482 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
12483 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
12484 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
12485 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
12487 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth4$&"
12488 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
12489 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
12490 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
12492 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
12493 .cindex "authentication" "id"
12494 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
12495 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
12496 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
12497 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
12498 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
12499 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
12500 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
12502 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
12503 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
12504 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
12505 command line option.
12506 This second case also sets up information used by the
12507 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12509 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12510 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
12511 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
12512 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12513 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
12514 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
12515 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
12516 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
12517 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
12521 .tvar &$authenticated_sender$&
12522 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
12523 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
12524 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12525 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
12526 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
12527 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
12528 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
12529 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12530 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12532 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12533 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12534 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12535 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12536 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12539 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12540 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
12541 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12542 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12543 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12544 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12545 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12546 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12547 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&).
12548 Failure includes cancellation of a authentication attempt,
12549 and any negative response to an AUTH command,
12550 (including, for example, an attempt to use an undefined mechanism).
12552 .vitem &$av_failed$&
12553 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12554 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12555 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12556 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12557 the ACL malware condition.
12559 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
12560 .cindex "message body" "line count"
12561 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
12562 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12563 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12564 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12566 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12567 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12568 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12569 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12570 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12571 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12572 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12574 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12575 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12576 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12577 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12578 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12580 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12581 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12582 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12583 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12584 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12586 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12587 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12588 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12589 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12590 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12591 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12592 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12594 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12595 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12596 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12597 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12598 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12599 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12600 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12602 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12603 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12604 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12605 address that was connected to.
12607 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12608 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12609 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12610 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12611 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12613 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12614 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12615 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12616 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12617 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12618 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12620 .vitem &$config_file$&
12621 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12622 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12624 .vitem &$connection_id$&
12625 .vindex "&$connection_id$&"
12626 .cindex connection "identifier logging"
12627 An identifier for the accepted connection, for use in custom logging.
12629 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12630 Results of DKIM verification.
12631 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12633 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12634 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12635 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12636 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12637 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12639 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12640 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12641 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12642 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12643 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12644 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12645 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12646 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12647 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12648 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12649 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12650 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12651 &$dkim_key_length$&
12652 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12653 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12655 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12656 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12657 When a message has been received this variable contains
12658 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12659 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12661 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12662 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12663 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12664 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12665 Results of DMARC verification.
12666 For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12668 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12669 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12670 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12672 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12673 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12674 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12675 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12676 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12677 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12678 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12679 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12680 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12683 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12684 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12685 case for &$domain$&.
12687 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12688 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12689 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12690 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12692 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12693 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12694 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12695 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12696 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12697 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12699 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12700 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12701 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12703 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12706 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12707 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12708 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12709 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12710 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12711 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12712 the &(smtp)& transport.
12715 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12716 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12717 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12718 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12721 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12722 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12723 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12724 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12725 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12726 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12729 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12730 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12731 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12732 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12735 .cindex "tainted data"
12736 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12737 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and may not
12738 be further expanded or used as a filename.
12739 When an untainted version is needed, one should be obtained from
12740 looking up the value in a local (therefore trusted) database.
12741 Often &$domain_data$& is usable in this role.
12744 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12745 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12746 When the &%domains%& condition on a router
12749 against a list, the match value is copied to &$domain_data$&.
12750 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
12751 applied to the data read by a lookup.
12752 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
12754 If the router routes the
12755 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12756 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12759 &$domain_data$& set in an ACL is available during
12760 the rest of the ACL statement.
12762 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12763 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12764 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12766 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12767 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12768 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12770 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12771 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12772 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12774 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12775 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12776 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12777 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12778 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12779 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12780 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12782 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12784 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12785 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12786 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12787 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12788 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12790 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12791 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12792 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12793 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12794 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12798 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12799 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12800 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12801 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12802 by a setting on the transport itself.
12804 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12805 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12806 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12810 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12811 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12812 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12813 to local and remote transports.
12815 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12816 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12817 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12818 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12819 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12820 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12821 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12824 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12825 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12826 client is connected.
12829 .vitem &$host_address$&
12830 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12831 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12832 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12833 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12835 .vitem &$host_data$&
12836 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12837 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12838 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12839 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12841 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12842 message = $host_data
12845 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12846 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12847 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12848 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12849 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12850 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12851 variables is set to &"1"&.
12854 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12855 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12858 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12859 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12860 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12863 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12864 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12865 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12866 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12867 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12868 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12869 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12870 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12871 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12872 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12874 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12875 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12876 &%authresults%& expansion item.
12879 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12880 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12881 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12883 .vitem &$host_port$&
12884 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12885 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12886 for an outbound connection.
12888 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12889 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12890 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12891 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12892 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12893 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12896 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12897 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12898 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12899 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12900 a unique name for the file.
12902 .vitem &$interface_address$& &&&
12904 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12905 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12906 These are obsolete names for &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12910 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12911 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12912 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12916 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12917 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12918 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12921 .vitem &$load_average$&
12922 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12923 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12924 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12925 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12927 .tvar &$local_part$&
12928 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12929 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12930 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12931 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12933 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12934 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12935 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12936 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12939 .cindex "tainted data"
12940 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12941 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and
12942 may not be further expanded or used as a filename.
12944 &*Warning*&: the content of this variable is usually provided by a potential
12946 Consider carefully the implications of using it unvalidated as a name
12948 This presents issues for users' &_.forward_& and filter files.
12949 For traditional full user accounts, use &%check_local_users%& and the
12950 &$local_part_data$& variable rather than this one.
12951 For virtual users, store a suitable pathname component in the database
12952 which is used for account name validation, and use that retrieved value
12953 rather than this variable.
12954 Often &$local_part_data$& is usable in this role.
12955 If needed, use a router &%address_data%& or &%set%& option for
12956 the retrieved data.
12958 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12959 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12960 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12963 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12964 local part of the recipient address.
12966 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12967 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12968 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12970 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12973 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12974 abc\:xyz@test.example
12976 the value of &$local_part$& is
12980 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12981 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12984 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12986 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12987 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12988 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12990 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12991 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12992 When the &%local_parts%& condition on a router or ACL
12993 matches a local part list
12994 the match value is copied to &$local_part_data$&.
12995 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
12996 applied to the data read by a lookup.
12997 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
12999 The &%check_local_user%& router option also sets this variable.
13001 .vindex &$local_part_prefix$& &&&
13002 &$local_part_prefix_v$& &&&
13003 &$local_part_suffix$& &&&
13004 &$local_part_suffix_v$&
13005 .cindex affix variables
13006 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
13007 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
13008 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
13009 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
13010 .cindex "tainted data"
13011 If the specification did not include a wildcard then
13012 the affix variable value is not tainted.
13014 If the affix specification included a wildcard then the portion of
13015 the affix matched by the wildcard is in
13016 &$local_part_prefix_v$& or &$local_part_suffix_v$& as appropriate,
13017 and both the whole and varying values are tainted.
13019 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
13020 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
13021 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
13022 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
13024 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
13025 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
13026 See &$local_user_uid$&.
13028 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
13029 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
13030 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
13031 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
13032 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
13033 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
13034 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
13035 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
13037 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
13038 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
13039 This contains the expanded value of the
13040 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
13043 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
13044 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13045 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
13046 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
13047 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
13048 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
13050 .vitem &$log_space$&
13051 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13052 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
13053 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
13054 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
13055 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
13056 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
13059 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
13060 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
13061 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
13062 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
13063 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13064 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
13065 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
13066 and &"yes"& if it was.
13067 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
13068 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
13069 as authenticated data.
13071 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
13072 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
13073 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
13074 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
13075 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
13076 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
13077 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
13080 .vitem &$malware_name$&
13081 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
13082 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
13083 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
13084 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
13086 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
13087 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
13088 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
13089 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
13090 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
13091 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
13093 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
13095 .vitem &$message_age$&
13096 .cindex "message" "age of"
13097 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
13098 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
13099 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
13102 .tvar &$message_body$&
13103 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
13104 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
13105 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
13106 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
13107 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
13108 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
13109 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
13110 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
13112 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
13113 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
13114 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
13115 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
13116 zeros are always converted into spaces.
13118 .tvar &$message_body_end$&
13119 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
13120 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
13121 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
13122 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
13125 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
13126 .cindex "body of message" "size"
13127 .cindex "message body" "size"
13128 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
13129 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
13130 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
13131 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
13132 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
13134 If the spool file is wireformat
13135 (see the &%spool_wireformat%& main option)
13136 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
13138 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
13139 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
13140 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
13141 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
13142 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
13143 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
13144 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
13145 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
13147 .tvar &$message_headers$&
13148 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
13149 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
13150 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
13151 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
13153 .tvar &$message_headers_raw$&
13154 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
13155 contents of header lines is done.
13157 .vitem &$message_id$&
13158 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
13160 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
13161 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
13162 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
13163 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
13164 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
13165 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
13166 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
13167 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
13168 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
13169 from the body is not counted.
13171 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
13172 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
13173 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
13174 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
13175 header and the body).
13177 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
13180 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
13181 message = Too many lines in message header
13183 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
13184 message has not yet been received.
13186 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
13188 .vitem &$message_size$&
13189 .cindex "size" "of message"
13190 .cindex "message" "size"
13191 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
13192 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
13193 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
13194 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
13195 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
13196 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
13197 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
13198 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
13199 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
13201 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
13202 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
13203 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
13204 value may not, of course, be truthful.
13206 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
13207 &$mime_anomaly_text$& &&&
13208 &$mime_boundary$& &&&
13209 &$mime_charset$& &&&
13210 &$mime_content_description$& &&&
13211 &$mime_content_disposition$& &&&
13212 &$mime_content_id$& &&&
13213 &$mime_content_size$& &&&
13214 &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$& &&&
13215 &$mime_content_type$& &&&
13216 &$mime_decoded_filename$& &&&
13217 &$mime_filename$& &&&
13218 &$mime_is_coverletter$& &&&
13219 &$mime_is_multipart$& &&&
13220 &$mime_is_rfc822$& &&&
13221 &$mime_part_count$&
13222 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
13223 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
13224 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
13226 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
13227 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
13228 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
13230 .tvar &$original_domain$&
13231 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13232 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13233 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
13234 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
13235 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
13236 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
13237 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
13238 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
13240 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13241 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13242 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13244 .tvar &$original_local_part$&
13245 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13246 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13247 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
13248 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
13249 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
13250 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
13251 the original address.
13253 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
13254 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
13255 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
13256 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
13257 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
13259 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13260 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13261 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13263 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
13264 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
13265 .cindex "sender" "gid"
13266 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
13267 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
13268 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
13269 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
13270 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
13271 normally the gid of the Exim user.
13273 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
13274 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
13275 .cindex "sender" "uid"
13276 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
13277 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
13278 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
13279 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
13280 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
13283 .tvar &$parent_domain$&
13284 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
13285 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13287 .tvar &$parent_local_part$&
13288 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
13289 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13292 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
13294 This variable contains the current process id.
13296 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
13297 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
13298 .cindex "transport" "filter"
13299 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
13300 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
13301 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
13302 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
13303 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
13304 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
13305 variable"& error if encountered.
13306 &*Note*&: This value permits data supplied by a potential attacker to
13307 be used in the command for a &(pipe)& transport.
13308 Such configurations should be carefully assessed for security vulnerbilities.
13310 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
13311 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
13312 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
13313 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
13314 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
13315 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
13316 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
13319 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
13320 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
13321 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
13322 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
13324 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
13326 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
13328 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
13329 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
13330 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
13331 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
13333 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$& &&&
13334 &$prvscheck_keynum$& &&&
13335 &$prvscheck_result$&
13336 These variables are used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
13337 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
13338 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
13340 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
13341 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
13342 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
13344 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
13345 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
13346 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
13347 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
13349 .vitem &$queue_name$&
13350 .vindex &$queue_name$&
13351 .cindex "named queues" variable
13352 .cindex queues named
13353 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
13355 .vitem &$queue_size$&
13356 .vindex "&$queue_size$&"
13357 .cindex "queue" "size of"
13358 .cindex "spool" "number of messages"
13359 This variable contains the number of messages queued.
13360 It is evaluated on demand, but no more often than once every minute.
13361 If there is no daemon notifier socket open, the value will be
13366 .cindex router variables
13367 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
13368 They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
13369 The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
13370 and the eventual transport.
13372 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
13373 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
13374 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13375 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
13376 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
13378 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
13379 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
13380 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
13381 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13382 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13383 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
13385 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
13386 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
13387 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13388 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13389 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
13391 .vitem &$received_count$&
13392 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
13393 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
13394 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
13395 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
13398 .tvar &$received_for$&
13399 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
13400 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
13401 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
13402 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
13404 .vitem &$received_ip_address$& &&&
13406 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
13407 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
13408 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, these
13409 variables are set to the address and port on the local IP interface.
13410 (The remote IP address and port are in
13411 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
13412 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
13415 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
13416 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
13417 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
13418 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
13419 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
13421 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
13423 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
13424 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
13425 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
13426 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
13427 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
13428 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
13429 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
13430 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
13431 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
13433 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
13434 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
13435 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
13436 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
13437 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
13438 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
13440 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
13441 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
13442 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
13444 .vitem &$received_time$&
13445 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
13446 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
13447 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13449 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
13450 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
13451 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
13452 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
13453 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
13455 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13456 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
13458 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13459 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13460 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13461 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13463 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
13464 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
13465 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
13466 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
13469 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
13470 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
13473 &"route"&: Routing failed.
13476 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
13477 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
13481 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
13484 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
13487 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
13488 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
13490 .tvar &$recipients$&
13491 .tvar &$recipients_list$&
13492 These variables both contain the envelope recipients for a message.
13494 The first uses a comma and a space separate the addresses in the replacement text.
13495 &*Note*&: an address can legitimately contain a comma;
13496 this variable is not intended for further processing.
13498 The second is a proper Exim list; colon-separated.
13500 However, the variables
13501 are not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
13502 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use either of them only in these
13506 In a system filter file.
13508 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
13509 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
13510 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
13511 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
13513 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
13517 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
13518 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
13519 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
13520 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
13521 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
13522 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
13525 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
13526 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
13527 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
13528 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
13530 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
13531 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
13532 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
13533 these variables contain the
13534 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
13535 If the subject string was tainted then so will any captured substring.
13538 .tvar &$reply_address$&
13539 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
13540 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
13541 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
13542 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
13543 decoding or character code translation takes place.
13545 .vitem &$return_path$&
13546 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
13547 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
13548 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
13549 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
13550 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
13551 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
13552 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
13553 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
13554 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
13555 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
13558 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
13559 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
13560 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
13562 .vitem &$router_name$&
13563 .cindex "router" "name"
13564 .cindex "name" "of router"
13565 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
13566 During the running of a router, or a transport called,
13567 this variable contains the router name.
13570 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13571 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
13572 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13573 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13574 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13575 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13576 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13579 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
13580 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13581 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13582 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13583 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13584 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13585 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13586 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13588 .tvar &$sender_address$&
13589 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13590 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13591 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13592 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13594 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13595 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
13596 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13597 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13598 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13599 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13600 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13601 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13603 .tvar &$sender_address_domain$&
13604 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13606 .tvar &$sender_address_local_part$&
13607 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13609 .vitem &$sender_data$&
13610 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13611 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13612 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13613 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13616 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13617 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13619 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13620 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13621 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13622 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13624 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13625 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13626 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13627 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13628 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13629 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13630 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13631 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13632 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13633 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13634 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13635 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13636 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13638 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13639 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13640 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13641 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13642 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13644 .tvar &$sender_helo_name$&
13645 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13646 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13647 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13648 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13650 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13651 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13652 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13653 this variable contains that
13654 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13656 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13657 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13658 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13659 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13660 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13661 &$authenticated_id$&.
13663 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13664 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13665 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13666 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13667 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13668 resolver library states that both
13669 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13670 other times, this variable is false.
13672 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13673 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13674 library, by setting:
13679 In addition, on Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer the resolver library will
13680 default to stripping out a successful validation status.
13681 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
13682 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
13683 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
13684 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
13689 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13690 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13692 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13693 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13695 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13696 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13697 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13698 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13701 .tvar &$sender_host_name$&
13702 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13703 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13704 other means, this variable is empty.
13706 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13707 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13708 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13709 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13710 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13711 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13712 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13714 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13715 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13716 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13717 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13719 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13720 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13721 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13724 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13725 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13726 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13727 following are true:
13730 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13732 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13733 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13734 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13736 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13737 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13738 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13740 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13741 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13742 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13744 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13745 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13746 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13747 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13749 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13751 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13752 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13756 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13757 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13758 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13759 number that was used on the remote host.
13761 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13762 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13763 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13764 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13765 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13768 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13769 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13770 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13771 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13773 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13774 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13775 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13776 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13777 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13778 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13779 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13780 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13781 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13782 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13783 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13786 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13787 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13788 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13789 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13790 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13792 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13793 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13794 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13795 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13796 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13798 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13799 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13800 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13801 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13802 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13803 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13804 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13806 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13807 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13808 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13809 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13810 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13812 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13813 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13814 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13815 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13816 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13817 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13819 .tvar &$smtp_command$&
13820 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13821 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13822 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13827 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13828 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13829 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13830 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13832 .tvar &$smtp_command_argument$&
13833 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13834 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13835 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13836 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13837 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13839 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13840 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13841 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13842 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13843 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13846 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13847 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13848 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13849 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13850 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13851 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13852 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13853 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13854 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13855 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13856 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13858 .vitem &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
13859 .vindex "&$smtp_notquit_reason$&"
13860 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, this variable is set to a string
13861 that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP connection.
13863 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13864 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13865 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13866 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13867 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13868 message is junk mail.
13870 .vitem &$spam_score$& &&&
13871 &$spam_score_int$& &&&
13873 &$spam_report$& &&&
13875 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13876 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13877 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13879 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13880 &$spf_received$& &&&
13882 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13883 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13884 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13885 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13887 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13888 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13889 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13891 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13892 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13893 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13894 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13895 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13896 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13898 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13899 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13900 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13901 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13902 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13903 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13904 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13905 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13907 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13909 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13912 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13913 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13914 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13915 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13916 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13917 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13919 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13920 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13921 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13922 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13923 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13924 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13925 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13926 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13928 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13929 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13932 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13933 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13934 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13935 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13936 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13937 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13939 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13940 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13941 .cindex certificate variables
13942 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13943 inbound connection when the message was received.
13944 It is only useful as the argument of a
13945 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13946 or a &%def%& condition.
13948 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13949 when a list of more than one
13950 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13951 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
13953 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13954 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13955 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13956 inbound connection when the message was received.
13957 It is only useful as the argument of a
13958 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13959 or a &%def%& condition.
13960 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13961 which is not the leaf.
13963 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13964 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13965 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13966 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13967 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13968 or a &%def%& condition.
13970 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13971 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13972 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13973 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13974 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13975 or a &%def%& condition.
13976 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13977 which is not the leaf.
13979 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13980 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13981 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13982 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13984 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13985 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13988 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13989 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13990 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13991 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13992 and &"0"& otherwise.
13994 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13995 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13996 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13997 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13998 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13999 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
14000 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
14001 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
14002 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
14004 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
14005 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
14006 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
14008 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
14009 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
14010 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
14012 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
14013 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
14015 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
14016 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
14017 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
14018 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
14020 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
14021 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
14022 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
14024 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
14025 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
14026 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
14028 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
14029 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
14030 When a message is received from a remote client connection
14031 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
14033 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
14034 1 No response to request
14035 2 Response not verified
14036 3 Verification failed
14037 4 Verification succeeded
14040 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
14041 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
14042 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
14043 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
14044 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
14046 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
14047 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
14048 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
14049 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
14050 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
14051 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
14052 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
14053 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
14054 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14055 which is not the leaf.
14057 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
14058 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14061 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
14062 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
14063 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
14064 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
14065 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
14066 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
14067 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14068 which is not the leaf.
14071 .vitem &$tls_in_resumption$& &&&
14072 &$tls_out_resumption$&
14073 .vindex &$tls_in_resumption$&
14074 .vindex &$tls_out_resumption$&
14075 .cindex TLS resumption
14076 Observability for TLS session resumption. See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
14079 .tvar &$tls_in_sni$&
14080 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
14081 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
14083 .cindex SNI "observability on server"
14084 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
14085 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
14086 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
14087 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
14088 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
14089 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
14090 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
14092 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
14093 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14096 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
14097 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
14098 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
14100 .cindex SNI "observability in client"
14102 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
14105 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
14106 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
14107 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
14109 .vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
14110 .vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
14111 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
14112 this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
14114 .vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
14115 .vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
14116 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
14117 this variable is set to the protocol version.
14120 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
14121 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
14122 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
14123 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
14125 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
14126 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
14127 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
14129 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
14130 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
14131 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
14133 .vitem &$tod_full$&
14134 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
14135 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
14136 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
14137 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
14138 values for those that are behind (west).
14141 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14142 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
14143 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
14145 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
14146 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
14147 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
14148 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
14151 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
14152 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14153 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
14156 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
14157 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
14158 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
14159 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
14161 .vitem &$transport_name$&
14162 .cindex "transport" "name"
14163 .cindex "name" "of transport"
14164 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
14165 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
14168 .vindex "&$value$&"
14169 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
14170 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
14171 &*reduce*& expansion.
14173 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
14174 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
14175 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
14176 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
14179 .vitem &$version_number$&
14180 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
14181 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
14182 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
14184 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
14185 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
14186 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
14187 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
14189 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
14190 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
14191 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
14192 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
14198 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14199 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14201 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
14202 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
14203 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
14204 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
14205 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
14206 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
14211 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
14214 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
14215 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
14216 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
14217 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
14218 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
14219 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
14220 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
14221 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
14222 a newly created Perl interpreter.
14224 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
14225 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
14226 should usually be something like
14228 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
14230 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
14231 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
14232 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
14233 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
14234 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
14235 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
14236 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
14237 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
14241 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
14242 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
14243 a startup when Exim is entered.
14245 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
14246 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
14249 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
14250 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
14253 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
14254 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
14255 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
14256 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
14257 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
14258 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
14261 &*Note*&: This is entirely separate from Exim's tainted-data tracking.
14264 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
14265 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
14266 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
14267 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
14271 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
14272 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
14274 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
14275 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
14276 with an error message of the form
14278 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
14280 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
14281 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
14282 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
14283 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
14284 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
14285 that was passed to &%die%&.
14288 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
14289 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
14290 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
14293 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
14295 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
14296 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
14297 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
14299 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
14300 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
14301 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
14302 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
14304 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
14305 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
14306 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
14307 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
14308 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
14309 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
14310 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
14313 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
14314 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
14315 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
14316 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
14317 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
14318 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
14319 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
14320 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
14321 avoided, but the output is lost.
14323 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
14324 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
14325 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
14326 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
14327 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
14328 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
14329 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
14331 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
14333 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
14334 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
14335 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
14336 as the first subroutine argument.
14340 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14341 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14343 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
14344 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
14345 "Starting the daemon"
14346 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
14347 .cindex "interface" "listening"
14348 .cindex "network interface"
14349 .cindex "interface" "network"
14350 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
14351 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
14352 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
14353 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14354 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
14355 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
14356 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
14357 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
14358 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
14359 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
14360 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
14363 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
14364 and ports to listen on.
14366 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
14367 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
14368 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
14369 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
14370 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
14371 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
14372 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
14373 as an error situation.
14375 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
14376 for the outgoing connection.
14380 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
14381 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
14382 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
14383 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
14384 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
14386 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
14387 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
14388 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
14389 chapter describes how they operate.
14391 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
14392 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
14396 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
14397 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
14398 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
14402 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
14404 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
14406 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
14407 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
14410 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
14411 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
14412 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
14413 colons. For example:
14415 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
14418 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
14420 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
14421 in &%local_interfaces%&:
14424 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
14425 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
14427 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
14428 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
14431 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
14432 with a colon separator, for example:
14434 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
14435 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
14439 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
14440 default setting contains just one port:
14442 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14444 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
14445 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
14446 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
14447 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
14448 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
14452 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
14453 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
14454 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
14455 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
14456 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
14457 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14459 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14461 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
14463 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14465 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
14469 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
14470 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
14471 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
14472 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
14473 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
14474 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
14477 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
14478 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
14479 If there are any items that do not
14480 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
14481 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
14482 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14483 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
14487 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
14490 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
14492 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
14493 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
14494 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
14498 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
14499 .cindex "submissions protocol"
14500 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
14501 .cindex "smtps protocol"
14502 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
14503 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
14504 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
14505 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
14506 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
14507 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
14508 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
14509 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
14510 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
14513 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
14514 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
14515 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
14517 The common use of this option is expected to be
14519 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
14522 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
14523 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
14525 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
14526 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
14527 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
14528 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
14529 connections via the daemon.)
14534 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
14535 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
14536 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
14537 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
14538 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
14539 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
14540 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
14541 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
14543 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
14545 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
14546 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
14547 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
14548 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
14549 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
14550 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
14552 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
14554 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
14555 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
14556 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
14557 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
14558 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
14560 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
14561 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14562 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
14563 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
14564 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
14565 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
14566 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
14567 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14568 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14569 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
14570 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14571 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14573 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
14574 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
14575 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
14576 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
14577 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
14581 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
14582 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
14584 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14585 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14587 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
14588 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
14589 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
14590 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
14592 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
14594 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14596 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14598 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14599 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14601 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14602 IPv4 loopback address only:
14604 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14606 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14608 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14610 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14614 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14615 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14616 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14617 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14620 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14621 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14622 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14623 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14625 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14626 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14627 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14628 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14629 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14630 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14631 used for listening. Consider this example:
14633 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14635 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14637 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14639 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14640 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14643 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14644 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14645 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14646 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14647 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14648 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14649 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14650 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14654 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14655 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14656 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14657 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14658 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14659 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14665 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14666 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14668 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14669 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14670 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14671 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14674 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14675 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14677 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14678 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14679 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14681 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14682 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14683 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14684 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14688 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14689 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14690 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14691 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14692 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14693 listed in more than one group.
14695 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14697 .row &%add_environment%& "environment variables"
14698 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14699 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14700 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14701 .row &%keep_environment%& "environment variables"
14702 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14703 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14704 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14705 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14706 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14707 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14708 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14709 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14713 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14715 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14716 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14717 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14718 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14719 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14720 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14725 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14727 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14728 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14729 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14730 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14731 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14732 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14733 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14734 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14735 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14736 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14737 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14738 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14743 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14745 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14746 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14747 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14748 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14749 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14750 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14751 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14752 .row &%panic_coredump%& "request coredump on fatal errors"
14753 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14754 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14755 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14756 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14757 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14758 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14759 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14760 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14765 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14767 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14768 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14769 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14770 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14775 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14777 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14778 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14779 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14780 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14781 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14782 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14783 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14784 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14785 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14786 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14787 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14788 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14789 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14790 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14791 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14796 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14798 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14799 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14804 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14806 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14807 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14808 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14813 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14815 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14816 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14817 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14818 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14819 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14820 .row &%notifier_socket%& "override compiled-in value"
14821 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14822 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14823 .row &%smtp_backlog_monitor%& "level to log listen backlog"
14828 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14830 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14831 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14832 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14833 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14834 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14835 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14836 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14837 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14838 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14839 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14840 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14841 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14842 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14843 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14844 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14845 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14847 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14848 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14849 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14850 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14851 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14856 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14858 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14859 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14860 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14861 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14862 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14863 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14864 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14865 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14866 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14867 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14868 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14869 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14870 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14871 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14872 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14873 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14874 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14875 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14876 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14877 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14878 .row &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& "ACL for WELLKNOWN"
14879 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14880 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14882 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14883 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14884 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14885 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14886 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14887 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14888 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14889 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14890 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14891 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14892 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14893 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14894 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14895 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14896 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14897 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14898 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14899 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14900 .row &%proxy_protocol_timeout%& "timeout for proxy protocol negotiation"
14901 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14902 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14903 .row &%spf_smtp_comment_template%& "template for &$spf_smtp_comment$&"
14908 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14910 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14912 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14914 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14915 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14916 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14921 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14923 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14924 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14925 .row &%hosts_require_alpn%& "mandatory ALPN"
14926 .row &%hosts_require_helo%& "mandatory HELO/EHLO"
14927 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14928 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14929 .row &%tls_alpn%& "acceptable protocol names"
14930 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14931 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14932 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14933 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14934 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14935 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14936 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14937 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14938 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14939 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14940 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14941 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14942 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14947 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14949 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14950 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14951 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14952 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14953 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14954 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14955 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14956 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14961 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14963 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14964 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14965 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14966 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14967 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14968 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14969 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14970 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14976 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14978 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14985 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14986 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14989 .row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14990 .row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14991 .row &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%& "DKIM key sizes accepted for signatures"
14992 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14993 .row &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& "DMARC sender for report messages"
14994 .row &%dmarc_history_file%& "DMARC results log"
14995 .row &%dmarc_tld_file%& "DMARC toplevel domains file"
14996 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14997 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14998 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14999 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
15000 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
15001 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
15002 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
15003 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
15004 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
15005 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
15006 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
15007 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
15008 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
15009 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
15011 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
15012 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
15013 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
15014 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
15015 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
15016 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
15017 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
15018 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
15019 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
15020 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
15021 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
15022 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
15023 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
15024 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
15025 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
15026 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
15031 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
15033 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
15034 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
15035 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
15036 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
15037 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
15038 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
15039 .row &%limits_advertise_hosts%& "advertise LIMITS to these hosts"
15040 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
15041 .row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
15042 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
15043 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
15044 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
15045 .row &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%& "advertise WELLKNOWN to these hosts"
15050 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
15052 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
15053 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
15054 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
15055 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
15057 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15058 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15059 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
15060 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
15061 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
15062 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
15063 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15064 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
15065 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
15066 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
15071 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
15073 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
15074 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
15076 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
15077 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
15078 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
15079 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
15080 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
15085 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
15087 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
15088 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
15089 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
15090 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
15091 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
15092 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
15093 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
15094 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
15095 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
15096 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
15097 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
15098 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
15099 .row &%queue_fast_ramp%& "parallel delivery with 2-phase queue run"
15100 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
15101 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
15102 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
15103 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
15104 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
15105 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
15106 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
15107 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
15108 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
15109 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
15110 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
15111 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
15116 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
15118 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
15119 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
15120 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
15121 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
15122 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
15123 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
15124 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
15125 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
15126 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
15127 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
15128 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
15129 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
15130 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
15131 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
15132 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
15137 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
15138 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
15141 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
15143 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15144 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15145 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
15146 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" 8BITMIME
15147 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
15148 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
15149 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
15150 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
15152 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
15153 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
15154 It now defaults to true.
15155 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
15157 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
15160 To log received 8BITMIME status use
15162 log_selector = +8bitmime
15165 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
15166 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
15167 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
15168 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
15169 read and is on the point of being accepted. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for
15172 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
15173 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
15174 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
15177 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
15178 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
15179 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
15180 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
15181 non-SMTP message. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for further details.
15183 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
15184 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
15185 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
15186 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
15188 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs, and chapter
15189 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
15191 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
15192 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
15193 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
15194 See section &<<SECconnectACL>>& for further details.
15196 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
15197 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
15198 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
15199 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
15200 acknowledgment is sent. See section &<<SECdataACLS>>& for further details.
15202 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
15203 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
15204 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
15205 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
15206 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
15207 This option defines the ACL that,
15208 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
15209 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
15210 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
15211 acknowledgment is sent. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>& for further details.
15213 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
15214 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
15215 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
15216 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
15217 of a received message.
15218 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
15220 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
15221 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
15222 .cindex "ETRN" advertisement
15223 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
15225 If no value is set then the ETRN facility is not advertised.
15226 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15228 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
15229 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
15230 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
15231 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15233 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
15234 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
15235 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
15236 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
15237 command is received. See section &<<SECheloACL>>& for further details.
15240 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
15241 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
15242 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
15243 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15245 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
15246 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
15247 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
15249 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs, and chapter
15250 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
15252 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
15253 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
15254 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
15255 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
15256 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
15258 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
15259 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
15260 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
15261 ends without a QUIT command being received.
15262 See section &<<SECTNOTQUITACL>>& for further details.
15264 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
15265 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
15266 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
15269 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
15270 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
15271 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
15272 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15274 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
15275 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
15276 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
15277 received. See section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& for further details.
15279 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
15280 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
15281 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
15282 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15284 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
15285 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
15286 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
15287 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15289 .option acl_smtp_wellknown main string&!! unset
15290 .cindex "WELLKNOWN, ACL for"
15291 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP WELLKNOWN command is
15292 received. See section &<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>& for further details.
15294 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
15295 .cindex "environment" "set values"
15296 This option adds individual environment variables that the
15297 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes may use.
15298 Each list element should be of the form &"name=value"&.
15300 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
15302 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15303 .cindex "admin user"
15304 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
15305 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
15306 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
15307 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
15308 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
15309 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
15310 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
15312 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
15313 .cindex "domain literal"
15314 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
15315 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
15316 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
15317 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
15319 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
15320 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
15321 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
15322 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
15323 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
15324 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
15325 the local host's IP addresses.
15327 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
15328 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
15329 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
15330 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
15331 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
15332 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
15333 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
15334 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
15335 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
15337 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
15338 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
15339 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
15340 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
15341 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
15342 that at least two other MTAs permit this.
15343 This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
15345 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
15346 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
15347 letters, digits, and hyphens.
15349 If Exim is built with internationalization support
15350 and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
15351 this option can be left as default.
15353 if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
15354 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
15355 suitable setting is:
15357 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
15358 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
15360 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
15362 dns_check_names_pattern =
15364 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
15367 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15368 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
15369 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
15370 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
15371 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
15372 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
15373 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
15374 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
15375 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
15376 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
15377 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
15378 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
15380 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
15381 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
15382 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
15383 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
15384 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
15385 which Exim advertises AUTH.
15387 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
15388 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
15389 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
15390 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
15392 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
15394 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
15395 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
15396 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
15397 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
15400 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
15401 .cindex "thawing messages"
15402 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
15403 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
15404 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
15405 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
15406 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
15407 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
15409 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
15410 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
15411 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
15414 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
15415 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
15416 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
15418 sophie:/var/run/sophie
15420 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
15421 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
15424 .option bi_command main string unset
15426 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
15427 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
15428 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
15429 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
15432 .option bounce_message_file main string&!! unset
15433 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
15434 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
15435 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15436 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
15437 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
15438 .cindex bounce_message_file "tainted data"
15439 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
15440 absolute and untainted.
15441 See also &%warn_message_file%&.
15444 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
15445 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
15446 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
15447 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
15449 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
15450 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
15451 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
15452 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
15453 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
15454 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
15455 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
15456 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
15457 point at which the error was detected are returned.
15458 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
15460 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
15461 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
15462 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
15463 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
15464 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
15465 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
15466 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
15467 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
15468 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
15469 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
15471 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
15472 during reception of a message.
15473 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
15475 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
15478 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
15479 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
15480 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
15481 &%bounce_return_body%&.
15484 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
15485 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
15486 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
15487 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
15488 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
15489 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
15490 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
15491 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
15492 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
15494 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
15495 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
15496 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
15497 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
15498 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
15501 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
15502 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
15503 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
15504 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
15505 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
15506 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
15507 connection. A typical setting might be:
15509 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15511 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
15513 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15515 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
15518 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
15519 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
15520 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
15521 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
15522 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15523 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15526 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
15527 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
15528 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15529 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15532 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
15533 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
15534 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15535 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15538 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
15539 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
15540 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15541 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15544 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
15545 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
15546 callout verification. The default value is
15548 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
15550 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
15553 .options check_log_inodes main integer 100 &&&
15554 check_log_space main integer 10M
15555 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15557 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
15558 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
15559 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
15560 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
15561 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
15562 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
15563 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
15564 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
15565 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
15566 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
15569 .options check_spool_inodes main integer 100 &&&
15570 check_spool_space main integer 10M
15571 .cindex "checking disk space"
15572 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15573 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15574 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
15575 message is accepted.
15577 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
15578 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
15579 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
15580 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
15581 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
15582 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
15583 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
15584 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
15587 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
15588 either value is greater than zero, for example:
15590 check_spool_space = 100M
15591 check_spool_inodes = 100
15593 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
15594 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
15597 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
15598 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
15599 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
15601 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
15602 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
15603 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
15604 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
15605 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
15606 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
15608 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
15609 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
15610 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
15612 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
15613 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
15614 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
15616 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
15617 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
15618 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
15619 may wish to deliberately disable them.
15621 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15622 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15623 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15624 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" CHUNKING
15625 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
15627 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15629 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15630 .cindex "restricting access to features"
15631 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15632 administrative user.
15633 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15635 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15636 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15637 .cindex memory debugging
15638 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15639 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15640 it should normally be left as default.
15642 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15643 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
15644 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15645 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15646 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15647 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15649 .options daemon_startup_retries main integer 9 &&&
15650 daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15651 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15652 These options control the retrying done by
15653 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15654 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15655 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15656 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15658 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15659 .cindex "warning of delay"
15660 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15661 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15662 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15663 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15664 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15665 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15666 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15667 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15670 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15672 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15673 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15674 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15675 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15679 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15680 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15682 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15684 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15685 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15686 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15688 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15689 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15690 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15691 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15692 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15693 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15694 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15695 not sent. The default is:
15697 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15698 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15699 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15700 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15703 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15704 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15705 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15706 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15708 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15709 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15710 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15711 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15712 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15713 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15714 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15715 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15717 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15718 .cindex "load average"
15719 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15720 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15721 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15722 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15723 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15726 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15727 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15728 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15729 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15730 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15731 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15732 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15733 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15735 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15736 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15737 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15738 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15739 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15740 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15741 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15742 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15744 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15745 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15746 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15747 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15750 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15751 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15752 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15753 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15754 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15755 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15756 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15759 .option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512"
15760 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15761 This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15762 and an order of processing.
15763 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15765 Acceptable values include:
15772 Note that the acceptance of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15774 .option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15775 This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15776 and an order of processing.
15777 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15780 .option dkim_verify_min_keysizes main "string list" "rsa=1024 ed25519=250"
15781 This option gives a list of key sizes which are acceptable in signatures.
15782 The list is keyed by the algorithm type for the key; the values are in bits.
15783 Signatures with keys smaller than given by this option will fail verification.
15785 The default enforces the RFC 8301 minimum key size for RSA signatures.
15787 .option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15788 If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15791 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15792 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15793 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15794 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15795 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15796 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15799 .options dmarc_forensic_sender main string&!! unset &&&
15800 dmarc_history_file main string unset &&&
15801 dmarc_tld_file main string unset
15802 .cindex DMARC "main section options"
15803 These options control DMARC processing.
15804 See section &<<SECDMARC>>& for details.
15807 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15808 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15809 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15810 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15811 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15812 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15813 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15814 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15815 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15816 by a setting such as this:
15818 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15820 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does,
15821 except for TLSA lookups (where knowing about such failures
15822 is security-relevant).
15823 It also applies when the
15824 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15825 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15826 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15827 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15828 options are applied after this global option.
15830 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15831 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15832 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15833 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15834 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15835 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15836 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15837 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15838 value of this option. The default pattern is
15840 dns_check_names_pattern = \
15841 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15843 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15844 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15845 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15846 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15847 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15850 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15851 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15852 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15854 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15855 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15856 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15857 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15859 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15860 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15861 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15862 not do it internally.
15863 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15864 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15866 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15867 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15868 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15871 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15872 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15873 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15874 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15875 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15876 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15878 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15880 On Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer this is insufficient, the resolver library
15881 will default to stripping out a successful validation status.
15882 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
15883 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
15884 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
15885 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
15891 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15892 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15893 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15894 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15895 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15896 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15897 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15898 domain matches this list.
15900 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15901 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15902 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15903 Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15904 this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15905 only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15908 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
15909 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15910 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15911 .cindex "DNS" timeout
15912 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15913 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15914 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15915 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15916 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15917 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15918 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15919 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15921 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15924 .option dns_retry main integer 0
15925 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15928 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15929 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15930 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15931 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15932 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15933 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15934 match with this expanded domain list.
15936 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15937 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15938 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15939 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15940 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15941 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15943 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15944 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15945 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15947 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15948 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15949 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15950 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15951 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15953 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15954 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15955 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15956 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15957 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15958 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15959 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15960 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15963 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15965 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15966 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15967 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15970 .option drop_cr main boolean false
15971 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15972 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15973 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15975 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15976 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15977 .cindex "DSN" "success"
15978 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15979 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" DSN
15980 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15981 and accepted from, these hosts.
15982 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ORCPT options on RCPT TO commands,
15983 and RET and ENVID options on MAIL FROM commands.
15984 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15985 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15987 &*Note*&: Supplying success-DSN messages has been criticised
15988 on privacy grounds; it can leak details of internal forwarding.
15990 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15991 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15992 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15993 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15994 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15995 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15997 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15999 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
16000 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
16002 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
16003 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
16004 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
16005 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
16006 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
16007 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
16008 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
16009 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
16010 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
16013 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
16014 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
16015 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
16016 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
16017 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
16018 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
16019 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
16020 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
16021 must be enclosed in double quotes.
16023 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
16024 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
16025 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
16026 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
16027 are examined. For example:
16029 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
16030 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
16031 postmaster@mydomain.example
16033 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16034 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16035 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
16036 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
16037 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
16038 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
16039 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
16042 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
16043 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
16044 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
16046 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
16048 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
16049 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
16050 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
16051 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
16052 overrides the default.
16054 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
16055 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
16056 and warning messages. For example:
16058 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
16060 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
16061 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
16062 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
16063 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
16067 .option event_action main string&!! unset
16069 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
16070 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
16073 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
16074 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
16075 .cindex "Exim group"
16076 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
16077 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
16078 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
16079 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
16080 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
16084 .option exim_path main string "see below"
16085 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
16086 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
16087 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
16088 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
16089 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
16091 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
16092 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
16093 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
16094 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
16097 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
16098 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
16099 .cindex "Exim user"
16100 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
16101 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
16102 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
16103 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
16105 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
16106 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
16107 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
16108 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
16111 .option exim_version main string "current version"
16112 .cindex "Exim version"
16113 .cindex customizing "version number"
16114 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
16115 This option overrides the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& that Exim reports in
16116 various places. Use with care; this may fool stupid security scanners.
16119 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
16120 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
16121 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
16122 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
16125 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16126 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16128 . .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments"
16129 . but apparently this results in searchability problems; bug 1197
16131 .option extract_addresses_remove_arguments main boolean true
16133 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
16134 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
16135 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
16136 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
16137 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
16138 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
16139 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
16140 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
16141 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
16142 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
16146 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
16147 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
16148 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
16149 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
16150 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
16151 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
16152 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
16153 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
16156 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
16157 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
16158 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
16159 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
16163 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
16164 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
16165 .cindex "frozen messages" "sending a message when freezing"
16166 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
16167 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
16168 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
16169 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
16170 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
16171 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
16172 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
16173 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
16174 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
16175 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
16176 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
16177 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
16178 logging that you require.
16181 .options gecos_name main string&!! unset &&&
16182 gecos_pattern main string unset
16184 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
16185 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
16186 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
16187 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
16188 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
16189 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
16190 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
16191 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
16193 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
16194 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
16195 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
16198 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
16199 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
16200 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
16201 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
16203 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
16208 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
16209 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
16210 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
16211 implementations of TLS.
16214 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
16215 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
16216 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
16219 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
16224 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
16225 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
16226 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
16227 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
16228 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
16229 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
16233 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
16234 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
16235 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
16236 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
16237 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
16238 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
16239 sections are rejected.
16242 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
16243 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
16244 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
16245 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
16246 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
16247 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
16248 zero means &"no limit"&.
16253 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16254 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
16255 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
16256 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
16257 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
16258 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
16259 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
16260 if you want to do semantic checking.
16261 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
16265 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
16266 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
16267 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
16268 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
16269 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
16270 non-ip-literal EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
16271 hyphens, and dots. For examplem if you really must allow underscores,
16274 helo_allow_chars = _
16276 This option does not apply to names that look like ip-literals.
16277 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
16280 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
16281 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16282 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16283 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
16284 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
16285 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
16286 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
16290 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16291 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
16292 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
16293 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
16294 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
16295 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
16296 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
16297 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
16298 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
16299 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
16300 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
16301 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
16303 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
16304 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
16305 EHLO command either:
16308 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
16310 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
16311 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
16312 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
16313 calling host address, or
16315 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
16318 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
16319 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
16320 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
16322 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
16323 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
16324 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
16326 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16327 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
16328 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
16329 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
16330 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
16331 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
16332 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
16333 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
16334 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
16337 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16338 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
16339 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
16340 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
16341 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
16342 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
16343 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
16344 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
16345 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
16347 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
16348 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
16349 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
16350 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
16351 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
16353 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
16354 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
16355 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
16356 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
16359 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
16360 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
16361 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
16362 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
16363 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
16364 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
16365 default configuration file contains
16369 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
16370 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
16372 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
16373 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
16374 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
16376 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
16377 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
16378 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
16379 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
16380 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
16381 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
16384 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
16385 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
16386 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
16387 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
16388 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
16391 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
16392 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
16393 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
16394 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
16398 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
16399 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
16400 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
16401 as soon as the connection is made.
16402 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
16403 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
16404 connections immediately.
16406 If the connection is on a TLS-on-connect port then the TCP connection is
16407 just dropped. Otherwise, an SMTP error is sent first.
16409 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
16410 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
16411 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
16412 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
16413 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
16416 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
16417 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
16418 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
16419 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
16420 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
16421 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
16422 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
16423 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
16424 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
16426 hosts_connection_nolog = :
16428 The hosts affected by this option also do not log "no MAIL in SMTP connection"
16429 lines, as may commonly be produced by a monitoring system.
16432 .option hosts_require_alpn main "host list&!!" unset
16433 .cindex ALPN "require negotiation in server"
16435 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
16436 If the TLS library supports ALPN
16437 then a successful negotiation of ALPN will be required for any client
16438 matching the list, for TLS to be used.
16439 See also the &%tls_alpn%& option.
16441 &*Note*&: prevention of fallback to in-clear connection is not
16442 managed by this option, and should be done separately.
16445 .option hosts_require_helo main "host list&!!" *
16446 .cindex "HELO/EHLO" requiring
16447 Exim will require an accepted HELO or EHLO command from a host matching
16448 this list, before accepting a MAIL command.
16451 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
16452 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
16453 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
16454 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
16457 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
16458 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
16459 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
16460 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
16461 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
16463 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
16464 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
16466 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
16467 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
16468 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
16469 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
16470 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
16471 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
16472 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
16475 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
16476 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
16477 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
16478 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16479 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
16483 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
16484 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
16485 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
16486 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
16487 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
16488 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
16490 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
16491 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
16492 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
16493 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
16494 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
16495 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
16496 for frozen messages. For example,
16498 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
16500 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
16501 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
16502 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
16503 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
16504 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
16505 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
16508 .options ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset &&&
16509 ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
16510 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16511 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16512 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
16513 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
16514 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
16515 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
16516 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
16517 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
16518 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
16522 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
16523 .cindex "environment" "values from"
16524 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
16525 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
16526 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
16527 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
16528 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
16529 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
16530 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
16532 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
16533 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
16535 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
16536 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
16537 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
16538 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
16540 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
16541 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
16542 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
16545 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
16546 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
16547 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
16551 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
16552 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
16553 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
16554 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
16558 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
16559 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
16560 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
16561 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
16562 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16563 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16564 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16565 and constrained to be a directory.
16568 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
16569 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
16570 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16571 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
16572 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16573 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16574 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16575 and constrained to be a file.
16578 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
16579 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
16580 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16581 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
16582 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16583 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
16586 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
16587 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
16588 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
16589 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
16590 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16591 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
16592 identity to be proven.
16595 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
16596 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
16597 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
16598 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
16599 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
16602 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
16603 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
16604 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
16605 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
16606 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
16610 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
16611 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
16612 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
16613 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
16614 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
16615 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
16619 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
16620 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
16621 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
16622 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
16623 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
16625 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
16626 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
16627 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
16630 .option ldap_version main integer unset
16631 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
16632 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
16633 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
16634 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
16635 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
16636 has been built with LDAP support.
16640 .option limits_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16641 .cindex LIMITS "suppressing advertising"
16642 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
16643 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16644 LIMITS extension (RFC 9422) to specific hosts.
16645 If permitted, Exim as a server will advertise in the EHLO response
16646 the limit for RCPT commands set by the &%recipients_max%& option (if it is set)
16647 and the limit for MAIL commands set by the &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%&
16650 .option local_from_check main boolean true
16651 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
16652 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
16653 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16654 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
16655 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
16656 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
16658 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
16659 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
16660 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16662 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
16663 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
16664 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
16665 and the default qualify domain.
16667 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
16668 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
16669 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
16670 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
16672 .cindex "envelope from"
16673 .cindex "envelope sender"
16674 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
16675 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
16676 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
16678 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
16679 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
16680 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16685 .options local_from_prefix main string unset &&&
16686 local_from_suffix main string unset
16687 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16688 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16689 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16690 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16691 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16692 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16695 local_from_prefix = *-
16697 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16699 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16701 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16702 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16706 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16707 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16708 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16709 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16710 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16711 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16712 &%local_interfaces%& is
16714 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16716 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16718 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16721 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16722 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16723 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16724 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16725 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16726 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16727 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16728 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16732 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16733 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16734 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16735 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16736 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16737 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16738 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16739 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16744 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16745 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16746 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16747 .cindex multiple "systems sharing a spool"
16748 .cindex "multiple hosts" "sharing a spool"
16749 .cindex "shared spool directory"
16750 .cindex "spool directory" sharing
16751 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16752 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16753 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required
16754 (eg. because they share a spool directory),
16755 each host must set a different
16756 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16757 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16758 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16759 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16760 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16761 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number%& is set, the final four
16762 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16763 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16764 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16768 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16769 .cindex "log" "file path for"
16770 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16771 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16772 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16773 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16774 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16775 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16776 A path must start with a slash.
16777 To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16778 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16779 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16780 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16781 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16782 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16783 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16784 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16787 .option log_selector main string unset
16788 .cindex "log" "selectors"
16789 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16790 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16791 minus characters. For example:
16793 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16795 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16796 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16799 .option log_timezone main boolean false
16800 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16801 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16802 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16803 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16804 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16805 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16806 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16807 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16808 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16809 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16810 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16811 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16814 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16815 .cindex "too many open files"
16816 .cindex "open files, too many"
16817 .cindex "file" "too many open"
16818 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16819 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16820 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16821 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16822 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16823 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16824 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16825 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16826 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16827 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16828 &%lookup_open_max%&.
16831 .option max_username_length main integer 0
16832 .cindex "length of login name"
16833 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16834 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
16835 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16836 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16837 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16838 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16841 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
16842 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16843 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16844 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16845 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16846 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16847 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16848 option is set true, this no longer happens.
16851 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
16852 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16853 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
16854 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16855 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16856 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16857 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16860 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16861 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16862 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16863 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16864 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16865 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16866 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16867 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16868 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16869 empty string, the option is ignored.
16872 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16873 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16874 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16875 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16876 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16877 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16878 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16879 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16880 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16881 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16882 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16883 colons will become hyphens.
16886 .option message_logs main boolean true
16887 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16888 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16889 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16890 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16891 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16892 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16893 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16894 which is not affected by this option.
16897 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16898 .cindex "message" "size limit"
16899 .cindex "limit" "message size"
16900 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16901 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16902 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16903 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16904 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16905 optionally followed by K or M.
16907 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
16908 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
16909 If nonzero the value will be advertised as a parameter to the ESMTP SIZE
16910 service extension keyword.
16912 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16913 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16914 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16915 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16916 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16918 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16919 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16920 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16921 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16922 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16923 message that an individual transport can process.
16925 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16926 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16927 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16928 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16929 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16930 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16931 some problems may result.
16933 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16934 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16935 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16938 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16939 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16940 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16942 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16944 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16945 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16946 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16947 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16948 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16951 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16952 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16953 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16954 contains a full description of this facility.
16958 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16959 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16960 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16961 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16962 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16965 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16966 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16967 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16968 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16969 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16972 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16973 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16974 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16975 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16976 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16978 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16979 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16982 never_users = root:daemon:bin
16984 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16985 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16989 .option notifier_socket main string "$spool_directory/exim_daemon_notify"
16990 This option gives the name for a unix-domain socket on which the daemon
16991 listens for work and information-requests.
16992 Only installations running multiple daemons sharing a spool directory
16993 should need to modify the default.
16995 The option is expanded before use.
16996 If the platform supports Linux-style abstract socket names, the result
16997 is used with a nul byte prefixed.
16999 it should be a full path name and use a directory accessible
17002 If this option is set as empty,
17003 or the command line &%-oY%& option is used, or
17004 the command line uses a &%-oX%& option and does not use &%-oP%&,
17005 then a notifier socket is not created.
17008 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
17009 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
17010 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
17011 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
17012 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
17014 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
17015 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
17016 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
17017 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
17018 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
17019 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
17020 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
17022 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
17023 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
17024 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
17025 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
17026 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
17028 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
17030 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
17031 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
17032 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
17033 some now infamous attacks.
17037 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
17038 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
17039 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
17041 # Disable older protocol versions:
17042 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
17045 Possible options may include:
17049 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
17051 &`cipher_server_preference`&
17053 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
17057 &`legacy_server_connect`&
17059 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
17061 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
17063 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
17065 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
17067 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
17071 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
17085 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
17089 &`single_ecdh_use`&
17091 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
17093 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
17095 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
17099 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
17102 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
17103 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
17104 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
17105 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
17106 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
17107 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
17110 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
17111 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
17112 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
17113 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
17114 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
17117 .option panic_coredump main boolean false
17118 This option is rarely needed but can help for some debugging investigations.
17119 If set, when an internal error is detected by Exim which is sufficient
17120 to terminate the process
17121 (all such are logged in the paniclog)
17122 then a coredump is requested.
17124 Note that most systems require additional administrative configuration
17125 to permit write a core file for a setuid program, which is Exim's
17126 common installed configuration.
17128 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17129 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
17130 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
17131 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
17132 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
17133 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
17134 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
17135 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
17136 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
17137 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
17140 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
17141 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
17142 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
17143 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
17144 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
17145 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
17146 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
17149 .options perl_at_start main boolean false &&&
17150 perl_startup main string unset
17152 These options are available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
17153 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of their use.
17155 .option perl_taintmode main boolean false
17157 This option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
17160 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
17161 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
17162 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
17163 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
17164 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
17165 PostgreSQL support.
17168 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
17169 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
17170 .cindex "pid file, path for"
17171 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
17172 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
17175 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
17177 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
17179 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
17180 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
17181 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
17184 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17185 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
17186 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
17187 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
17188 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
17189 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
17190 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
17191 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
17192 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
17193 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
17195 .option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17196 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
17197 .cindex "pipelining" PIPECONNECT
17198 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPECONNECT
17199 If Exim is built without the DISABLE_PIPE_CONNECT build option
17200 this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
17201 and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
17202 commands are acceptable.
17203 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
17205 See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
17207 The SMTP service extension keyword advertised is &"PIPECONNECT"&;
17208 it permits the client to pipeline
17209 TCP connection and hello command (cleatext phase),
17210 or TLS-establishment and hello command (encrypted phase),
17211 on later connections to the same host.
17214 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
17215 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
17216 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
17217 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
17218 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
17219 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
17220 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
17221 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
17222 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
17224 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
17225 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
17226 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
17227 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
17228 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
17229 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
17230 volume of mail. Use with care!
17233 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
17234 .cindex "name" "of local host"
17235 .cindex "host" "name of local"
17236 .cindex "local host" "name of"
17237 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17238 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
17239 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
17240 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
17241 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
17242 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
17244 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
17245 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
17246 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
17247 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
17248 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
17249 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
17252 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
17253 .cindex "printing characters"
17254 .cindex "8-bit characters"
17255 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
17256 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
17257 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
17258 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
17259 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
17262 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
17263 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
17264 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
17265 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
17266 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
17270 .option process_log_path main string unset
17271 .cindex "process log path"
17272 .cindex "log" "process log"
17273 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
17274 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
17275 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
17276 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
17277 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
17278 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
17279 different spool directories.
17282 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
17283 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17287 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
17288 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
17289 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17292 .option proxy_protocol_timeout main time 3s
17293 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
17294 This option sets the timeout for proxy protocol negotiation.
17295 For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
17298 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
17299 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
17300 .cindex "address" "qualification"
17301 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
17302 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
17303 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
17304 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
17305 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
17306 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
17308 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
17309 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
17310 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
17311 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
17312 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
17313 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
17314 &%primary_hostname%& value.
17317 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
17318 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
17319 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
17323 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17324 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
17325 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17326 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
17327 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
17328 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
17329 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
17330 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
17333 .option queue_fast_ramp main boolean true
17334 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
17335 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
17336 If set to true, two-phase queue runs, initiated using &%-qq%& on the
17337 command line, may start parallel delivery processes during their first
17338 phase. This will be done when a threshold number of messages have been
17339 routed for a single host.
17342 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
17343 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17345 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
17346 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
17347 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
17348 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17351 .option queue_only main boolean false
17352 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17353 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
17354 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
17355 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
17356 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
17357 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
17359 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
17360 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
17361 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
17362 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
17365 .option queue_only_file main "string list" unset
17366 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17367 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
17368 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
17369 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
17370 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
17371 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
17372 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
17373 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
17375 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
17377 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
17378 &_/some/file_& exists.
17381 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
17382 .cindex "load average"
17383 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17384 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
17385 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
17386 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
17387 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
17388 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
17389 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17392 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
17393 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
17394 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
17395 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17398 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
17399 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
17400 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
17401 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
17402 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
17403 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
17404 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
17405 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
17406 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
17407 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17408 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
17409 re-evaluated for each message.
17412 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
17413 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17414 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
17415 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
17416 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
17417 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
17420 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
17421 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
17422 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
17423 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
17424 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
17425 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
17426 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
17427 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
17428 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
17429 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
17430 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
17431 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
17432 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
17436 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
17437 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
17438 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
17439 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
17440 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
17441 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
17442 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
17443 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
17444 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
17446 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
17447 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
17448 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
17449 the daemon's command line.
17451 .cindex queues named
17452 .cindex "named queues" "resource limit"
17453 To set limits for different named queues use
17454 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
17456 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17457 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17458 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
17459 .cindex "first pass routing"
17460 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
17461 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
17462 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
17463 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
17464 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
17465 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
17466 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
17467 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
17468 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
17469 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
17473 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
17474 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
17475 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
17476 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
17477 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
17478 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
17479 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
17481 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
17482 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
17483 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
17484 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
17485 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
17486 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
17487 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
17488 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
17489 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
17491 The default setting is:
17494 received_header_text = Received: \
17495 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
17496 {${if def:sender_ident \
17497 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
17498 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
17499 by $primary_hostname \
17500 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
17501 ${if def:tls_in_ver { ($tls_in_ver)}}\
17502 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
17503 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
17504 ${if def:sender_address \
17505 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
17506 id $message_exim_id\
17507 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
17510 The references to the TLS version and cipher are
17511 omitted when Exim is built without TLS
17512 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
17513 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
17514 header lines such as the following:
17516 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
17517 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
17518 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
17519 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
17520 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
17521 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
17522 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
17524 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
17525 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
17526 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
17527 message was accepted.
17530 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
17531 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
17532 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
17533 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
17534 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
17535 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
17536 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
17537 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
17540 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17541 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17542 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17543 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17544 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
17545 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
17546 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
17547 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
17548 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
17549 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
17550 option was not set.
17553 .option recipients_max main integer&!! 50000
17554 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
17555 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
17556 If the value resulting from expanding this option
17557 is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
17558 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
17559 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
17560 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
17561 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
17564 For SMTP message the expansion is done after the connection is
17565 accepted (but before any SMTP conversation) and may depend on
17566 the IP addresses and port numbers of the connection.
17567 &*Note*&: If an expansion is used for the option,
17568 care should be taken that a resonable value results for
17571 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
17572 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
17573 RCPT commands in a single message.
17576 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
17577 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
17578 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
17579 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
17580 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
17581 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
17582 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
17585 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 4
17586 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
17587 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
17588 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
17589 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
17590 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
17591 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
17592 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
17593 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
17594 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
17595 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
17596 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
17597 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
17598 tagged with its process id.
17600 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
17601 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
17602 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
17603 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
17606 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option,
17607 and the &%serialize_hosts%& smtp transport option.
17609 .cindex "number of deliveries"
17610 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
17611 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
17612 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
17613 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
17614 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
17615 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
17616 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
17617 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
17618 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
17619 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
17621 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
17622 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
17623 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
17624 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
17627 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17628 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
17629 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
17630 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
17631 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
17633 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
17635 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
17636 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
17639 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
17640 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
17641 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
17642 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
17643 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
17647 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
17648 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
17649 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
17650 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
17651 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
17652 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
17653 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
17657 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
17658 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
17659 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
17660 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
17661 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
17662 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
17663 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
17664 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
17665 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
17666 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
17669 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
17670 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
17673 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
17675 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
17676 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
17677 an item in the list.
17678 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
17681 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
17682 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
17683 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
17684 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
17685 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
17688 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17689 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17690 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17691 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17692 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
17693 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
17694 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
17695 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
17696 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
17697 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
17700 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
17701 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
17702 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
17703 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
17704 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
17705 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
17706 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
17710 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
17711 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
17712 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
17713 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
17714 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
17715 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
17716 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
17717 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
17718 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
17719 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
17720 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
17724 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
17725 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
17726 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17728 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
17729 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
17730 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
17731 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
17732 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
17733 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17735 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
17736 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
17737 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
17738 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
17741 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
17742 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
17743 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
17744 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
17745 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
17746 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
17747 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
17748 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
17750 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
17751 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
17752 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
17753 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17754 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17755 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17756 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17757 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17760 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17761 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17762 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17763 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17767 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17768 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17769 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17770 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17771 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17772 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17773 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17774 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17775 . the option name to split.
17777 .option smtp_accept_max_per_connection main integer&!! 1000
17778 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17779 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17780 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17781 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17782 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17783 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17784 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17786 The option is expanded after the HELO or EHLO is received
17787 and may depend on values available at that time.
17788 An empty or zero value after expansion removes the limit.
17791 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17792 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17793 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17794 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17795 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17796 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17797 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17798 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17799 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17800 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17801 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17803 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17804 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17805 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17806 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17807 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17808 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17812 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17813 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17814 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17815 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17816 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17817 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17818 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17819 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17820 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17821 to all messages received in the same connection.
17823 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17824 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17825 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17826 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17829 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17831 .option smtp_accept_queue_per_connection main integer 10
17832 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17833 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17834 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17835 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17836 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17837 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17838 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17839 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17840 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17841 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17842 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17845 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17846 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17847 .cindex "host" "reserved"
17848 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17849 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17850 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17851 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17852 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17853 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17854 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17855 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17858 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17859 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17860 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17861 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17864 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17865 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17866 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17867 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17868 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17869 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17870 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17871 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17872 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17874 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17875 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17876 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17877 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17879 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17880 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17881 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17882 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17883 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17886 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17887 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17890 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17891 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17892 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17893 &%helo_data%& value.
17895 .option smtp_backlog_monitor main integer 0
17896 .cindex "connection backlog" monitoring
17897 If this option is set to greater than zero, and the backlog of available
17898 TCP connections on a socket listening for SMTP is larger than it, a line
17899 is logged giving the value and the socket address and port.
17900 The value is retrived jsut before an accept call.
17901 This facility is only available on Linux.
17903 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17904 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17905 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
17906 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17907 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17908 If a connect ACL does not supply a message,
17909 this string (which is expanded every time it is used) is output as the initial
17910 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17912 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17913 $version_number $tod_full
17915 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error;
17916 a forced fail just closes the connection.
17917 If you want to create a
17918 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17919 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17920 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17921 multiline response).
17924 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17925 .cindex "checking disk space"
17926 .cindex "disk space, checking"
17927 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17928 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17929 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17930 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17931 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17932 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17935 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17936 .cindex "connection backlog" "set maximum"
17937 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17938 .cindex "backlog of connections"
17939 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17940 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17941 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17942 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17943 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17944 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17945 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17946 attacks by SYN flooding.
17949 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17950 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17951 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17952 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17953 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17954 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17955 fewer, but they still exist.
17957 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17958 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17959 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17960 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17961 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17962 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17963 does detect many instances.
17965 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17966 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17967 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17968 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17972 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17973 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17974 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
17975 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17976 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17977 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17978 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17979 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17980 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17983 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17984 $sender_host_address
17986 If the option is not set, the argument for the ETRN command must
17987 be a &'#'& followed by an address string.
17988 In this case an &'exim -R <string>'& command is used;
17989 if the ETRN ACL has set up a named-queue then &'-MCG <queue>'& is appended.
17991 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17992 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17993 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17994 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17995 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17999 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
18000 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
18001 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
18002 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
18003 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
18006 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
18007 .cindex "load average"
18008 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
18009 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
18010 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
18011 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
18012 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
18013 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
18017 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
18018 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
18019 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
18020 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
18021 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
18023 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
18025 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
18026 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
18027 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
18028 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
18029 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
18031 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
18032 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
18033 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
18034 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
18035 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
18036 not count towards the limit.
18040 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
18041 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
18042 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
18043 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
18044 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
18047 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
18048 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
18052 .options smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset &&&
18053 smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset &&&
18054 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
18055 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
18056 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
18057 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
18058 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
18059 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
18062 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
18063 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
18064 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
18065 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
18067 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
18068 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
18069 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
18070 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
18074 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
18076 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
18077 fractional parts are allowed here.
18079 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
18081 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
18082 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
18085 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
18086 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
18088 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
18089 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
18091 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
18092 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
18093 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
18094 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
18098 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
18099 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
18100 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
18101 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
18102 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
18103 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
18104 the message is abandoned.
18105 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
18107 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
18108 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
18110 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
18111 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
18113 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
18114 expanded before use and may depend on
18115 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
18119 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
18120 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
18121 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
18122 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
18123 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
18126 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18127 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
18128 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
18131 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
18132 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
18133 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
18134 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
18135 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
18136 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
18137 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
18138 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
18139 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
18140 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
18142 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
18143 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
18147 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18148 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
18149 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
18150 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
18151 the availability thereof is advertised in
18152 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18153 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
18156 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
18157 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
18158 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
18159 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
18163 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
18164 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
18165 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
18167 .option spf_smtp_comment_template main string&!! "Please%_see%_http://www.open-spf.org/Why"
18168 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support. It
18169 allows the customisation of the SMTP comment that the SPF library
18170 generates. You are strongly encouraged to link to your own explanative
18171 site. The template must not contain spaces. If you need spaces in the
18172 output, use the proper placeholder. If libspf2 can not parse the
18173 template, it uses a built-in default broken link. The following placeholders
18174 (along with Exim variables (but see below)) are allowed in the template:
18178 &*%{L}*&: Envelope sender's local part.
18180 &*%{S}*&: Envelope sender.
18182 &*%{O}*&: Envelope sender's domain.
18184 &*%{D}*&: Current(?) domain.
18186 &*%{I}*&: SMTP client Ip.
18188 &*%{C}*&: SMTP client pretty IP.
18190 &*%{T}*&: Epoch time (UTC).
18192 &*%{P}*&: SMTP client domain name.
18194 &*%{V}*&: IP version.
18196 &*%{H}*&: EHLO/HELO domain.
18198 &*%{R}*&: Receiving domain.
18200 The capitalized placeholders do proper URL encoding, if you use them
18201 lowercased, no encoding takes place. This list was compiled from the
18204 A note on using Exim variables: As
18205 currently the SPF library is initialized before the SMTP EHLO phase,
18206 the variables useful for expansion are quite limited.
18209 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
18210 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
18211 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
18212 .cindex "directories, multiple"
18213 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
18214 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
18215 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
18216 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
18217 arrival of the message.
18219 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
18220 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
18221 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
18222 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
18223 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
18225 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
18226 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
18227 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
18228 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
18229 automatically deleted.
18231 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
18232 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
18233 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
18234 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
18235 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
18236 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
18237 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
18238 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
18239 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
18242 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
18243 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
18244 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
18245 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
18246 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
18247 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
18248 &$primary_hostname$&.
18250 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
18251 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
18252 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
18253 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
18254 as failures in the configuration file.
18256 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
18257 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
18259 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
18260 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
18261 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
18262 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
18263 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
18264 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
18267 The following variables will not have useful values:
18269 $max_received_linelength
18274 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
18275 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
18276 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
18277 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
18279 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
18280 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
18281 The transmission benefit is maintained.
18283 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
18284 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
18285 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
18286 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
18288 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
18289 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
18290 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
18291 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
18292 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
18293 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
18295 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
18296 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
18297 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
18298 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
18299 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
18300 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
18301 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
18304 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
18305 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
18306 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
18307 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
18308 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
18309 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
18310 domain causes a syntax error.
18311 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
18315 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
18316 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
18317 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
18318 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
18319 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
18320 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
18321 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
18322 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
18323 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
18324 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
18325 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
18326 the LOG_ALERT priority.
18329 .option syslog_facility main string unset
18330 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
18331 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18332 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
18333 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
18334 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18335 details of Exim's logging.
18338 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
18339 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
18340 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
18341 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
18342 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
18343 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
18344 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18348 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
18349 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
18350 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18351 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
18352 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18356 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
18357 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
18358 .cindex timestamps syslog
18359 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
18360 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18361 details of Exim's logging.
18364 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
18365 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
18366 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
18367 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
18368 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
18369 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
18370 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
18371 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
18372 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
18373 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
18374 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
18375 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
18378 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
18379 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18380 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
18381 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
18382 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
18383 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18386 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
18387 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
18388 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
18389 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
18390 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18392 .option system_filter_group main string unset
18393 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
18394 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
18395 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
18396 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
18398 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
18399 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
18400 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18401 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
18402 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
18403 contains the pipe command.
18406 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
18407 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
18408 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
18409 is used in a system filter.
18412 .option system_filter_user main string unset
18413 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
18414 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
18415 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
18416 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
18417 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
18418 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
18419 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
18420 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
18421 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
18423 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
18424 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
18425 transport option overrides.
18428 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
18429 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
18430 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
18431 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
18432 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
18433 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
18434 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
18435 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
18436 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
18437 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
18438 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
18439 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
18443 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
18444 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
18445 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
18446 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
18447 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
18448 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
18449 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
18450 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
18451 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
18452 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
18454 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
18455 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
18456 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
18459 .option timezone main string unset
18460 .cindex "timezone, setting"
18461 .cindex "environment" "values from"
18462 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
18463 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
18464 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
18465 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
18469 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
18470 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
18471 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
18472 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
18473 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
18474 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
18477 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18478 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
18479 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
18480 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
18481 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
18482 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
18483 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
18484 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18485 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
18486 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
18487 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
18488 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
18491 .option tls_alpn main "string list&!!" "smtp : esmtp"
18492 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
18494 .cindex ALPN "set acceptable names for server"
18495 If this option is set,
18496 the TLS library supports ALPN,
18497 and the client offers either more than one
18498 ALPN name or a name which does not match the list,
18499 the TLS connection is declined.
18502 .option tls_certificate main "string list&!!" unset
18503 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
18504 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
18505 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18506 files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
18507 Commonly only one file is needed.
18508 The server's private key is also
18509 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
18510 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18512 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
18513 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
18514 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
18515 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
18517 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
18518 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
18520 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
18521 when a list of more than one
18522 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
18523 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
18525 .cindex SNI "selecting server certificate based on"
18526 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
18527 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
18528 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
18529 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
18531 If this option is unset or empty a self-signed certificate will be
18533 Under Linux this is generated at daemon startup; on other platforms it will be
18534 generated fresh for every connection.
18536 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
18537 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
18538 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
18539 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
18540 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
18542 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
18544 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
18545 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
18546 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
18548 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18551 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
18552 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
18553 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
18554 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
18555 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
18556 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
18558 The value must be at least 1024.
18560 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
18561 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
18562 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
18564 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
18567 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
18568 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
18569 larger prime than requested.
18572 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
18573 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
18574 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
18575 to be used by Exim.
18577 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
18578 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
18579 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
18580 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
18582 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
18583 then it names a file from which DH
18584 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
18585 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
18586 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
18587 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
18588 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
18589 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
18591 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
18594 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
18595 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
18596 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
18597 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
18599 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
18600 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
18602 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
18603 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
18604 in IKE is assigned number 23.
18606 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
18607 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
18608 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
18609 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
18610 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18612 The available standard primes are:
18613 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
18614 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
18615 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
18616 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
18618 The available additional primes are:
18619 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18621 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
18622 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
18623 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
18624 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
18625 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
18627 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
18628 they are still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
18629 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
18630 Two of them in particular (&`ike1`& and &`ike22`&) are called out by RFC 8247
18631 as MUST NOT use for IPSEC, and two more (&`ike23`& and &`ike24`&) as
18633 Because of this, Exim regards them as deprecated; if either of the first pair
18634 are used, warnings will be logged in the paniclog, and if any are used then
18635 warnings will be logged in the mainlog.
18636 All four will be removed in a future Exim release.
18638 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
18639 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
18640 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
18641 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
18642 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
18645 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
18646 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
18647 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
18648 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
18649 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
18650 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
18651 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
18654 .option tls_eccurve main string list&!! &`auto`&
18655 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
18656 This option selects EC curves for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
18657 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS
18658 (the equivalent can be done using a priority string for the
18659 &%tls_require_ciphers%& option).
18661 After expansion it must contain
18662 one or (only for OpenSSL versiona 1.1.1 onwards) more
18663 EC curve names, such as &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-521`&.
18664 Consult your OpenSSL manual for valid curve names.
18666 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
18667 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
18668 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
18670 If the option expands to an empty string, the effect is undefined.
18673 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
18674 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
18675 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
18677 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
18678 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
18679 Certificate Authority.
18681 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
18682 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
18684 For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
18685 for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
18686 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
18687 The ordering of the two lists must match.
18688 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
18690 The file(s) should be in DER format,
18691 except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
18693 when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
18694 The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
18695 a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
18696 files in the list; the initial format is DER.
18697 If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
18698 (this only works under TLS1.3)
18699 they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
18701 Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
18702 PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
18703 TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
18704 although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
18706 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
18709 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
18710 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
18711 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
18712 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
18716 .option tls_privatekey main "string list&!!" unset
18717 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
18718 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18719 files which contains the server's private keys.
18720 If this option is unset, or if
18721 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
18722 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
18723 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18725 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18728 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
18729 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
18730 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
18731 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
18732 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
18733 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
18737 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
18738 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
18739 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
18740 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
18741 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
18742 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
18743 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
18744 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
18745 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
18746 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
18747 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
18750 .option tls_resumption_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18751 .cindex TLS resumption
18752 This option controls which connections to offer the TLS resumption feature.
18753 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
18756 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18757 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18758 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18759 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
18762 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
18763 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18764 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18765 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
18767 or the absolute path to
18768 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
18769 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
18771 The "system" value for the option will use a
18772 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
18773 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
18774 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
18777 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
18778 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
18780 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
18782 either by file or directory
18783 are added to those given by the system default location.
18785 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
18786 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
18787 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
18788 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
18789 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
18790 use the explicit directory version. (If your peer is Exim up to 4.85,
18791 using GnuTLS, you may need to send the CAs (thus using the file
18792 variant). Otherwise the peer doesn't send its certificate.)
18794 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18796 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
18800 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18801 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18802 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18803 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
18804 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
18805 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
18806 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
18807 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
18809 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
18810 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
18811 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
18813 &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
18814 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
18815 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
18816 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
18818 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
18819 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
18820 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
18821 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
18822 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
18823 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
18824 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
18827 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
18831 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
18832 .cindex "trusted groups"
18833 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
18834 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18835 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
18836 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
18837 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
18838 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
18839 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
18842 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
18843 .cindex "trusted users"
18844 .cindex "user" "trusted"
18845 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18846 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
18847 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
18848 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
18849 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
18850 Exim user are trusted.
18852 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
18853 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
18854 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
18855 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
18856 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
18857 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
18858 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
18859 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
18860 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
18863 .option unknown_username main string unset
18864 See &%unknown_login%&.
18866 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
18867 .cindex "trusted users"
18868 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
18869 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
18870 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
18871 .cindex "envelope from"
18872 .cindex "envelope sender"
18873 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18874 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18875 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18876 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18877 is used) is ignored.
18879 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18880 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18882 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18884 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18885 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18886 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18887 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18888 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18889 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18890 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18891 followed by a hyphen
18892 by a setting like this:
18894 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18896 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18897 restriction, you can use
18899 untrusted_set_sender = *
18901 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18902 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18903 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18904 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18905 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18906 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18907 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18908 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18910 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18911 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18912 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18913 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18917 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18918 .cindex "&""From""& line"
18919 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18920 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18921 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18922 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18923 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18924 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18925 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18926 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18928 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18929 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18931 The pattern can be seen by running
18933 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18935 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18936 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18937 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18938 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18939 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18940 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18943 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18944 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18947 .option warn_message_file main string&!! unset
18948 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18949 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18950 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18951 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18952 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18953 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18954 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
18955 .cindex warn_message_file "tainted data"
18956 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
18957 absolute and untainted.
18958 See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18961 .option wellknown_advertise_hosts main boolean unset
18962 .cindex WELLKNOWN advertisement
18963 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" WELLKNOWN
18964 This option enables the advertising of the SMTP WELLKNOWN extension.
18965 See also the &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& ACL (&<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>&).
18967 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18968 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18969 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18970 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18971 .ecindex IIDconfima
18972 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
18977 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18978 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18980 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18981 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18982 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18983 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18984 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
18986 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18987 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18988 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18989 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18990 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18992 The name of a router is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
18993 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
18997 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
18998 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18999 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
19000 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
19001 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
19002 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
19003 delivery of the address to be deferred.
19005 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19006 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
19007 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
19008 routers, and the eventual transport.
19010 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
19011 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
19012 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
19013 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
19014 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
19016 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
19017 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
19018 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
19019 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
19020 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
19022 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
19023 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
19024 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
19026 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
19028 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
19030 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
19032 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
19033 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
19035 See also the &%set%& option below.
19037 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
19038 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19039 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
19040 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
19041 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
19042 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
19043 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
19047 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
19049 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
19050 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
19051 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
19052 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
19053 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
19058 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
19059 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
19060 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
19061 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
19062 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
19063 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
19064 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
19065 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
19066 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
19067 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
19070 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
19072 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
19075 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
19077 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
19078 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
19079 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
19080 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
19083 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
19084 .cindex "case of local parts"
19085 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
19086 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
19087 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
19088 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
19089 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
19090 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
19091 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
19094 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19095 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
19096 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
19097 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
19098 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
19099 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
19100 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
19101 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
19102 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
19104 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
19105 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
19106 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
19107 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
19111 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
19112 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
19113 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
19114 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
19116 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
19117 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
19118 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
19119 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
19120 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
19122 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
19123 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router check_local_user option"
19124 &$local_part_data$& is set to an untainted version of the local part and
19125 &$home$& is set from the password data. The latter can be tested in other
19126 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
19127 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
19128 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
19129 the router is skipped.
19131 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
19132 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
19133 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
19134 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
19135 setting to achieve this. For example:
19137 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
19139 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
19140 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
19141 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
19145 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
19146 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
19147 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
19148 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
19149 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
19150 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
19151 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
19152 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
19154 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
19155 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
19157 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
19158 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
19160 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
19161 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
19162 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
19164 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
19166 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
19168 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
19171 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
19173 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
19174 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
19178 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
19179 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
19180 be specified using &%condition%&.
19182 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
19183 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
19184 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
19185 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
19186 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
19187 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
19188 Router rules processing behavior.
19190 This is best illustrated in an example:
19192 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
19193 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
19195 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
19198 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
19201 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
19202 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
19203 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
19204 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
19205 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
19206 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
19207 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
19208 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
19210 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
19211 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
19212 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
19213 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
19216 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
19217 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
19218 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
19219 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
19220 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
19223 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
19224 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19225 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19226 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
19227 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
19228 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19229 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19230 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19231 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
19232 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
19233 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
19234 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
19235 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
19236 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
19240 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
19241 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
19242 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
19243 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
19244 transport option of the same name.
19246 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
19247 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19248 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19249 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19250 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19251 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
19252 the DNSSEC request bit set.
19253 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19255 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
19256 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19257 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19258 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19259 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19260 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
19261 the DNSSEC request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
19262 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
19263 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19266 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
19267 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
19268 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
19269 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
19271 The data returned by the list check
19272 is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
19273 expansions of the driver's private options and in the transport.
19274 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
19275 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
19277 A complex example, using a file like:
19283 and checking both domain and local_part
19285 domains = ${domain:${lookup {$local_part@$domain} lseach,ret=key {/path/to/accountsfile}}}
19286 local_parts = ${local_part:${lookup {$local_part@$domain} lseach,ret=key {/path/to/accountsfile}}}
19291 .option driver routers string unset
19292 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
19296 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
19297 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19298 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19299 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
19300 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
19301 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
19302 Not effective on redirect routers.
19306 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
19307 .cindex "envelope from"
19308 .cindex "envelope sender"
19309 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
19310 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
19311 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
19312 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
19313 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
19314 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
19315 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
19317 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
19318 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
19319 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
19322 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
19323 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
19324 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
19325 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
19327 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
19328 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
19329 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
19330 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
19336 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
19337 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
19338 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
19339 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
19340 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
19342 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19343 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
19344 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
19345 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
19346 setting &%return_path%&.
19348 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
19349 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
19350 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
19354 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
19355 .cindex "address" "testing"
19356 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
19357 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
19358 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
19359 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
19360 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
19361 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
19362 on for the system alias file.
19363 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19366 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
19367 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
19368 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
19372 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
19373 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
19374 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
19375 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19379 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
19380 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19381 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
19385 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
19386 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19387 verifying a sender, verification fails.
19391 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
19392 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
19393 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
19394 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
19395 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
19396 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
19397 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
19398 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
19399 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
19401 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
19402 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
19403 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
19404 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
19405 transport for further details.
19408 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
19409 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
19410 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19411 .cindex "transport" "local"
19412 .cindex "router" "setting group"
19413 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19414 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
19416 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19417 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19418 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
19419 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
19420 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19424 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
19425 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
19426 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
19427 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19428 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19429 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19430 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
19431 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
19432 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
19433 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
19434 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
19435 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
19436 &"see"& the added header lines.
19438 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
19439 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
19440 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
19441 failures are treated as configuration errors.
19443 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
19444 for a router; all listed headers are added.
19446 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19447 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19449 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19450 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
19451 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19452 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
19453 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
19454 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
19455 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
19456 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
19457 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
19458 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19462 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
19463 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19464 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
19465 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19466 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19467 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19468 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
19469 Each list item is separately expanded, at transport time.
19470 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
19472 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
19473 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
19474 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
19475 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
19476 &"see"& the original header lines.
19478 The &%headers_remove%& option is handled after &%errors_to%& and
19479 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
19480 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
19483 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
19484 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
19486 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19487 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19489 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19490 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
19491 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
19492 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
19494 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
19495 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
19496 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19500 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
19501 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
19502 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
19503 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
19504 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
19505 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
19506 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
19509 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
19513 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
19515 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
19516 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
19517 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
19518 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
19519 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
19520 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
19522 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
19523 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
19525 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
19526 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
19528 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
19529 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
19531 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
19532 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19533 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
19534 domain that is being routed.
19536 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19537 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
19540 .option initgroups routers boolean false
19541 .cindex "additional groups"
19542 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19543 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19544 .cindex "transport" "local"
19545 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
19546 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
19547 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
19548 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
19549 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19553 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
19554 .cindex affix "router precondition"
19555 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
19556 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
19557 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
19558 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
19559 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
19562 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
19563 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
19564 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
19565 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
19566 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
19567 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
19568 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
19569 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
19570 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
19572 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19573 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
19574 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
19575 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
19576 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
19577 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
19578 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
19579 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
19580 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
19581 the relevant transport.
19583 .vindex &$local_part_prefix_v$&
19584 If wildcarding (above) was used then the part of the prefix matching the
19585 wildcard is available in &$local_part_prefix_v$&.
19587 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
19588 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
19589 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
19592 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
19593 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
19594 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
19595 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
19596 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
19600 local_part_prefix = real-
19602 transport = local_delivery
19604 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19605 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19607 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19608 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19611 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
19612 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
19613 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
19614 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
19617 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
19618 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
19622 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
19623 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
19624 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
19625 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
19626 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
19627 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
19628 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
19629 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
19630 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
19634 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
19635 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
19639 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
19640 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
19641 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
19642 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
19643 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19645 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
19646 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
19649 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain_data
19651 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
19652 the data returned by the list check
19653 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
19654 expansions of the router's private options or in the transport.
19655 You might use this option, for
19656 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
19657 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
19658 each virtual domain:
19662 local_parts = postmaster
19663 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
19667 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
19668 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
19669 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
19670 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
19671 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
19672 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
19673 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
19674 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
19675 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
19676 redirect addresses.
19680 .option more routers boolean&!! true
19681 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19682 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19683 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19684 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
19685 delivery to be deferred.
19687 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
19688 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
19690 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
19691 means of the setting
19695 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
19696 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
19697 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
19699 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
19700 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
19701 controls what happens next.
19704 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
19705 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
19706 .cindex "router" "timeout"
19707 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
19708 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
19709 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
19710 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
19711 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
19713 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
19714 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
19715 applies to all of them.
19719 .option pass_router routers string unset
19720 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
19721 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
19722 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
19723 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
19724 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
19725 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
19726 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
19727 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
19728 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
19729 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
19733 .option redirect_router routers string unset
19734 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
19735 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
19736 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
19737 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
19738 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
19740 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
19741 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
19742 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
19743 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
19747 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
19748 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
19749 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
19750 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
19751 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
19752 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
19753 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
19755 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
19756 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
19757 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19758 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
19759 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
19761 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
19762 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
19763 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
19764 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
19765 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
19768 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
19769 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
19772 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
19773 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
19774 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
19775 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
19776 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
19777 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
19778 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
19779 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
19781 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
19782 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
19783 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
19784 operates as follows:
19786 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
19787 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
19788 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
19789 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
19792 require_files = mail:/some/file
19793 require_files = $local_part_data:$home/.procmailrc
19795 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
19796 &%require_files%& condition fails.
19798 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
19799 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
19800 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
19801 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
19803 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
19804 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
19805 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
19806 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
19807 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
19809 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
19810 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
19811 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
19812 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
19813 check again in that process.
19815 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
19816 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
19817 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
19818 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
19819 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
19820 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
19821 as if the file did not exist. For example:
19823 require_files = +/some/file
19825 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
19826 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
19827 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
19831 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
19832 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19833 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
19834 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
19835 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
19836 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
19837 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
19838 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
19841 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
19842 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
19843 router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
19844 &%check_local_user%&,
19847 &%local_part_prefix%&,
19848 &%local_part_suffix%&,
19851 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
19852 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
19855 Failing to set this option when it is needed
19856 (because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
19857 can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
19859 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
19860 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
19861 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
19865 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
19866 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
19867 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
19869 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
19870 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
19871 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
19872 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
19873 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
19874 cause the router to defer.
19876 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
19877 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
19879 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19881 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
19882 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
19884 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
19885 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
19886 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
19887 of these values that is set:
19890 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19892 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19894 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19896 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19899 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
19900 router, but not for the transport.
19904 .option self routers string freeze
19905 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19906 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19907 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19908 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19909 and &(manualroute)& routers.
19910 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19912 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19913 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19914 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19915 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19916 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19918 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
19919 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
19920 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
19921 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
19922 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
19927 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
19929 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19930 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19931 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19932 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19934 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19935 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19936 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19941 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19942 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19943 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19944 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19945 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19946 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19952 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19953 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19954 be passed to the next router.
19957 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19960 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
19961 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19962 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19963 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19964 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19965 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19970 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19971 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
19972 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19973 address matches something on the list.
19974 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19977 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19978 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19979 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19980 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19981 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19982 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19983 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19987 .option set routers "string list" unset
19988 .cindex router variables
19989 This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19990 because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19991 The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19994 Each list-element given must be of the form &"name = value"&
19995 and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19996 Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19997 When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19998 to create variables which are added to the set associated with
20000 This is done immediately after all the preconditions, before the
20001 evaluation of the &%address_data%& option.
20002 The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
20003 The variables can be used by the router options
20004 (not including any preconditions)
20005 and by the transport.
20006 Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
20007 Variable use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
20009 This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
20010 many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
20013 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
20014 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
20015 .cindex "packet radio"
20016 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
20017 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
20018 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
20019 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
20020 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
20021 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
20022 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
20023 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20025 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20026 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
20027 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
20028 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
20029 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
20030 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
20031 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
20032 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
20033 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
20034 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
20036 translate_ip_address = \
20037 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
20040 The file would contain lines like
20042 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
20043 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
20045 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
20050 .option transport routers string&!! unset
20051 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
20052 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
20053 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
20054 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
20055 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
20056 delivery is deferred.
20058 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
20059 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
20060 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
20064 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
20065 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20066 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
20067 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
20068 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
20069 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
20070 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
20071 overridden by a setting on the transport.
20072 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20073 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20074 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
20080 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
20081 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20082 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
20083 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
20084 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
20085 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
20086 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
20087 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
20088 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20089 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20091 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
20092 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
20093 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
20094 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
20095 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
20097 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
20103 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
20104 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
20105 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
20106 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
20107 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
20108 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
20109 delivery to be deferred.
20111 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
20112 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
20113 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
20114 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
20115 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
20116 sometimes true and sometimes false).
20118 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
20119 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
20120 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
20121 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
20122 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
20123 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
20124 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
20125 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
20127 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
20128 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
20129 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
20130 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
20131 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
20132 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
20133 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
20134 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
20135 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
20136 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
20138 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
20139 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
20140 subsequent routers.
20143 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
20144 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20145 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20146 .cindex "transport" "local"
20147 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
20148 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
20149 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
20150 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
20151 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
20152 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
20153 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
20154 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
20155 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
20156 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
20157 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
20158 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
20162 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
20163 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
20164 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
20167 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
20168 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
20170 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
20171 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
20172 delivering in cutthrough mode or
20173 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
20174 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
20175 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
20176 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
20178 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
20179 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
20180 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
20184 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
20185 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
20187 delivering in cutthrough mode
20188 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
20189 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20191 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
20194 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
20195 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
20196 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
20197 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20199 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
20200 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
20201 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
20208 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20209 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20211 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
20212 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
20213 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
20214 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
20215 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
20216 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
20217 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
20218 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
20219 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
20223 domains = mydomain.example
20225 transport = local_delivery
20227 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
20228 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
20229 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
20230 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
20237 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20238 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20240 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
20241 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
20242 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
20243 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
20244 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
20245 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
20247 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
20248 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
20249 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
20250 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
20253 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
20254 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
20255 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
20256 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
20257 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
20258 generic option, the router declines.
20260 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
20261 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
20262 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
20264 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
20265 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
20266 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
20267 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
20268 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
20269 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
20272 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
20273 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
20274 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
20275 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
20276 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
20277 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
20279 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
20280 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
20281 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
20282 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
20283 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
20284 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
20285 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
20286 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
20287 case routing fails.
20290 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
20291 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
20292 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
20293 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
20294 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
20296 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
20297 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
20299 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
20301 The domain does not exist in DNS
20303 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
20304 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
20305 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
20307 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
20309 MX record points to a non-existent host.
20311 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
20312 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
20314 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
20315 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
20317 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
20318 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
20320 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
20321 not be found in the MX records (see below)
20327 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
20328 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
20329 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
20331 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
20332 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
20333 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
20334 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
20335 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
20336 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
20337 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
20340 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
20341 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
20342 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
20343 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
20344 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
20345 required. For example,
20349 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
20350 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
20351 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
20352 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
20353 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
20356 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
20357 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
20358 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
20359 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
20360 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
20361 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
20363 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
20364 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
20365 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
20366 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
20367 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
20368 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
20369 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
20370 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
20372 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
20373 when there is a DNS lookup error.
20378 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20379 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
20380 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
20381 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
20382 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
20383 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
20384 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
20385 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
20389 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
20390 .cindex IPv6 disabling
20391 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
20392 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20393 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20394 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20395 only A records are used.
20397 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
20398 .cindex IPv4 preference
20399 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
20400 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20401 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20402 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20403 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
20405 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20406 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
20407 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
20408 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
20409 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
20410 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
20411 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
20414 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
20416 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
20417 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
20418 the address record.
20421 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20422 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20423 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
20424 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20429 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
20430 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20431 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
20432 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
20433 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
20434 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
20435 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
20436 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
20437 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
20442 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
20443 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
20444 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
20445 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
20446 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
20447 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
20448 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
20449 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
20450 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
20451 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
20452 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
20454 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
20455 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
20458 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
20459 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
20460 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
20461 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
20462 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
20466 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
20467 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20468 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
20469 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
20470 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20471 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20472 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20473 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20475 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20476 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
20477 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20478 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
20479 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
20480 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
20481 without processing them independently,
20482 provided the following conditions are met:
20485 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
20486 &%headers_remove%&.
20488 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
20495 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
20496 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20497 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
20498 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
20499 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
20500 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
20501 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
20502 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
20503 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
20504 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
20506 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
20507 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
20512 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20513 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20514 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
20515 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20520 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
20521 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
20522 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
20523 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
20526 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
20528 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
20529 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
20530 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
20531 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
20532 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
20533 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
20536 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
20537 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
20538 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
20539 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
20540 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
20542 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
20543 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
20544 such as that implied by
20548 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
20549 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
20550 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
20551 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
20561 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20562 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20564 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
20565 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
20566 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
20567 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
20568 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
20569 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
20570 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
20571 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
20572 router handles the address
20576 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
20577 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
20578 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
20580 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
20582 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
20583 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
20585 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
20586 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
20587 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
20588 &%self%& option determines what happens.
20590 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
20591 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
20592 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
20593 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
20597 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20598 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20600 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
20601 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
20602 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
20603 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
20604 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
20605 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
20608 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
20610 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
20612 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
20613 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
20614 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
20615 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
20616 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
20617 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
20618 must not be specified for it.
20620 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
20621 .option hosts iplookup string unset
20622 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
20623 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
20624 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
20625 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
20626 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
20629 .option optional iplookup boolean false
20630 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
20631 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
20632 delivery to the address is deferred.
20635 .option port iplookup integer 0
20636 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
20637 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
20641 .option protocol iplookup string udp
20642 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
20643 protocols is to be used.
20646 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
20647 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
20650 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
20652 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
20653 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
20656 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
20657 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
20658 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
20659 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
20660 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
20661 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
20662 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
20663 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
20666 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
20667 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
20668 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
20669 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
20670 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
20671 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
20672 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
20673 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
20674 following could be used:
20676 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
20677 reroute = $local_part@$1
20680 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
20681 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
20682 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
20683 call. It does not apply to UDP.
20688 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20689 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20691 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
20692 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
20693 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
20694 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
20695 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
20696 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
20697 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
20698 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
20699 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
20700 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
20702 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
20703 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
20704 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
20705 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
20706 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
20707 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
20708 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
20711 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
20712 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
20713 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
20714 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
20715 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
20716 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
20717 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
20720 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
20721 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
20722 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
20723 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
20724 below, following the list of private options.
20727 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
20729 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
20730 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
20732 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
20733 See &%host_find_failed%&.
20735 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
20736 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
20737 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
20738 of the following values:
20747 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
20748 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
20749 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
20752 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
20753 router only if &%more%& is true.
20755 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
20756 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
20757 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
20758 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
20760 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
20761 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
20762 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
20765 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
20766 .cindex "randomized host list"
20767 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
20768 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
20769 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
20770 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
20771 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
20772 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
20773 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
20774 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
20776 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
20777 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
20778 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
20779 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
20781 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
20783 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
20784 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
20785 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
20786 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
20787 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
20790 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
20791 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
20792 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
20795 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
20797 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
20798 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
20802 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
20803 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
20804 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
20805 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
20808 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
20809 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20810 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
20811 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
20812 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20813 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20814 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20815 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20817 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20818 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
20819 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20820 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
20821 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
20822 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
20823 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
20824 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
20829 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
20830 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
20831 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
20832 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
20833 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
20834 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
20836 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
20838 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
20842 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
20843 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20845 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
20846 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
20847 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
20848 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
20849 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
20850 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
20851 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
20852 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
20853 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
20854 in a &%route_list%&).
20856 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
20857 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
20858 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
20859 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
20863 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
20864 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
20865 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
20866 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
20867 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
20868 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
20869 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
20872 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
20873 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20875 This data can be accessed by setting
20877 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
20879 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
20880 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
20881 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
20882 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
20883 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
20888 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
20889 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
20890 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
20891 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
20892 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
20893 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
20894 The format of each item
20895 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
20896 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
20898 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
20899 variables are set during its expansion:
20902 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20903 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
20904 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
20906 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
20909 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20911 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
20914 .vindex "&$value$&"
20915 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
20916 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
20918 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
20922 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
20923 semicolon is the default route list separator.
20927 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
20928 Each item in the list of hosts can be either a host name or an IP address,
20929 optionally with an attached port number, or it can be a single "+"
20930 (see &%hosts_randomize%&).
20931 When no port is given, an IP address
20932 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20933 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20934 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20937 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20938 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20939 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20941 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20942 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20945 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20946 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20947 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20948 number follows. For example:
20950 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20954 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20955 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20956 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20957 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20958 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20961 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20962 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20963 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20964 records in the DNS. For example:
20966 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20968 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20971 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20973 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20974 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20975 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20976 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20977 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20978 happens is controlled by the
20979 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20980 &%self%& option of the router.
20982 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20983 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20984 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20985 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20986 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20987 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20988 defined by MX preferences.
20990 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20991 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20992 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20994 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20995 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20996 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20997 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20999 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
21000 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
21003 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
21004 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
21005 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
21007 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
21008 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
21012 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
21013 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
21014 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
21015 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
21016 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
21017 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
21018 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
21021 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
21022 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
21024 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
21025 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
21027 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
21028 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
21029 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
21031 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
21032 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
21033 timeout), delivery is deferred.
21035 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
21037 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
21042 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
21043 domain2 host4:host5
21045 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
21046 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
21047 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
21048 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
21051 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
21052 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
21053 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
21054 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
21057 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
21058 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
21063 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
21064 &%host_find_failed%& option.
21067 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
21068 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
21072 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
21073 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
21074 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
21077 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
21078 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
21079 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
21080 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
21082 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
21084 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
21085 your first router something like this:
21088 driver = manualroute
21089 domains = !+local_domains
21090 transport = remote_smtp
21091 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
21093 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
21094 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
21095 they are tried in order
21096 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
21097 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
21100 driver = manualroute
21101 transport = remote_smtp
21102 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
21104 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
21105 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
21106 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
21107 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
21108 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
21109 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
21110 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
21111 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
21114 .cindex "mail hub example"
21115 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
21116 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
21117 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
21118 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
21119 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
21120 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
21121 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
21122 lookup is easier to manage.
21124 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
21125 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
21129 driver = manualroute
21130 transport = remote_smtp
21131 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
21133 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
21134 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
21135 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
21136 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
21137 domain can be used to find the host:
21140 driver = manualroute
21141 transport = remote_smtp
21142 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
21144 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
21145 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
21146 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
21150 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
21151 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
21152 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
21153 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
21154 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
21155 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
21158 driver = manualroute
21159 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
21160 route_list = saved.domain.example
21162 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
21163 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
21164 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
21167 driver = manualroute
21169 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
21170 *.saved.domain2.example \
21171 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
21174 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21176 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
21177 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
21178 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
21179 the address if the lookup fails.
21182 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
21183 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
21184 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
21185 one way it can be done:
21191 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
21192 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
21193 return_fail_output = true
21198 driver = manualroute
21200 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
21202 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
21204 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
21206 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
21207 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
21208 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
21210 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
21211 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
21220 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21221 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21223 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
21224 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
21225 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
21226 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
21227 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
21228 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
21229 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
21230 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
21231 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
21232 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
21234 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
21236 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
21237 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
21238 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
21239 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
21240 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
21243 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
21244 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
21245 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
21246 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
21247 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
21248 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
21251 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
21252 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
21253 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
21254 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
21255 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
21256 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
21257 not set, a value for the gid also.
21259 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
21260 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
21261 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
21262 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
21263 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
21264 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
21268 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
21269 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
21270 before running the command.
21273 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
21274 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
21275 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
21279 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
21280 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
21281 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
21282 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
21283 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
21286 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
21289 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
21290 &%no_more%& is set.
21292 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
21293 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
21294 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
21295 included in the SMTP response.
21297 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
21298 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
21299 included in any SMTP response.
21301 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
21303 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
21304 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
21306 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
21307 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
21308 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
21311 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
21312 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
21315 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
21316 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
21318 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
21319 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
21320 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
21321 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
21323 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
21324 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
21325 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
21326 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
21327 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
21329 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
21330 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
21331 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
21332 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
21333 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
21335 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
21336 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
21337 variable. For example, this return line
21339 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
21341 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
21342 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
21343 .ecindex IIDquerou1
21344 .ecindex IIDquerou2
21349 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21350 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21352 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
21353 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
21354 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
21355 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
21356 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
21357 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
21358 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
21359 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
21360 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
21361 redirected in several different ways:
21364 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
21367 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
21369 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
21371 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
21373 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
21375 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
21377 It can be discarded.
21380 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
21381 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
21382 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
21383 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
21385 If success DSNs have been requested
21386 .cindex "DSN" "success"
21387 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
21388 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
21392 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
21393 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
21394 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
21395 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
21396 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
21397 aliases, in a configuration like this:
21401 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
21403 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
21404 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
21405 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
21406 cause delivery to be deferred.
21408 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
21409 &_.forward_& files, like this:
21414 file = $home/.forward
21417 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
21418 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
21419 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
21420 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
21423 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21424 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21425 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21427 &*Warning*&: It is unwise to use &$local_part$& or &$domain$&
21428 directly for redirection,
21429 as they are provided by a potential attacker.
21430 In the examples above, &$local_part$& is used for looking up data held locally
21431 on the system, and not used directly (the second example derives &$home$& via
21432 the passsword file or database, using &$local_part$&).
21436 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
21437 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
21438 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
21439 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
21442 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
21443 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
21444 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
21445 practice the router may not be able to operate.
21447 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
21448 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
21449 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
21450 saves some resources.
21458 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
21459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21460 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21461 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
21462 can be interpreted in two different ways:
21465 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
21466 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
21467 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
21468 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
21469 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
21470 document is intended for use by end users.
21472 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
21473 described in the next section.
21476 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
21477 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
21478 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
21479 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
21480 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
21484 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
21485 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
21486 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
21487 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
21488 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
21489 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
21490 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
21491 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
21492 commas or newlines.
21493 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
21496 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
21497 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
21498 next newline character is ignored.
21500 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
21501 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
21502 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
21503 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
21506 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21507 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
21508 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
21509 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
21510 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
21511 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
21514 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
21518 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
21519 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
21520 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
21521 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
21522 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
21523 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
21524 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
21525 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
21526 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
21527 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
21528 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
21530 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
21531 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
21532 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
21533 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
21534 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
21536 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
21538 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
21539 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
21540 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
21541 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
21542 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
21545 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
21546 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
21547 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
21548 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
21549 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
21551 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
21552 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
21557 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
21558 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
21561 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21563 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
21564 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
21565 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
21566 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
21567 should really contain
21569 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21571 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
21572 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
21573 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
21577 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
21578 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
21579 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
21582 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
21583 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
21584 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
21585 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
21586 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
21587 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21588 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21590 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
21591 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
21592 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
21593 in double quotes, for example:
21595 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
21597 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
21598 quote just the command. An item such as
21600 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
21602 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
21604 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
21605 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
21606 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
21607 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
21608 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
21609 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
21610 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
21611 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
21612 an &%accept%& router.
21615 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
21616 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
21617 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
21618 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
21620 /home/world/minbari
21622 is treated as a filename, but
21624 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
21626 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
21627 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
21628 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
21629 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
21631 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21632 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21634 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
21635 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
21636 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
21637 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
21640 .cindex "included address list"
21641 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
21642 If an item is of the form
21644 :include:<path name>
21646 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
21647 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
21648 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
21649 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
21650 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
21651 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
21653 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
21655 It must be given as
21657 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
21659 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21660 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21661 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21663 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
21664 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
21665 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
21666 .cindex "black hole"
21667 .cindex "abandoning mail"
21668 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
21669 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
21670 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
21674 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
21675 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
21676 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
21678 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
21679 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
21680 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
21681 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
21685 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
21686 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
21687 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
21688 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
21689 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
21690 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
21691 redirection items of the form
21696 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
21697 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
21698 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
21699 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
21701 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
21703 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
21705 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
21706 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
21708 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
21709 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
21710 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
21712 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21713 By default for verify, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
21714 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
21715 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
21716 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
21717 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
21718 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
21719 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
21720 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
21723 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
21724 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
21725 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
21726 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
21728 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
21729 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
21730 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
21731 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
21732 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
21734 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
21735 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
21736 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
21737 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
21738 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
21742 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
21743 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
21744 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
21745 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
21746 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
21747 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
21748 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
21752 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
21753 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
21754 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
21755 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
21756 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
21757 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
21758 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
21759 aliasing scheme of the type
21761 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
21765 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
21766 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
21767 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
21770 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
21771 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
21773 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
21774 the pipes are distinct.
21778 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
21779 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
21780 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
21781 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
21782 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
21783 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
21784 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
21785 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
21786 can be used to avoid this.
21789 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
21790 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
21791 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
21792 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
21793 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
21794 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
21795 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
21799 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
21801 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
21802 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
21805 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
21806 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
21807 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
21810 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
21811 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
21812 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
21813 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
21816 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
21817 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
21818 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
21819 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
21820 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
21821 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
21822 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
21824 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
21825 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
21828 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
21829 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
21830 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
21831 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
21832 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
21836 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
21837 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
21838 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
21839 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
21840 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
21841 let ordinary users do.
21845 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
21846 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
21847 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
21848 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
21849 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
21850 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
21852 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
21853 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
21854 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
21855 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
21856 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
21857 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
21859 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
21861 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
21862 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
21863 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
21864 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
21865 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
21866 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
21867 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
21868 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
21871 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
21872 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
21873 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
21874 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
21875 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
21876 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
21877 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
21878 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
21882 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
21883 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
21884 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
21885 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
21886 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
21887 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
21890 .option data redirect string&!! unset
21891 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
21892 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
21893 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
21894 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
21895 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
21897 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
21898 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
21899 terminated with newline characters. For example:
21901 data = #Exim filter\n\
21902 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
21904 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
21905 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
21906 choice into a newline.
21909 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
21910 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
21911 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21912 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21913 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
21916 .option file redirect string&!! unset
21917 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
21918 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
21919 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
21920 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
21921 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
21922 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
21923 entirely of comments), the router declines.
21925 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
21926 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
21927 runs a check on the containing directory,
21928 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
21929 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
21930 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
21931 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
21932 not, the router declines.
21935 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
21936 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21937 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
21938 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21939 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21940 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
21941 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
21944 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21945 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21946 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21947 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21948 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21951 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21952 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21953 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21954 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21958 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21959 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21960 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21961 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21962 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21967 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21968 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21969 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21970 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21971 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21972 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21973 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21974 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21975 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21976 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21977 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21980 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21981 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21982 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21983 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21984 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21987 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21988 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21989 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21990 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21991 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21992 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21994 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21995 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21996 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21997 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21998 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21999 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
22000 &_.forward_& files).
22003 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
22004 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22005 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22006 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22007 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
22010 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
22011 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22012 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22013 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
22014 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
22015 of the embedded Perl support.
22018 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
22019 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22020 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22021 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22022 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
22025 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
22026 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22027 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22028 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22029 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
22032 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
22033 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22034 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22035 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
22036 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
22037 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
22038 &%one_time%& is set.
22041 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
22042 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22043 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22044 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22045 to make use of &%run%& items.
22048 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
22049 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22050 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22051 If this option is true, items of the form
22053 :include:<path name>
22055 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
22058 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
22059 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22060 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22061 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
22062 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
22063 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
22064 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
22067 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
22068 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22069 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22070 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
22071 &%allow_filter%& is true.
22074 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
22075 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
22076 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
22077 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
22078 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
22083 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
22084 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
22085 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
22086 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
22087 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
22088 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
22089 bounce may well quote the generated address.
22092 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
22094 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
22095 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
22096 file did not exist.
22099 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
22101 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
22102 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
22103 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
22105 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
22106 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
22107 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
22108 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
22109 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
22110 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
22111 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
22112 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
22116 .option include_directory redirect string unset
22117 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
22118 redirection list must start with this directory.
22121 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
22122 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
22123 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
22126 .option one_time redirect boolean false
22127 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
22128 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
22129 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
22130 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
22131 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
22132 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
22133 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
22134 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
22135 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
22136 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
22137 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
22138 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
22139 before they subscribed.
22141 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
22142 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
22143 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
22144 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
22147 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
22148 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
22149 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
22150 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
22152 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
22153 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
22154 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
22156 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
22159 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
22160 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
22161 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
22162 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
22163 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
22167 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
22168 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
22169 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
22170 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
22171 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
22172 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
22173 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
22174 See &%check_owner%& above.
22177 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
22178 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
22179 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
22180 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
22183 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
22184 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22185 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
22186 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
22187 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
22188 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
22189 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
22192 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
22193 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
22194 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
22195 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
22196 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
22197 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
22198 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
22199 &$qualify_recipient$&.
22201 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
22202 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
22203 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
22206 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
22207 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
22208 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
22209 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
22210 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
22211 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
22212 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
22213 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
22214 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
22215 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
22218 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
22219 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
22220 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
22221 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
22222 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
22223 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
22226 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
22227 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
22228 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
22229 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
22230 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
22231 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
22234 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
22235 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
22236 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
22237 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
22238 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
22241 .option sieve_inbox redirect string&!! inbox
22243 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
22244 name of the mailbox used for "keep" operations (explicit or implicit).
22247 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
22248 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
22249 :subaddress part of an address.
22251 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
22252 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
22253 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
22254 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
22257 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
22258 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
22259 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
22260 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
22261 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
22262 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
22263 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
22267 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
22268 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
22269 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
22270 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
22271 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
22272 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
22273 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
22274 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
22275 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
22276 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
22277 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
22278 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
22279 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
22280 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
22281 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
22282 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
22284 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
22285 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
22286 the following routers.
22288 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
22289 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
22290 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
22291 so it is passed to the following routers.
22293 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
22294 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
22295 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
22296 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
22298 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
22299 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
22300 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
22301 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
22307 file = $home/.forward
22308 file_transport = address_file
22309 pipe_transport = address_pipe
22310 reply_transport = address_reply
22313 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
22314 syntax_errors_text = \
22315 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
22316 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
22317 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
22318 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
22319 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
22320 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
22321 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
22322 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
22323 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
22324 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
22326 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
22327 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
22328 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
22333 local_part_prefix = real-
22334 transport = local_delivery
22336 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
22337 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
22339 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
22340 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
22344 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
22345 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22348 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
22349 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22350 .ecindex IIDredrou1
22351 .ecindex IIDredrou2
22358 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22359 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22361 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
22362 "Environment for local transports"
22363 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
22364 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
22365 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
22366 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
22367 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
22368 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
22369 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
22371 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
22372 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
22373 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
22374 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
22376 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
22377 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
22378 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
22379 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
22380 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
22384 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
22385 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
22386 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
22387 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
22388 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
22389 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
22390 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
22393 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
22394 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
22398 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
22400 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
22401 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
22402 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
22403 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
22408 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
22409 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
22410 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
22411 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
22412 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
22413 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
22414 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
22415 group (set by the transport). For example:
22418 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
22422 transport = group_delivery
22425 # This transport overrides the group
22427 driver = appendfile
22428 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
22431 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
22432 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
22433 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
22436 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
22437 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
22438 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
22439 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
22440 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
22441 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
22443 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
22444 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
22445 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
22446 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
22447 original gid is also used.
22449 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
22450 following that is set is used:
22453 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
22455 A &%group%& setting of the router;
22457 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
22458 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
22460 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
22462 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
22463 the uid is the creator's uid;
22465 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
22468 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
22469 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
22470 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
22471 The first of the following that is set is used:
22474 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
22476 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
22478 A &%user%& setting of the router;
22480 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
22485 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
22486 &%never_users%& list.
22492 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
22493 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
22494 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
22495 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
22496 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
22497 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
22498 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
22499 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
22500 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
22501 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22504 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
22506 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
22508 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
22510 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
22513 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22516 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
22518 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
22522 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
22523 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
22524 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
22528 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
22529 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22530 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22531 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
22532 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
22533 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
22534 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
22535 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
22536 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
22537 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
22538 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
22539 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
22540 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
22541 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
22549 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22550 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22552 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
22553 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
22554 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
22555 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
22556 The name of a transport is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
22557 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
22560 The following generic options apply to all transports:
22563 .option body_only transports boolean false
22564 .cindex "transport" "body only"
22565 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
22566 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
22567 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
22568 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
22569 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
22570 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
22571 automatically suppress them.
22574 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
22575 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
22576 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
22577 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
22578 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
22579 logged, and delivery is deferred.
22582 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
22583 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
22584 deliveries by the transport or for any
22585 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
22586 what you are doing.
22589 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
22590 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
22591 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
22592 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
22594 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
22595 output, and Exim carries on processing.
22596 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
22597 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
22598 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
22599 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
22601 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
22602 transport and the router that called it.
22604 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
22605 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
22606 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
22607 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
22608 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
22609 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
22610 safely be resent to other recipients.
22613 .option driver transports string unset
22614 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
22615 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
22618 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
22619 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22620 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
22621 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
22622 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
22623 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
22624 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
22625 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
22626 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
22627 resent to other recipients.
22629 &*Note:*& If used on a transport handling multiple recipients
22630 (the smtp transport unless &%max_rcpt%& is 1, the appendfile, pipe or lmtp
22631 transport if &%batch_max%& is greater than 1)
22632 then information about Bcc recipients will be leaked.
22633 Doing so is generally not advised.
22636 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
22638 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
22639 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
22642 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
22643 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
22644 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
22645 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
22646 &%user%& (see below).
22649 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
22650 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
22651 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
22652 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22653 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22654 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
22655 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
22656 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
22657 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22658 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22659 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22661 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
22662 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
22665 .option headers_only transports boolean false
22666 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
22667 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
22668 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
22669 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
22670 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
22671 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
22672 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
22675 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
22676 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
22677 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
22678 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22679 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22680 to be removed from the message.
22681 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
22682 Each list item is separately expanded.
22683 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22684 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22685 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22686 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
22688 Matching headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
22689 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
22692 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
22693 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
22695 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
22696 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
22697 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
22701 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
22702 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
22703 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22704 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
22705 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
22706 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
22707 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
22708 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
22711 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
22714 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
22715 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
22716 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
22717 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
22718 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
22719 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
22720 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
22721 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
22722 change envelope recipients at this time.
22725 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
22726 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
22728 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
22729 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
22730 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
22731 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
22732 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
22733 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
22734 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
22738 .option initgroups transports boolean false
22739 .cindex "additional groups"
22740 .cindex "groups" "additional"
22741 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
22742 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
22743 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
22744 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
22747 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
22748 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
22749 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
22750 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
22751 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
22752 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
22753 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
22754 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
22756 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
22757 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
22758 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
22759 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
22760 Obviously there is scope for
22761 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22762 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22764 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
22765 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22766 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22767 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22768 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
22771 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
22772 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
22773 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
22774 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
22775 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
22776 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
22777 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
22778 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
22779 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
22780 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
22781 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
22782 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
22783 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
22788 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
22789 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
22790 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
22791 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
22792 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
22793 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
22794 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
22795 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
22798 local_part_prefix = *-
22800 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
22803 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
22805 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
22806 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
22807 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
22808 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
22809 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
22812 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
22813 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
22814 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
22815 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
22816 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
22817 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
22818 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
22819 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
22820 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
22822 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
22823 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
22824 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
22825 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
22827 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
22828 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
22829 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
22832 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
22833 .cindex "envelope sender"
22834 .cindex "envelope from"
22835 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
22836 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
22837 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
22838 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
22839 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
22840 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
22841 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
22842 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
22843 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
22845 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
22846 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
22848 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
22849 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
22850 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
22851 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
22852 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
22853 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
22854 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
22856 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
22857 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
22858 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
22859 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
22860 &%errors_to%& in a router.
22864 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
22865 .chindex Return-path:
22866 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
22867 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
22868 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
22869 have easy access to it.
22871 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
22872 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
22873 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
22874 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
22875 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
22879 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
22880 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
22883 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
22884 .cindex "shadow transport"
22885 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
22886 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
22887 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
22889 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
22890 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
22891 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
22892 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
22893 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
22894 cause a log line to be written.
22896 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
22897 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
22898 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
22899 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
22900 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
22903 ST=<shadow transport name>
22905 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
22906 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
22907 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
22908 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
22909 headers that some sites insist on.
22912 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
22913 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22914 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22915 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
22916 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
22917 individual users or via a system filter.
22918 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
22920 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
22921 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
22922 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
22923 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock).
22924 The command must be specified as an absolute path.
22926 The process run by the command must use its standard input as the message
22927 data to be transformed, and write the results on its standard output.
22929 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
22930 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
22931 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
22932 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
22933 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
22934 &(pipe)& transports.
22936 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
22937 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
22938 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
22939 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
22940 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
22942 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
22943 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
22944 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
22945 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
22947 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
22948 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
22949 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
22950 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
22951 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
22952 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
22954 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
22955 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
22956 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
22957 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
22958 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
22959 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
22960 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
22961 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
22963 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22964 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
22965 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
22966 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
22967 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22968 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22969 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22970 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22971 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22972 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22975 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22976 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22977 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22978 which the message is being sent. For example:
22979 . used to have $sender_address in this cmdline, but it's tainted
22981 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22982 $host $host_address $pipe_addresses
22985 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22986 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22987 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22989 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22990 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22991 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22994 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22996 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22997 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise.
22999 Option strings in general have any fully-surrounding double quote wrapping
23000 removed early in parsing (see &<<SECTstrings>>&).
23001 Then, for this option, quotes protect against whitespace being
23002 regarded as a separator while splitting into the command argument vector.
23003 Either double or single quotes can be used here;
23004 the former interprets backlash-quoted charachters
23005 and the latter does not.
23007 If double quotes had been used in this example, they would have been
23008 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
23009 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
23010 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
23011 Exim tried to expand the first one.
23013 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
23014 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
23015 arguments. Consider this example:
23017 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
23018 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
23020 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
23021 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
23023 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
23024 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
23028 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
23029 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
23030 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
23031 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
23032 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
23033 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
23034 bounced from a transport filter.
23036 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
23037 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
23038 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
23041 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
23042 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
23043 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
23044 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
23045 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
23046 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
23047 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
23048 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
23049 becomes a temporary error.
23052 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
23053 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23054 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
23055 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
23056 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
23057 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
23058 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
23061 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
23062 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
23063 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
23065 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
23066 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
23067 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
23068 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
23070 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
23071 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
23072 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
23079 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23080 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23082 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
23084 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
23085 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
23086 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
23087 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
23088 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
23089 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
23090 copy of the message is delivered each time.
23092 .cindex "batched local delivery"
23093 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
23094 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
23095 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
23096 local transport, for example:
23099 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
23100 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
23101 recipients saves space.
23103 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
23104 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
23106 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
23107 to a scanner program or
23108 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
23112 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
23113 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
23114 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
23116 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
23117 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
23118 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
23119 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
23120 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
23121 to certain conditions:
23124 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23125 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
23126 batching is possible.
23128 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23129 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
23130 addresses with the same domain are batched.
23132 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
23133 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
23134 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
23135 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
23136 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
23139 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
23140 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
23141 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
23145 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
23146 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
23147 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
23148 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
23149 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
23150 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
23151 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
23154 escape_string = ".."
23156 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
23157 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
23158 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
23160 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
23161 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
23162 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
23163 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
23164 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
23165 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
23167 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
23168 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23169 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
23170 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
23171 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
23172 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
23173 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
23174 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
23175 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
23180 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23181 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23183 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
23184 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
23185 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
23186 .cindex "directory creation"
23187 .cindex "creating directories"
23188 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
23189 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
23190 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
23191 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
23192 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
23193 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
23194 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
23195 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
23196 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
23197 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
23199 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
23200 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
23201 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
23204 .cindex "quota" "system"
23205 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
23206 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
23207 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
23209 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
23210 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
23211 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
23212 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
23214 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
23215 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
23218 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
23219 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
23220 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
23221 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
23226 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
23227 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
23228 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
23229 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
23230 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
23232 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
23233 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23234 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
23235 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
23236 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
23237 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
23238 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
23239 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
23240 operation. There are two cases:
23243 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
23244 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
23245 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
23246 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
23247 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
23248 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
23249 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
23251 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
23252 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
23253 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
23255 If the &%create_file%& option is set to a path which
23256 matches (see the option definition below for details)
23257 a file or directory name
23258 for the delivery, that name becomes de-tainted.
23260 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
23261 .cindex appendfile "tainted data"
23262 Tainted data may not be used for a file or directory name.
23263 This means that, for instance, &$local_part$& cannot be used directly
23264 as a component of a path. It can however be used as the key for a lookup
23265 which returns a path (or component).
23268 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
23269 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
23270 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
23271 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
23276 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
23278 require "fileinto";
23279 fileinto "folder23";
23281 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
23282 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
23283 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the
23288 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
23289 way of handling this requirement:
23291 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
23292 {/var/mail/$local_part_data} \
23293 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
23295 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
23299 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
23300 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
23301 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
23304 An alternative for the &"keep"& aspect is to use the &%sieve_inbox%& option
23305 on the redirect router that calls the Sieve filter,
23306 to explicitly set the filename used.
23309 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
23310 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
23311 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
23312 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
23313 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
23314 path to the transport.
23316 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
23317 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
23320 &*Note 3*&: Permitting a user to enable writes to an absolute path
23321 may be a security issue.
23326 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
23327 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
23331 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
23332 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
23333 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
23334 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
23335 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
23336 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
23337 delivery is deferred.
23340 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
23341 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23342 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23343 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
23344 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
23345 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
23346 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
23347 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
23350 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
23351 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23352 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
23353 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
23357 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
23358 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23361 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
23362 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
23363 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
23364 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
23365 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
23368 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
23369 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
23370 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
23371 process is running.
23374 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
23375 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23376 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
23377 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
23378 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
23379 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
23380 contains is significant.
23382 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
23383 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
23384 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
23385 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
23386 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
23388 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
23389 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
23390 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
23391 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
23392 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
23393 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
23395 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23396 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
23397 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23398 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23400 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
23401 .cindex "directory creation"
23402 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
23403 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
23404 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
23406 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
23407 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
23408 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
23409 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
23410 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
23414 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
23415 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
23416 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
23417 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
23418 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
23421 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
23422 &"belowhome"&, or to an absolute path.
23424 In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
23425 set for the transport, and the file or directory being created must
23427 The "belowhome" checking additionally checks for attempts to use "../"
23428 to evade the testing.
23429 This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
23430 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
23431 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
23432 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
23433 &%file_must_exist%&.
23435 In the fourth case,
23436 the value given for this option must be an absolute path for an
23437 existing directory.
23438 The value is used for checking instead of a home directory;
23439 checking is done in "belowhome" mode.
23441 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
23442 .cindex "de-tainting" "using appendfile create_file option"
23443 If "belowhome" checking is used, the file or directory path
23444 becomes de-tainted.
23447 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
23448 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
23449 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
23450 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
23452 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
23453 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
23454 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
23455 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
23456 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
23458 The result of expansion must not be tainted, unless the &%create_file%& option
23462 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
23464 .vindex "&$inode$&"
23465 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
23466 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
23467 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
23469 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
23471 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
23472 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
23476 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
23477 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
23478 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
23481 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
23482 See &%check_string%& above.
23485 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
23486 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
23487 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
23488 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
23489 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
23490 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
23493 The result of expansion must not be tainted, unless the &%create_file%& option
23496 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23497 .cindex "locking files"
23498 .cindex "lock files"
23499 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
23500 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
23502 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
23503 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
23506 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
23507 file = /home/$local_part_data/inbox
23510 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
23511 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
23512 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
23513 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
23514 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
23515 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
23519 .option file_format appendfile string unset
23520 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
23521 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
23522 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
23523 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
23524 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
23525 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
23526 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
23527 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
23530 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
23531 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
23533 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
23534 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
23535 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
23536 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
23537 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
23538 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
23539 delivery is deferred.
23542 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
23543 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
23544 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
23545 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
23548 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
23549 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23550 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
23551 .cindex "locking files"
23552 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
23553 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
23554 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
23555 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
23556 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
23557 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
23558 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
23559 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
23561 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
23562 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
23563 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
23564 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
23566 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
23567 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
23570 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
23572 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
23573 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
23574 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
23576 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
23577 local deliveries because of errors of the form
23579 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
23582 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
23583 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
23584 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
23585 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
23588 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
23589 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
23590 for details of locking.
23593 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
23594 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
23595 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
23598 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23599 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
23600 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
23603 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
23604 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23605 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
23606 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
23607 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
23610 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
23611 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23612 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23613 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23614 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
23615 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
23616 external source that maintains the data.
23619 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
23620 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23621 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23622 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23623 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
23624 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
23625 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
23626 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
23630 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
23631 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
23632 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
23633 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
23634 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
23635 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
23636 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
23637 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
23638 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
23639 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23642 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
23643 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
23644 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
23645 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
23646 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
23647 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
23648 calculation. The default value is:
23650 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
23652 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
23653 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
23655 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
23657 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
23659 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
23660 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
23661 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
23662 directly into that directory.
23665 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
23666 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
23667 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23670 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
23671 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
23672 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23675 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
23676 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23677 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
23678 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
23679 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
23680 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
23681 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
23682 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23684 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
23685 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
23686 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
23687 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
23688 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
23689 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
23690 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
23691 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
23692 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
23693 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
23696 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
23697 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
23698 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
23699 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
23700 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
23701 below for further details.
23704 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
23705 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23706 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23709 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
23710 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23711 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23714 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
23715 .cindex "locking files"
23716 .cindex "file" "locking"
23717 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
23718 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
23719 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23720 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
23721 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
23722 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
23723 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
23725 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
23726 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
23727 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
23734 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
23735 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
23736 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
23737 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
23738 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
23739 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
23740 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
23741 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
23743 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
23744 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
23745 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
23746 append messages to it.
23749 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23750 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23751 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23752 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23753 in which case it is:
23755 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
23756 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
23758 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23759 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23761 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23762 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23763 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23764 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
23769 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23770 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23772 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23773 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
23774 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
23775 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
23776 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
23777 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
23778 value, and this option is ignored.
23781 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
23782 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
23783 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
23784 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
23785 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
23788 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
23789 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
23790 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
23791 on users about incoming mail.
23794 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
23795 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
23796 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
23797 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
23798 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
23799 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
23800 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
23801 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
23802 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
23804 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
23805 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
23806 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
23808 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
23809 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
23810 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
23811 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
23812 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
23813 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
23815 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
23816 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
23817 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
23818 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
23819 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
23822 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23823 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23825 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
23827 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
23828 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
23829 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
23830 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
23831 system quota failures.
23833 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
23834 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
23835 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
23836 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
23837 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
23838 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
23839 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
23840 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
23841 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
23842 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
23845 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
23846 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
23847 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
23848 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
23849 delivery directory.
23852 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
23853 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
23854 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
23855 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
23856 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
23859 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23860 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23862 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
23863 See &%quota%& above.
23866 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
23867 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
23868 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
23869 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
23870 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
23871 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
23872 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
23874 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
23875 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
23876 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
23877 the file length to the filename. For example:
23879 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
23880 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
23882 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
23883 number of lines in the message.
23885 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
23886 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
23887 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
23889 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
23891 This option should not be used when other message-handling software
23892 may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
23893 will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
23894 disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
23895 a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
23896 as is used to adjust the effective size.
23899 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
23900 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
23901 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
23903 quota_warn_message = "\
23904 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
23905 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
23906 This message is automatically created \
23907 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
23908 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
23909 a warning threshold that is\n\
23910 set by the system administrator.\n"
23914 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
23915 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
23916 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
23917 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23918 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
23919 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
23920 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
23921 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
23922 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
23926 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
23928 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
23929 percent sign is ignored.
23931 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
23932 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
23933 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
23934 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
23935 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
23936 &'From:'& line, the default is:
23938 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
23940 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
23941 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
23944 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
23945 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
23949 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
23950 .cindex "envelope from"
23951 .cindex "envelope sender"
23952 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
23953 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
23954 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
23955 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
23956 for details of batch SMTP.
23959 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
23960 .cindex "carriage return"
23962 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23963 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23964 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
23965 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23967 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
23968 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
23969 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
23970 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
23971 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
23972 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23975 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23976 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
23977 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
23978 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
23979 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23980 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
23983 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
23984 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
23985 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
23986 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
23987 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
23989 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
23990 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
23991 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
23992 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
23994 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
23995 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
23996 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
23997 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
23998 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
24001 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
24002 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
24005 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
24006 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
24007 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
24008 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
24009 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
24010 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
24011 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
24013 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
24014 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
24015 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
24016 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
24019 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
24020 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
24021 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
24024 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
24025 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
24026 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
24027 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
24028 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
24029 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
24030 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
24031 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
24032 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
24034 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
24035 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
24036 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
24037 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
24042 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
24043 .cindex "appending to a file"
24044 .cindex "file" "appending"
24045 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
24048 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
24052 .cindex "directory creation"
24053 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
24054 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
24055 &%directory_mode%& option.
24058 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
24059 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
24063 .cindex "file" "locking"
24064 .cindex "locking files"
24065 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
24066 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
24067 reliably over NFS, as follows:
24070 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
24071 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
24072 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
24074 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
24076 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
24077 Unlink the hitching post name.
24079 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
24080 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
24081 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
24082 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
24084 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
24085 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
24086 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
24087 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
24088 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
24089 it before trying again.
24093 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
24094 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
24095 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
24098 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
24099 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
24100 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
24101 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
24102 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
24103 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
24104 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
24105 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
24106 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
24110 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
24111 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
24112 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
24113 delivery is deferred.
24116 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
24117 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
24118 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
24122 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
24123 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
24124 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
24127 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
24128 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
24129 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
24132 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
24133 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
24134 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
24135 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
24136 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
24137 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
24138 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
24139 that prevents link following.
24142 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
24143 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
24144 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
24145 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
24146 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
24149 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
24152 .cindex "file" "locking"
24153 .cindex "locking files"
24154 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
24155 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
24156 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
24157 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
24158 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
24160 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
24162 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
24163 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
24164 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
24166 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
24167 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
24168 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
24170 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
24171 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
24172 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
24173 delivery is deferred.
24175 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
24176 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
24177 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
24178 immediately. It retries up to
24180 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
24182 times (rounded up).
24185 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
24186 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
24189 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
24190 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
24191 .cindex "&""From""& line"
24192 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
24193 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
24194 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
24195 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
24196 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
24197 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
24198 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
24200 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
24201 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
24202 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
24203 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
24204 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
24205 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
24206 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
24208 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
24209 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
24210 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
24211 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
24214 .cindex "maildir format"
24215 .cindex "mailstore format"
24216 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
24217 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
24218 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
24219 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
24220 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
24222 .cindex "directory creation"
24223 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
24224 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
24225 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
24226 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
24227 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
24228 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
24233 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
24234 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
24235 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
24236 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
24237 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
24238 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
24239 &_new_& subdirectory.
24241 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
24242 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
24243 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
24244 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
24245 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
24246 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
24247 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
24249 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
24250 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
24251 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
24252 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
24253 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
24254 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
24255 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
24256 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
24258 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
24259 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
24260 folders. Consider this example:
24262 maildir_format = true
24263 directory = /var/mail/$local_part_data\
24264 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
24265 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
24266 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
24268 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
24269 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
24270 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
24271 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
24272 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
24273 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
24275 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
24276 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
24277 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
24278 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
24279 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
24281 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
24282 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
24283 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
24285 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
24286 .cindex "maildir++"
24287 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
24288 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
24289 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
24290 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
24291 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
24292 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
24293 amount of space used.
24295 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
24296 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
24297 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
24298 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
24299 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
24300 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
24305 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
24306 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
24307 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
24308 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
24309 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
24310 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
24313 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
24314 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
24315 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
24316 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
24317 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
24318 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
24319 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
24320 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
24321 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
24322 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
24323 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
24324 backwards compatibility).
24326 For one common implementation, you might set:
24328 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
24330 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
24332 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
24333 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
24334 &[stat()]& each message file.
24337 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
24338 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
24339 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
24340 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
24341 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
24342 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
24343 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
24344 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
24345 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
24347 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
24348 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
24349 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
24350 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
24351 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
24352 need to know the quota.
24354 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
24355 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
24357 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
24358 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
24359 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
24363 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
24364 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
24365 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
24366 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
24367 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
24368 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
24369 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
24370 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
24372 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
24373 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
24374 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
24375 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
24376 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
24377 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
24379 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
24380 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
24381 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
24382 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
24383 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
24384 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
24386 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
24387 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
24388 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
24389 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
24392 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
24393 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
24394 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
24395 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
24396 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
24398 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
24400 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
24401 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
24402 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
24403 .ecindex IIDapptra1
24404 .ecindex IIDapptra2
24411 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24412 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24414 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
24415 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
24416 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
24417 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
24418 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
24419 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
24420 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
24421 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
24423 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
24424 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
24425 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
24426 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
24427 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
24430 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
24431 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
24432 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
24433 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
24434 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
24436 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
24437 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
24438 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
24439 transport is run as a consequence of a
24441 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
24442 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
24443 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
24444 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
24445 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
24446 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
24448 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
24449 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
24450 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
24451 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
24453 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
24454 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
24455 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
24456 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
24457 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
24458 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
24459 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
24461 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
24462 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
24463 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
24464 the transport defers.
24465 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
24466 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
24468 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
24469 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
24470 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
24471 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
24473 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24474 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
24475 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
24476 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
24477 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
24478 problems. They are just discarded.
24482 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
24483 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
24485 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
24486 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
24487 message when the message is specified by the transport.
24490 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
24491 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
24492 when the message is specified by the transport.
24495 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
24496 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
24497 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
24498 string comes first.
24501 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
24502 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
24503 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
24506 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
24507 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
24508 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
24511 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
24512 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
24513 specified by the transport.
24516 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
24517 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
24518 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
24519 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
24522 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
24523 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
24524 the message is specified by the transport.
24527 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
24528 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
24532 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
24533 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
24534 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
24535 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
24536 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
24540 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
24541 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
24542 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
24543 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
24545 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
24546 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
24547 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
24548 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
24549 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
24550 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
24551 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
24554 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
24555 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
24556 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
24557 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
24558 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
24560 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
24561 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
24562 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
24563 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
24564 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
24565 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
24568 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
24569 See &%once%& above.
24572 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
24573 See &%once%& above.
24574 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
24577 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
24578 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
24579 specified by the transport.
24582 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
24583 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
24584 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
24585 configuration option.
24588 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
24589 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
24590 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
24591 automatic responses. For example:
24593 subject = Re: $h_subject:
24595 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
24596 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
24597 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
24598 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
24603 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
24604 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
24605 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
24606 the text comes first.
24609 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
24610 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
24611 when the message is specified by the transport.
24612 .ecindex IIDauttra1
24613 .ecindex IIDauttra2
24618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24621 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
24622 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
24623 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
24624 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
24625 .cindex "LMTP" "over a unix-domain socket"
24626 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
24628 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
24629 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
24630 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
24631 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
24632 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
24633 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
24637 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
24638 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
24639 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
24642 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
24643 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24646 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
24647 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24648 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
24649 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
24650 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24653 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
24654 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
24655 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
24656 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
24657 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
24658 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
24661 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
24662 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24663 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
24664 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
24665 in its response to the LHLO command.
24667 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
24668 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
24669 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
24670 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
24673 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
24674 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
24675 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
24676 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
24681 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
24685 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
24686 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
24690 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24691 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24693 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
24694 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
24695 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
24696 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
24697 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
24698 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
24699 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
24700 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
24704 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24705 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
24706 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
24707 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
24708 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
24710 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24711 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
24712 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
24713 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
24714 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
24715 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
24716 that are routed to the transport.
24718 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
24719 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
24720 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
24721 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
24722 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
24723 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
24724 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
24728 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
24729 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
24730 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
24732 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
24733 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
24734 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
24735 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
24736 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
24737 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
24738 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
24740 .cindex "tainted data" "in pipe command"
24741 .cindex pipe "tainted data"
24742 Tainted data may not be used for the command name.
24745 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
24746 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
24747 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
24748 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
24749 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
24750 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
24751 of "1" to enforce serialization.
24756 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
24757 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
24758 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
24759 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
24760 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
24761 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
24762 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
24763 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
24764 &"local delivery failed"&.
24766 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
24767 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
24768 will be sent as normal.
24770 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
24771 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
24772 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
24773 apply in this case.
24775 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
24776 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
24777 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
24778 a non-existent command may be the problem.
24780 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
24781 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
24782 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
24783 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
24784 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
24785 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
24786 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
24791 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
24792 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
24793 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
24794 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
24795 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
24798 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
24799 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
24800 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
24801 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
24803 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
24804 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
24805 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
24806 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
24807 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
24809 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
24811 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
24812 arguments. You have to write
24814 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
24816 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
24817 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
24818 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
24819 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
24820 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
24821 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
24824 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
24827 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24828 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24829 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24830 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
24831 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
24832 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
24833 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
24834 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
24835 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
24836 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
24837 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
24839 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
24840 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
24841 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
24842 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
24843 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
24844 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
24845 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
24846 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
24848 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
24849 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
24850 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
24851 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
24852 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
24853 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
24854 control what is done with it.
24856 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
24857 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
24858 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
24859 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
24860 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
24861 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
24862 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
24863 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
24864 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
24865 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
24866 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
24870 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
24871 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24872 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24873 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
24874 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
24875 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
24876 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
24877 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
24878 &*Note*&: Using enviroment variables loses track of tainted data.
24879 Writers of &(pipe)& transport commands should be wary of data supplied
24880 by potential attackers.
24882 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
24883 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
24884 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
24885 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
24886 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
24887 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
24888 &`LOGNAME `& see below
24889 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
24890 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
24891 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
24892 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
24893 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
24894 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
24895 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
24896 &`USER `& see below
24898 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
24899 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
24900 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
24901 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
24902 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
24903 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
24904 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
24907 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
24908 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
24909 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
24913 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
24914 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
24915 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
24916 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
24919 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
24920 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
24924 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
24925 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
24926 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24927 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
24928 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
24929 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
24930 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
24931 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
24932 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
24933 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
24934 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
24937 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
24939 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
24940 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
24941 &%use_shell%& is set.
24944 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
24945 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24948 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
24949 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24950 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24953 .option check_string pipe string unset
24954 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
24955 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
24956 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
24957 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
24958 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
24959 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
24960 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
24964 .option command pipe string&!! unset
24965 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
24966 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
24967 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
24968 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
24969 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
24970 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
24972 .cindex "tainted data"
24973 No part of the resulting command may be tainted.
24976 .option environment pipe "string list&!!" unset
24977 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24978 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24979 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
24980 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
24981 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24982 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
24985 .option escape_string pipe string unset
24986 See &%check_string%& above.
24989 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
24990 .cindex "exec failure"
24991 .cindex "failure of exec"
24992 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
24993 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
24994 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
24995 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
24996 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
24999 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
25000 .cindex "signal exit"
25001 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
25002 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
25003 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
25004 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
25007 .option force_command pipe boolean false
25008 .cindex "force command"
25009 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
25010 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
25011 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
25012 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
25013 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
25014 command. For example:
25016 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
25020 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
25021 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
25022 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
25025 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
25026 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
25027 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
25028 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
25029 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
25030 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
25032 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
25033 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
25036 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
25037 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
25038 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
25039 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
25040 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
25041 written to the main log.
25044 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
25045 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
25046 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
25047 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
25048 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
25049 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
25053 .option log_output pipe boolean false
25054 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
25055 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
25056 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
25057 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
25060 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
25061 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
25062 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
25063 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
25064 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
25065 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
25066 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
25067 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
25070 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
25071 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
25072 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
25075 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
25079 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
25080 .cindex "&""From""& line"
25081 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
25082 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
25083 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
25088 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
25089 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
25092 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
25093 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
25094 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
25095 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
25099 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
25100 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
25103 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
25104 This option is expanded and
25105 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
25106 variable of the subprocess.
25107 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
25108 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
25109 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
25112 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
25113 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
25114 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
25115 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
25116 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
25117 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
25118 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
25119 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
25120 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
25123 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
25124 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
25125 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
25126 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
25127 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
25128 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
25129 accept the message is used.
25132 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
25133 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
25134 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
25135 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
25136 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
25137 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
25140 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
25141 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
25142 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
25143 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
25144 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
25145 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
25146 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
25150 .option return_output pipe boolean false
25151 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
25152 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
25153 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
25154 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
25155 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
25156 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
25157 of them may be set.
25161 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
25162 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
25163 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
25164 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
25165 and &%return_output%& is not set,
25166 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
25167 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
25168 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
25169 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
25170 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
25171 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
25172 and 73, respectively.
25175 .option timeout pipe time 1h
25176 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
25177 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
25178 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
25179 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
25180 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
25181 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
25183 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
25184 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
25185 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
25186 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
25187 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
25188 delivery to be deferred.
25190 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
25191 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
25194 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
25195 .cindex "envelope sender"
25196 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
25197 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
25198 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
25199 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
25200 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
25202 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
25203 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
25204 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
25205 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
25206 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
25207 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
25211 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
25212 .cindex "carriage return"
25214 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
25215 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
25216 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
25217 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
25219 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
25220 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
25221 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
25222 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
25223 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
25226 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
25227 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
25228 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
25229 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
25230 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
25231 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
25232 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
25233 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
25234 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
25239 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
25240 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
25241 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
25242 .cindex "external local delivery"
25243 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
25244 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
25245 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
25246 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
25247 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
25248 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
25249 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
25250 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
25251 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
25252 configuration for &%procmail%&:
25257 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part_data
25261 check_string = "From "
25262 escape_string = ">From "
25264 user = $local_part_data
25271 transport = procmail_pipe
25273 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
25274 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
25275 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
25276 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
25277 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
25278 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
25280 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
25284 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
25285 use a shell to run pipe commands.
25288 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
25289 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
25290 . Used to have R: local_part_suffix = .* + T: -m $local_part_suffix_v
25291 . but that suffix is tainted so cannot be used in a command arg
25292 . Really, you'd want to use a lookup for acceptable suffixes to do real detainting
25295 local_delivery_cyrus:
25297 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
25298 -- $local_part_data
25310 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
25312 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
25313 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
25315 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
25316 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
25319 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25320 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25322 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
25323 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
25324 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
25325 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
25326 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
25327 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
25328 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
25329 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
25332 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
25333 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
25337 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
25338 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
25339 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
25340 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
25341 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
25342 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
25343 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
25345 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
25346 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
25347 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
25348 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
25349 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
25350 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
25355 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
25356 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
25357 no further messages are sent over that connection.
25361 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
25363 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25364 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
25365 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
25366 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
25367 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
25368 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
25369 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
25370 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
25373 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
25374 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
25375 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
25376 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
25377 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
25378 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
25379 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
25380 are the values that were set when the message was received.
25381 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
25382 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
25383 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
25384 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
25385 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
25386 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
25388 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
25389 and will be removed in a future release.
25392 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
25393 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
25394 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
25397 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
25398 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
25399 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
25400 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
25401 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
25402 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
25403 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
25404 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
25406 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
25407 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
25408 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25409 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
25410 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
25411 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
25412 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
25413 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
25414 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
25417 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
25419 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
25420 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
25421 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
25422 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
25423 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
25426 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
25427 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
25428 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
25429 particular connection.
25431 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
25432 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
25433 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
25434 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
25436 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
25437 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
25438 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
25440 authenticated_sender = $local_part
25442 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
25443 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
25445 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
25446 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
25450 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
25451 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
25452 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
25453 authenticated as a client.
25456 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
25457 .cindex timeout "smtp transport command"
25458 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
25459 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
25460 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
25463 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
25464 .cindex timeout "smtp transport connect"
25465 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
25466 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
25467 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
25468 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
25469 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
25470 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
25473 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
25474 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
25475 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
25476 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25477 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
25478 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
25479 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
25482 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
25483 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a MAILMAX value,
25484 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
25485 that value also constrains the result of this option.
25488 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25489 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
25490 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25491 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
25492 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
25493 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
25494 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
25495 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
25496 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
25497 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
25498 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
25499 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
25500 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
25501 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
25504 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
25505 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data blocks"
25506 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
25507 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
25508 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
25511 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
25512 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25513 .option dkim_domain smtp "string list&!!" unset
25514 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25515 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
25516 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25517 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
25518 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25519 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
25520 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25521 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
25522 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25523 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
25524 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25525 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
25526 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25527 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
25528 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25531 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
25532 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
25533 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
25534 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
25535 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
25538 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
25539 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
25540 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
25541 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
25542 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
25543 unhappy at this prospect, so...
25545 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25546 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
25547 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25548 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
25549 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
25550 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
25551 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
25552 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
25556 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
25557 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
25558 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
25559 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
25560 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
25563 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
25564 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
25565 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
25566 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
25570 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
25571 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25572 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25573 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25574 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25575 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
25576 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
25577 transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
25582 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
25583 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25584 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25585 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25586 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25587 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
25588 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
25589 useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
25590 &%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
25594 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
25595 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
25596 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
25597 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
25598 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
25599 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
25600 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
25602 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
25603 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
25604 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
25605 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
25606 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
25609 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
25610 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25611 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
25612 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
25613 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
25614 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25615 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25616 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
25618 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
25619 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
25620 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
25621 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
25622 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
25623 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
25625 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
25626 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
25627 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
25628 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
25629 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
25631 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
25632 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
25633 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
25634 copy of the message is sent.
25636 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
25637 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
25638 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
25639 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
25643 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
25644 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data accept"
25645 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
25646 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
25649 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
25650 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
25651 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
25652 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
25653 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
25654 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
25656 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
25657 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
25658 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
25659 implementations of TLS.
25661 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
25662 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
25663 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
25664 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
25665 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
25666 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
25667 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
25672 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
25673 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
25674 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
25675 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
25676 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
25677 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
25678 interface address, you could use this:
25680 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address} \
25681 {${listextract{1}{<\n $value}}} \
25682 {$primary_hostname}}
25684 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
25687 .option host_name_extract smtp "string list&!!" "see below"
25688 .cindex "load balancer" "hosts behind"
25689 .cindex TLS resumption
25690 Some mail-accepting sites
25691 (notably Microsoft)
25692 operate many servers behind a network load-balancer. When this is done,
25693 with separated TLS session caches, TLS session resuption becomes problematic.
25694 It will only succeed when the same server happens to be selected by the
25695 load-balancer, matching the session stored in the client's cache.
25697 Exim can pull out a server name, if there is one, from the response to the
25698 client's SMTP EHLO command.
25699 For normal STARTTLS use, the default value of this option:
25701 ${if and { {match {$host} {.outlook.com\$}} \
25702 {match {$item} {\N^250-([\w.]+)\s\N}} \
25705 suffices for one known case.
25707 During the expansion of this option the &$item$& variable will have the
25708 server's EHLO response.
25710 For TLS-on-connect connections we do not have an EHLO
25711 response to use. Because of this the default value of this option is
25712 set to a static string for those cases, meaning that resumption will
25713 always be attempted if permitted by the &%tls_resumption_hosts%& option.
25715 The result of the option expansion is included in the key used to store and
25716 retrieve the TLS session, for session resumption.
25718 Operators of high-load sites may wish to evaluate their logs for indications
25719 of other destination sites operating load-balancers, and develop a suitable
25720 expression for this option.
25721 The smtp:ehlo event and the &$tls_out_resumption$& variable
25722 will be useful for such work.
25724 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
25725 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
25726 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
25727 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
25728 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
25729 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
25731 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
25732 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
25733 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
25734 &%hosts_override%& is set.
25736 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
25737 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
25738 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
25739 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25740 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25741 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
25742 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
25744 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
25745 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
25746 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
25747 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
25748 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
25749 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
25750 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
25753 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
25754 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
25757 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25758 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
25759 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
25760 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
25761 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25762 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
25763 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
25764 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
25765 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
25766 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
25769 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
25770 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25771 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
25772 Exim will not use the ESMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
25773 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
25775 .option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
25776 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
25777 .cindex "pipelining" PIPECONNECT
25778 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
25779 this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
25780 and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
25782 The retry hints database is used for the record,
25783 and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
25784 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
25785 It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
25786 so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
25788 See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
25791 When the facility is used, if the transport &%interface%& option is unset
25792 the &%helo_data%& option
25793 will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
25795 A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
25796 presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
25797 can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
25798 You have been warned.
25801 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25802 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25803 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25804 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25806 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25807 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25808 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
25809 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
25810 to any host that matches this list.
25813 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
25814 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25815 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
25816 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
25817 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
25818 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
25819 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
25820 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
25823 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
25824 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
25825 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
25830 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25831 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25832 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25833 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25834 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
25835 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25836 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
25837 explanation of when this might be needed.
25839 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25840 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25841 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25842 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25843 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
25844 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25845 message on the same session.
25847 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
25848 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
25849 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
25850 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
25851 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
25852 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
25857 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
25858 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
25859 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
25860 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
25861 &%fallback_hosts%&.
25864 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
25865 .cindex "randomized host list"
25866 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
25867 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
25868 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
25869 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
25870 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
25871 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
25872 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
25873 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
25875 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
25876 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
25877 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
25878 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
25880 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
25882 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
25883 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
25884 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
25886 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25887 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
25888 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
25889 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
25890 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
25891 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
25892 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
25893 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
25894 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25897 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" "see below"
25898 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25899 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
25900 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25901 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25903 The default is &"**"& if DANE is not in use for the connection,
25904 or if DANE-TA us used.
25905 It is empty if DANE-EE is used.
25907 .option hosts_require_alpn smtp "host list&!!" unset
25908 .cindex ALPN "require negotiation in client"
25910 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
25911 If the TLS library supports ALPN
25912 then a successful negotiation of ALPN will be required for any host
25913 matching the list, for TLS to be used.
25914 See also the &%tls_alpn%& option.
25916 &*Note*&: prevention of fallback to in-clear connection is not
25917 managed by this option; see &%hosts_require_tls%&.
25919 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
25920 .cindex DANE "transport options"
25921 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
25922 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
25923 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
25924 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
25925 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25926 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25927 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25929 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25930 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25931 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
25932 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25933 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25935 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25936 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25937 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25938 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25939 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
25940 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
25942 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25943 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
25944 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25945 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
25946 connects. If authentication fails
25947 and &%hosts_require_auth%& permits,
25948 Exim will try to transfer the message unauthenticated.
25949 See also chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25951 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
25952 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
25953 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
25954 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
25955 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25956 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
25957 Unless DKIM signing is being done,
25958 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
25960 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
25961 .cindex DANE "transport options"
25962 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
25963 If built with DANE support, Exim will look up a
25964 TLSA record for any host matching the list,
25965 If one is found and that lookup was DNSSEC-validated,
25966 then Exim requires that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made for that host;
25967 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25968 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25969 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25971 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
25972 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
25973 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
25974 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
25975 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
25976 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
25977 perform a TCP Fast Open.
25978 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
25979 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
25980 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
25982 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
25983 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
25985 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
25986 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
25987 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
25988 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
25989 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
25991 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
25992 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
25993 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
25994 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25995 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
25996 for multi-recipient messages.
25997 The option can usually be left as default.
25999 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
26000 .cindex "bind IP address"
26001 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
26003 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26004 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
26005 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
26006 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
26007 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
26008 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
26009 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
26010 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
26013 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
26014 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
26015 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
26016 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
26017 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
26018 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
26021 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
26023 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
26024 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
26025 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
26026 interface to use if the host has more than one.
26029 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
26030 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
26031 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
26032 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
26033 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
26034 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
26035 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
26036 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
26037 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
26038 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
26042 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
26043 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
26044 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
26045 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
26046 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
26048 .option max_rcpt smtp integer&!! 100
26049 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
26052 limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
26053 SMTP message transaction.
26054 A value setting of zero disables the limit.
26056 If a constant is given,
26057 each set of addresses is treated independently, and
26058 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
26061 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
26062 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a RCPTMAX value,
26063 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
26064 that value also constrains the result of this option
26065 and no parallel connections will be caused on meeting the RCPTMAX limit.
26068 .option message_linelength_limit smtp integer 998
26069 .cindex "line length" limit
26070 This option sets the maximum line length, in bytes, that the transport
26071 will send. Any messages with lines exceeding the given value
26072 (before a transport filter, if any)
26073 will fail and a failure-DSN ("bounce") message will if possible be returned
26075 The default value is that defined by the SMTP standards.
26077 It is generally wise to also check in the data ACL so that messages
26078 received via SMTP can be refused without producing a bounce.
26081 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
26082 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26083 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
26084 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
26085 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
26086 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
26087 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
26088 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
26090 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
26091 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
26092 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
26094 If the connection is DANE-enabled then this option is ignored;
26095 only messages having the domain used for the DANE TLSA lookup are
26096 sent on the connection.
26098 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
26099 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a RCPTDOMAINMAX value,
26100 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
26101 this option is regarded as being false.
26104 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
26105 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
26106 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
26107 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
26108 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
26109 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
26110 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
26111 variable that contains an outgoing port.
26113 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
26114 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
26116 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
26117 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
26118 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
26121 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
26122 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
26126 .option protocol smtp string smtp
26127 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
26128 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
26129 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
26131 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
26132 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
26133 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
26134 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
26135 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
26137 &*Note*&: When using LMTP it should be considered whether the default values
26138 for some other features, such as DANE, are appropriate.
26140 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
26141 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
26142 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
26143 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
26144 but as of RFC 8314 it is preferred over STARTTLS for message submission
26145 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
26148 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
26149 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
26150 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
26151 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
26152 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
26153 addresses is not affected.
26155 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
26156 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
26157 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
26158 Exim to use only the host name.
26159 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
26162 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26163 .cindex "serializing connections"
26164 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
26165 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
26166 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
26167 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
26168 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
26169 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
26170 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
26172 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
26173 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
26174 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
26175 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
26176 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
26177 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
26179 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
26180 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
26181 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
26182 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
26183 are used for ETRN serialization.
26185 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
26188 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
26189 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
26190 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
26191 .cindex "size" "of message"
26192 .cindex "transport" "filter"
26193 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
26194 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
26195 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
26196 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
26197 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
26198 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
26199 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
26201 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
26202 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
26205 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
26206 .cindex proxy SOCKS
26207 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
26208 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
26211 .option tls_alpn smtp string&!! unset
26212 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
26214 .cindex ALPN "set name in client"
26215 If this option is set
26216 and the TLS library supports ALPN,
26217 the value given is used.
26219 As of writing no value has been standardised for email use.
26220 The authors suggest using &"smtp"&.
26224 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
26225 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
26226 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
26228 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26229 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
26230 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
26231 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
26232 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
26235 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
26236 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
26237 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
26238 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
26242 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
26243 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
26244 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
26245 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
26246 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
26249 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
26250 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
26251 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
26252 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
26253 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
26254 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
26257 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
26260 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
26261 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
26263 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26264 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
26265 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
26266 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
26267 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26268 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
26269 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
26270 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26273 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
26274 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
26275 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
26277 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26278 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
26279 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
26280 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
26281 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26282 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
26283 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
26284 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
26285 ciphers is a preference order.
26288 .option tls_resumption_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26289 .cindex TLS resumption
26290 This option controls which connections to use the TLS resumption feature.
26291 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
26295 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
26296 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
26298 .cindex SNI "setting in client"
26299 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
26300 If this option is set
26301 and the connection is not DANE-validated
26302 then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
26303 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
26304 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
26305 certificate and private key for the session.
26307 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
26309 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
26315 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
26316 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
26317 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
26318 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
26319 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
26320 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
26321 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
26322 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
26323 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26324 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26328 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
26329 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26330 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26331 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
26332 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
26333 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
26334 Note that unless the host is in this list
26335 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
26336 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
26337 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
26338 certificate verification succeeds.
26341 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
26342 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
26343 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26344 This option give a list of hosts for which,
26345 while verifying the server certificate,
26346 checks will be included on the host name
26347 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
26348 versus the Subject-Alternate-Name (or, if none, Subject-Name) fields.
26349 Wildcard names are permitted,
26350 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
26352 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
26355 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
26356 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26357 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26359 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26360 The value of this option must be either the
26362 or the absolute path to
26363 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
26364 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
26366 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
26367 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
26368 is taken as empty and an explicit location
26371 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
26372 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
26374 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
26376 either by file or directory
26377 are added to those given by the system default location.
26379 The values of &$host$& and
26380 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26381 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26383 For back-compatibility,
26384 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
26385 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
26386 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
26389 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26390 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26391 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26392 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
26393 certificate verification must succeed.
26394 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
26395 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
26396 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
26397 &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
26398 that connections use TLS.
26399 Fallback to in-clear communication will be done unless restricted by
26400 the &%hosts_require_tls%& option.
26402 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer&!! -1
26403 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
26404 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
26405 If built with internationalization support,
26406 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
26408 If, after expansion, the value is 1, 0, or -1 then this value overrides
26409 any value previously set for the message. Otherwise, any previously
26410 set value is used. To permit use of a previous value,
26411 set this option to an empty string.
26412 For details on the values see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
26417 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
26419 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
26420 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
26421 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
26422 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
26423 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
26426 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
26427 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
26428 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
26429 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
26432 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
26433 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
26434 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
26436 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
26437 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
26438 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
26439 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
26440 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
26442 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
26443 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
26444 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
26445 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
26446 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
26447 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
26448 see below for an exception).
26450 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
26451 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
26452 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
26453 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
26454 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
26456 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
26457 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
26458 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
26459 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
26460 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
26461 reached their retry times.
26463 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
26464 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
26465 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
26466 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
26467 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
26468 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
26469 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
26470 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
26471 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
26472 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
26475 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
26476 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
26477 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
26478 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
26479 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
26480 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
26482 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
26483 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
26484 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
26485 possible IP addresses have been tried.
26486 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
26487 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
26493 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26494 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26496 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
26497 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
26498 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
26499 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
26500 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
26501 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
26503 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
26504 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
26505 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26506 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
26507 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
26508 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
26509 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
26511 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
26512 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
26513 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
26514 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
26517 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
26518 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
26519 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
26520 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
26522 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
26523 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
26524 facility; you do not have to use it.
26526 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
26527 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
26528 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
26529 address to which it applies.
26531 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
26532 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
26533 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
26534 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
26535 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
26536 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
26539 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
26540 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
26541 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
26542 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
26545 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
26546 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
26547 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
26548 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
26549 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
26552 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
26553 illustrated by these examples:
26556 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
26557 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
26558 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
26559 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
26561 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
26562 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
26567 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
26568 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
26569 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
26570 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
26571 message's processing.
26573 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26574 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
26575 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&), but no
26576 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
26577 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
26578 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
26579 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
26580 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
26581 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
26583 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26584 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26585 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
26586 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
26587 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
26588 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
26589 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
26590 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
26591 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
26592 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
26594 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
26595 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
26596 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
26597 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
26598 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
26599 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
26601 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
26602 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
26603 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
26605 .cindex "envelope from"
26606 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
26607 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
26608 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
26609 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
26610 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
26611 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
26612 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
26613 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
26614 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
26616 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
26617 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
26623 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
26624 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
26625 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
26626 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
26627 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
26628 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
26629 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
26630 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
26631 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
26632 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
26634 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
26636 might produce the output
26638 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26639 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26640 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26641 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26642 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26643 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26644 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26645 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26647 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
26648 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
26649 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
26650 set for a particular transport.
26653 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
26654 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
26655 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
26658 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
26660 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
26661 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
26662 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
26663 any colons must be doubled, of course).
26665 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
26666 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
26667 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
26668 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
26671 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
26672 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
26673 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
26675 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
26676 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
26677 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
26678 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
26679 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
26680 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
26681 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
26683 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26684 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26685 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
26686 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
26687 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
26691 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
26692 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26695 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
26696 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
26697 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
26698 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
26699 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
26700 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
26701 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
26702 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
26703 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
26705 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
26706 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
26707 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
26709 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
26710 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
26711 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
26712 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
26713 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
26714 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
26715 of pattern they are set as follows:
26718 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
26719 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
26720 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
26723 *queen@*.fict.example
26725 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
26727 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
26731 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
26732 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
26735 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
26736 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
26737 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
26738 rewriting rule of the form
26740 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
26742 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
26748 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
26749 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
26750 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
26751 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
26752 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
26756 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
26757 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
26758 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
26759 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
26760 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
26762 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
26764 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
26767 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26768 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26769 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
26770 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
26771 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26772 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
26773 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
26774 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
26775 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
26776 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
26777 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
26778 entry written to the panic log.
26782 .subsection "Rewriting flags" "SSECID153"
26783 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
26786 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
26789 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
26791 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
26794 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
26795 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
26799 .subsection "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
26801 .cindex rewriting flags
26802 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
26803 &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
26804 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
26805 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
26806 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
26808 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
26809 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
26810 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
26811 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
26812 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
26813 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
26814 &`h`& rewrite all headers
26815 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
26816 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
26817 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
26819 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
26820 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
26821 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
26823 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
26824 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
26827 .subsection "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" SSECTrewriteS
26828 .cindex SMTP "rewriting malformed addresses"
26829 .cindex RCPT "rewriting argument of"
26830 .cindex MAIL "rewriting argument of"
26831 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
26832 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
26833 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
26834 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
26835 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
26837 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26838 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26839 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
26840 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
26841 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
26842 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
26843 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
26844 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
26847 .subsection "Flags controlling the rewriting process" SSECID155
26848 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
26849 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
26850 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
26853 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
26854 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
26855 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
26857 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
26858 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
26859 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
26860 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
26862 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
26863 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
26864 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
26866 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
26867 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
26868 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
26869 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
26871 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
26875 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
26878 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
26879 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
26880 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
26881 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
26882 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
26883 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
26884 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
26885 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
26887 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
26888 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
26892 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
26893 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
26895 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
26896 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
26897 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
26899 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
26900 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
26901 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
26902 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
26903 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
26904 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
26905 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
26906 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
26908 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
26909 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
26911 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
26913 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
26914 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
26916 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
26917 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
26918 messages that originate outside the local host:
26920 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
26921 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
26923 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
26926 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
26927 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
26928 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
26929 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
26930 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
26931 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
26932 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
26933 components. For example, the rule
26935 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
26937 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
26938 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
26939 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
26940 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
26941 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
26942 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
26943 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
26950 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26951 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26953 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
26954 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
26955 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
26956 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
26957 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
26958 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
26959 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
26960 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
26961 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
26962 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
26963 address, domain and error.
26965 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
26966 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
26967 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
26968 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
26969 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
26970 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
26971 log selector is set, the message
26972 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
26973 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
26974 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
26975 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
26977 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
26978 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
26979 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
26980 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
26981 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
26982 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
26983 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
26984 domain are maintained independently.
26986 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
26987 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
26988 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
26989 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
26990 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
26991 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
26992 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
26993 the local address is reached.
26995 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
26996 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
26997 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
26998 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
26999 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
27001 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
27002 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
27003 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
27004 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
27005 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
27006 messages that it should now be retaining.
27010 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
27011 .cindex "retry" "rules"
27012 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
27013 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
27014 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
27015 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
27016 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
27017 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
27018 message's sender, respectively.
27021 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
27022 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
27023 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
27024 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
27025 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
27026 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
27029 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27031 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
27034 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27036 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
27037 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
27040 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
27041 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
27042 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
27043 expressions work in address lists.
27045 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
27046 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
27050 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
27051 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
27052 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
27053 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
27054 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
27055 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
27056 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
27057 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
27058 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
27060 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
27061 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
27062 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
27063 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
27066 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
27067 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
27068 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
27069 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
27070 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
27071 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
27072 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
27073 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
27074 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
27075 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
27080 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
27082 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
27083 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
27084 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
27085 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
27086 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
27087 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
27089 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
27093 and the retry rules are
27095 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
27096 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
27098 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
27099 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
27100 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
27101 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
27102 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
27103 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
27105 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
27106 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
27107 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
27108 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
27110 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
27111 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
27112 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
27114 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
27116 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
27117 textual form of the IP address.
27119 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
27120 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
27121 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
27122 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
27125 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
27126 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
27127 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
27129 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
27130 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
27131 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
27133 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
27134 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
27136 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
27137 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
27140 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
27141 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
27142 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
27143 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
27144 retry rule of this form:
27146 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
27148 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
27149 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
27152 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
27153 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
27154 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
27155 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
27158 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
27159 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
27160 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
27161 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
27162 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
27164 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
27165 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
27167 .vitem &%refused_A%&
27168 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
27171 A connection was refused.
27173 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
27174 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
27176 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
27177 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
27179 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
27180 A connection attempt timed out.
27182 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
27183 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
27184 obtained from an MX record.
27186 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
27187 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
27188 obtained from an MX record.
27191 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
27193 .vitem &%tls_required%&
27194 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
27195 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
27196 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
27199 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
27202 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
27203 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
27204 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
27205 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
27206 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
27207 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
27211 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
27212 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
27213 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
27214 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
27215 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
27219 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
27220 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
27221 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
27223 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
27224 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
27225 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
27226 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
27227 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
27228 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
27229 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
27231 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
27232 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
27235 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
27236 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
27237 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
27242 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
27243 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
27244 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
27245 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
27246 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
27249 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
27251 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
27253 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
27255 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
27256 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
27259 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
27261 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
27262 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
27263 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
27264 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
27265 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
27267 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
27268 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
27270 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
27272 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
27273 list is never matched.
27279 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
27280 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
27281 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
27282 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
27284 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
27286 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
27287 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
27288 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
27289 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
27290 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
27292 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
27293 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
27294 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
27295 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
27296 The available algorithms are:
27299 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
27302 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
27303 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
27304 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
27306 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
27307 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
27308 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
27309 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
27310 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
27311 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
27312 queue processing times.
27315 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
27316 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
27317 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
27318 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
27319 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
27320 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
27321 interval is found. The main configuration variable
27322 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
27323 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
27324 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
27325 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
27326 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
27328 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
27329 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
27330 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
27331 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
27332 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
27333 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
27336 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
27337 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
27338 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
27339 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
27340 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
27341 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
27342 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
27343 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
27344 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
27345 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
27346 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
27347 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
27349 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
27350 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
27351 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
27352 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
27353 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
27354 deliveries that have been deferred.
27357 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
27358 Here are some example retry rules:
27360 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
27361 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
27362 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
27363 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27364 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
27365 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
27367 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
27368 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
27369 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
27370 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
27371 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
27372 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
27373 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
27376 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
27377 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
27378 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
27379 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
27380 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
27382 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
27383 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
27384 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
27385 were not obtained from an MX record.
27387 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
27388 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
27389 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
27390 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
27391 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
27395 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
27396 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
27397 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
27398 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
27399 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
27400 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
27401 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
27402 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
27403 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
27404 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
27405 failing for the first time.
27407 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
27408 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
27409 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
27410 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
27412 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
27413 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
27414 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
27419 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
27420 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
27421 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
27422 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
27423 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
27424 default retry rule:
27426 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
27428 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
27429 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
27430 failure for the recipient address that counts.
27432 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
27433 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
27434 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
27435 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
27436 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
27438 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
27439 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
27440 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
27442 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
27443 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
27444 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
27445 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
27446 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
27447 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
27448 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
27449 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
27450 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
27451 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
27452 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
27454 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
27455 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
27456 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
27457 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
27458 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
27461 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
27462 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
27463 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
27464 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
27465 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
27466 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
27467 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
27468 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
27469 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
27472 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
27473 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
27474 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
27475 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
27476 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
27477 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
27478 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
27479 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
27482 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
27483 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
27484 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
27485 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
27486 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
27487 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
27488 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
27489 time out the address.
27491 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
27492 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
27493 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
27494 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
27495 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
27496 considered immediately.
27497 .ecindex IIDretconf1
27498 .ecindex IIDregconf2
27505 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27506 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27508 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
27509 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
27510 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
27511 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
27512 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
27513 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
27514 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
27515 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
27516 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
27519 The name of an authenticator is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
27520 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
27523 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
27524 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
27525 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
27528 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
27529 the client's EHLO command.
27531 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
27532 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
27534 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
27535 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
27536 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
27537 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
27538 with the AUTH command.
27540 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
27542 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
27543 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
27544 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27547 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
27548 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
27549 unauthenticated connection.
27552 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
27553 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
27554 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
27555 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
27557 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
27558 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
27559 &`Connected to server.example.`&
27560 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
27561 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
27562 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
27563 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
27564 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
27569 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
27570 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
27571 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
27572 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
27573 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
27574 included by setting
27577 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
27581 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
27586 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
27587 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
27588 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
27589 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
27590 work via a socket interface.
27591 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
27592 as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
27593 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
27594 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
27595 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
27596 supporting setting a server keytab.
27597 The seventh can be configured to support
27598 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
27599 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
27600 The eighth authenticator
27601 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
27602 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
27603 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
27605 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
27606 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
27607 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
27608 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
27609 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
27610 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
27611 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
27613 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
27614 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
27615 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
27616 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
27617 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
27618 both sets of options, is required. For example:
27622 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27623 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
27625 client_secret = secret2
27627 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
27628 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
27630 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
27631 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
27632 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
27635 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
27636 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
27637 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
27638 authenticating data.
27640 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
27641 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
27642 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
27643 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
27644 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
27645 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
27646 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
27647 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
27648 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
27649 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
27652 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
27653 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
27654 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
27655 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
27659 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
27660 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
27661 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
27663 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27664 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
27665 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
27666 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
27667 encrypted by a setting such as:
27669 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27673 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27674 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
27675 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
27676 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
27679 .option driver authenticators string unset
27680 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
27681 authenticators is to be used.
27684 .option public_name authenticators string unset
27685 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
27686 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
27687 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
27688 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
27689 defaults to the driver's instance name.
27692 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27693 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
27694 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
27695 mechanism is not advertised.
27696 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
27697 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
27698 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
27701 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27702 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
27703 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
27706 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
27707 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
27709 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
27710 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
27711 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
27712 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
27713 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
27714 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
27715 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27716 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
27717 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
27721 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
27722 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
27723 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
27724 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
27725 out the values of variables.
27726 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
27727 output, and Exim carries on processing.
27730 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27731 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27732 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
27733 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
27734 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
27735 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
27736 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
27737 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
27738 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
27739 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
27740 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
27741 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
27744 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27745 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
27746 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
27747 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
27748 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
27749 remembered for later use.
27750 How it is used is described in the following section.
27756 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
27757 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
27758 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
27759 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
27760 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
27764 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
27765 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
27767 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
27769 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
27770 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
27771 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
27772 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
27773 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
27774 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
27775 given for the MAIL command.
27777 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
27778 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
27781 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
27782 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
27783 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
27784 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
27785 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
27786 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
27787 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
27792 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
27793 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
27794 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
27795 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
27797 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
27798 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
27799 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
27800 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
27801 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
27806 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
27807 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
27808 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
27809 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
27813 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
27815 If the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
27816 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
27819 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
27820 the mechanisms are advertised.
27822 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
27823 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
27824 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
27825 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
27826 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
27827 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
27828 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
27830 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
27832 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
27834 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
27835 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
27836 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
27839 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
27841 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27842 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
27843 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
27845 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
27846 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
27847 command. This is the case if
27850 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
27852 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
27854 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
27855 server authenticators.
27859 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
27860 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
27861 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
27863 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
27864 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
27865 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
27866 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
27867 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
27868 rejected with a 504 error.
27870 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
27871 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
27872 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
27873 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
27874 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
27875 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
27876 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
27877 no successful authentication.
27879 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
27880 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
27881 &%authresults%& expansion item.
27883 .cindex authentication "failure event, server"
27884 If an authenticator is run and does not succeed,
27885 an event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "auth:fail" is raised.
27886 While the event is being processed the variables
27887 &$sender_host_authenticated$& (with the authenticator name)
27888 and &$authenticated_fail_id$& (as set by the authenticator &%server_set_id%& option)
27890 If the event is serviced and a string is returned then the string will be logged
27891 instead of the default log line.
27892 See <<CHAPevents>> for details on events.
27895 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
27896 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
27897 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
27898 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
27899 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
27900 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
27901 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
27905 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
27907 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
27908 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
27909 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
27910 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
27911 command line to run this script on such data might be
27913 encode '\0user\0password'
27915 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
27916 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
27917 whose code value is zero.
27919 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
27920 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
27921 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
27922 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
27924 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
27925 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
27926 example, a command such as
27928 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
27930 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
27932 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to produce
27933 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
27935 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
27937 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
27938 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
27939 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
27940 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
27944 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
27945 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
27946 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
27947 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
27948 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
27949 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
27952 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
27953 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
27954 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
27955 of the authenticator.
27958 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27959 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
27960 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
27961 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
27962 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
27963 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
27964 delivery to be deferred.
27966 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
27967 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
27968 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
27972 .cindex authentication "failure event, client"
27973 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code),
27974 an event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "auth:fail" is raised.
27975 While the event is being processed the variable
27976 &$sender_host_authenticated$& (with the authenticator name)
27978 If the event is serviced and a string is returned then the string will be logged.
27979 See <<CHAPevents>> for details on events.
27982 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
27983 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
27984 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
27985 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
27986 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
27987 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
27988 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
27989 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
27990 deliver the message unauthenticated.
27993 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
27994 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
27995 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
27996 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
27997 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
27998 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
27999 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
28000 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
28002 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
28004 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
28005 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
28006 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
28007 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
28008 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
28009 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
28010 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
28011 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
28012 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
28013 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
28014 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
28015 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
28016 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
28023 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28024 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28026 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
28027 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
28028 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
28029 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
28030 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
28031 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
28032 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
28033 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
28034 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
28035 connections as you do for login accounts.
28037 .section "Avoiding cleartext use" "SECTplain_TLS"
28038 The following generic option settings will disable &(plaintext)& authenticators when
28039 TLS is not being used:
28041 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
28042 client_condition = ${if def:tls_out_cipher}
28045 &*Note*&: a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not vulnerable to casual snooping,
28046 but is still vulnerable to a Man In The Middle attack unless certificates
28047 (including their names) have been properly verified.
28049 .section "Plaintext server options" "SECID171"
28050 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
28051 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
28053 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
28054 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
28055 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
28057 .option server_prompts plaintext "string list&!!" unset
28058 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
28059 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
28062 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
28063 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28064 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28065 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
28066 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28067 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28068 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28070 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
28071 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
28072 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
28073 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
28074 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
28075 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
28076 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
28078 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
28079 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
28080 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
28081 string expansions that also use them for other things.
28083 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
28084 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
28085 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
28087 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28088 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
28089 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
28090 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
28091 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
28092 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
28093 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
28094 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
28095 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
28096 string as the error text.
28098 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
28099 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
28100 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
28104 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
28105 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
28106 .cindex authentication PLAIN
28107 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28108 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
28109 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
28110 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
28111 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
28113 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
28114 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
28115 configured as follows:
28119 public_name = PLAIN
28121 server_condition = \
28122 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
28123 server_set_id = $auth2
28125 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
28126 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
28127 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
28128 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
28130 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
28131 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
28132 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
28133 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
28137 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
28139 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
28141 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
28142 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
28146 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
28147 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
28149 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
28150 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
28151 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
28152 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
28153 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
28155 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
28156 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
28157 authenticating clients it could make sense.
28159 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
28160 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
28161 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
28162 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
28163 This is an incorrect example:
28165 server_condition = \
28166 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
28168 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
28169 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
28170 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
28171 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
28172 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
28173 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
28174 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
28176 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
28177 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
28179 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
28180 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
28181 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
28182 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
28183 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
28186 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
28187 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
28188 .cindex authentication LOGIN
28189 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
28190 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
28191 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
28192 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
28196 public_name = LOGIN
28197 server_prompts = User Name : Password
28198 server_condition = \
28199 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
28200 server_set_id = $auth1
28202 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
28203 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
28204 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
28205 strings are used to obtain two data items.
28207 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
28208 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
28209 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
28210 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
28211 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
28215 public_name = LOGIN
28216 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
28217 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
28220 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
28221 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
28222 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
28223 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
28225 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
28226 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
28227 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
28228 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
28229 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
28230 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
28231 uninterpreted string.
28234 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
28235 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
28236 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
28237 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
28238 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
28244 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
28245 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
28246 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
28248 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
28249 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
28250 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
28251 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
28254 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
28255 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
28256 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
28257 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
28258 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
28259 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
28260 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
28261 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
28262 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
28263 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
28264 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
28265 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
28267 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
28268 splitting takes priority and happens first.
28270 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
28271 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
28272 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
28273 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
28276 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
28277 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
28281 public_name = PLAIN
28282 client_send = ^username^mysecret
28284 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
28285 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs.
28286 Note that due to the ambiguity of parsing three consectutive circumflex characters
28287 there is no way to provide a password having a leading circumflex.
28291 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
28295 public_name = LOGIN
28296 client_send = : username : mysecret
28298 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
28299 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
28301 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
28302 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
28307 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28308 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28310 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
28311 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
28312 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
28313 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
28314 .cindex authentication CRAM-MD5
28315 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
28316 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
28317 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
28318 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
28319 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
28320 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
28321 available in plain text at either end.
28324 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
28325 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
28326 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
28327 authenticator as a server:
28329 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
28330 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
28331 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
28332 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
28333 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
28334 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
28335 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
28336 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
28337 returned to the client.
28339 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
28340 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
28341 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
28342 numeric variables for other things.
28344 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
28345 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
28346 user name, authentication fails.
28350 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28351 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
28352 server_set_id = $auth1
28354 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28355 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
28356 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
28357 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
28361 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28362 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
28364 server_set_id = $auth1
28366 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
28367 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
28369 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
28370 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
28371 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
28376 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28377 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
28378 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
28379 server_set_id = $auth1
28382 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
28383 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
28384 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
28388 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
28389 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
28390 computing the response to the server's challenge.
28393 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
28394 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
28395 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
28399 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28400 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
28401 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
28402 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
28403 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
28404 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
28405 send the message to the current server.
28407 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
28412 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28414 client_secret = secret
28416 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
28417 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
28421 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28422 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28424 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
28425 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
28426 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
28427 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
28429 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
28430 at A L Digital Ltd.
28432 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
28433 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
28434 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
28435 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
28436 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
28438 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
28439 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
28440 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
28441 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
28443 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
28444 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
28445 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
28446 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
28447 depending on the driver you are using.
28449 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
28450 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
28451 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
28452 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
28453 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
28456 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
28457 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
28458 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
28459 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
28460 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
28461 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
28462 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
28463 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
28466 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
28467 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
28468 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
28469 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
28470 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
28471 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
28475 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
28476 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28477 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
28478 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
28481 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
28482 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28483 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28484 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28488 driver = cyrus_sasl
28489 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28490 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28491 server_set_id = $auth1
28494 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
28495 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
28498 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
28499 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
28502 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
28503 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
28504 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
28505 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
28508 driver = cyrus_sasl
28509 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28510 server_set_id = $auth1
28513 driver = cyrus_sasl
28514 public_name = PLAIN
28515 server_set_id = $auth2
28517 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
28518 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
28519 but it is present in many binary distributions.
28520 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
28521 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
28526 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28527 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28528 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
28529 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
28530 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
28531 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
28532 Dovecot 2 POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
28533 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
28534 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
28535 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
28536 authenticator only. There is only one non-generic option:
28538 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
28540 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
28541 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
28542 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
28543 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
28547 public_name = PLAIN
28548 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher}
28549 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28550 server_set_id = $auth1
28555 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28556 server_set_id = $auth1
28559 &*Note*&: plaintext authentication methods such as PLAIN and LOGIN
28560 should not be advertised on cleartext SMTP connections.
28561 See the discussion in section &<<SECTplain_TLS>>&.
28563 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
28564 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
28565 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
28566 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
28567 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
28568 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
28570 The Dovecot configuration to match the above will look
28573 conf.d/10-master.conf :-
28578 unix_listener auth-client {
28585 conf.d/10-auth.conf :-
28587 auth_mechanisms = plain login ntlm
28590 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
28591 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
28594 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28595 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28596 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
28597 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
28598 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
28599 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
28600 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
28601 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
28602 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
28603 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
28604 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
28605 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
28606 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
28607 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM family"
28608 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides integration for the GNU SASL
28609 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
28610 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
28611 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
28612 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
28613 without code changes in Exim.
28615 The library is expected to add support in an upcoming
28616 realease for the SCRAM-SHA-256 method.
28617 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_SHA_256 will be defined
28620 To see the list of mechanisms supported by the library run Exim with "auth" debug
28621 enabled and look for a line containing "GNU SASL supports".
28622 Note however that some may not have been tested from Exim.
28625 .option client_authz gsasl string&!! unset
28626 This option can be used to supply an &'authorization id'&
28627 which is different to the &'authentication_id'& provided
28628 by &%client_username%& option.
28629 If unset or (after expansion) empty it is not used,
28630 which is the common case.
28632 .option client_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28633 See &%server_channelbinding%& below.
28635 .option client_password gsasl string&!! unset
28636 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28637 the password to be used, in clear.
28639 .option client_username gsasl string&!! unset
28640 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28641 the account name to be used.
28644 .option client_spassword gsasl string&!! unset
28645 This option is only supported for library versions 1.9.1 and greater.
28646 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY will be defined when this is so.
28648 If a SCRAM mechanism is being used and this option is set
28649 and correctly sized
28650 it is used in preference to &%client_password%&.
28651 The value after expansion should be
28652 a 40 (for SHA-1) or 64 (for SHA-256) character string
28653 with the PBKDF2-prepared password, hex-encoded.
28655 Note that this value will depend on the salt and iteration-count
28656 supplied by the server.
28657 The option is expanded before use.
28658 During the expansion &$auth1$& is set with the client username,
28659 &$auth2$& with the iteration count, and
28660 &$auth3$& with the salt.
28662 The intent of this option
28663 is to support clients that can cache thes salted password
28664 to save on recalculation costs.
28665 The cache lookup should return an unusable value
28666 (eg. an empty string)
28667 if the salt or iteration count has changed
28669 If the authentication succeeds then the above variables are set,
28670 .vindex "&$auth4$&"
28671 plus the calculated salted password value value in &$auth4$&,
28672 during the expansion of the &%client_set_id%& option.
28673 A side-effect of this expansion can be used to prime the cache.
28676 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28677 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
28678 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
28679 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
28680 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
28683 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
28684 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
28685 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
28688 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
28689 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
28690 When using this feature the "-PLUS" variants of the method names need to be used.
28692 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
28693 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
28694 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
28696 . However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be vulnerable in current versions.
28697 . Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
28698 . with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
28700 This option was deprecated in previous releases due to doubts over
28701 the "Triple Handshake" vulnerability.
28702 Exim takes suitable precausions (requiring Extended Master Secret if TLS
28703 Session Resumption was used) for safety.
28706 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
28707 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28708 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28709 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28712 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
28713 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28714 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28715 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28720 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28721 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28722 server_set_id = $auth1
28726 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
28727 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
28728 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
28729 the password itself.
28731 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
28732 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
28733 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
28734 if available, else the empty string.
28735 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
28736 else the empty string.
28738 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
28740 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
28741 option to be simply "true".
28744 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
28745 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
28746 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28749 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! 4096
28750 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
28751 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
28752 when this option is expanded.
28754 The result of expansion should be a decimal number,
28755 and represents both a lower-bound on the security, and
28756 a compute cost factor imposed on the client
28757 (if it does not cache results, or the server changes
28758 either the iteration count or the salt).
28759 A minimum value of 4096 is required by the standards
28760 for all current SCRAM mechanism variants.
28762 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
28763 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
28764 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
28765 when this option is expanded.
28766 The value should be a base64-encoded string,
28767 of random data typically 4-to-16 bytes long.
28768 If unset or empty after expansion the library will provides a value for the
28769 protocol conversation.
28772 .option server_key gsasl string&!! unset
28773 .option server_skey gsasl string&!! unset
28774 These options can be used for the SCRAM family of mechanisms
28775 to provide stored information related to a password,
28776 the storage of which is preferable to plaintext.
28778 &%server_key%& is the value defined in the SCRAM standards as ServerKey;
28779 &%server_skey%& is StoredKey.
28781 They are only available for version 1.9.0 (or later) of the gsasl library.
28782 When this is so, the macros
28783 _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_GSASL_SERVER_KEY
28784 and _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY
28787 The &$authN$& variables are available when these options are expanded.
28789 If set, the results of expansion should for each
28790 should be a 28 (for SHA-1) or 44 (for SHA-256) character string
28791 of base64-coded data, and will be used in preference to the
28792 &%server_password%& option.
28793 If unset or not of the right length, &%server_password%& will be used.
28795 The libgsasl library release includes a utility &'gsasl'& which can be used
28796 to generate these values.
28799 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
28800 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
28801 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28804 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
28805 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28806 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
28807 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
28809 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
28810 meanings for these variables:
28813 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
28814 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
28816 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
28817 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
28819 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
28820 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
28823 On a per-mechanism basis:
28826 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
28827 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
28828 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28830 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
28831 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
28832 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28834 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
28835 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
28836 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
28837 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28840 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
28841 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
28842 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
28845 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
28846 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
28848 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
28850 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28851 server_realm = imap.example.org
28852 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
28853 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
28854 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
28855 server_condition = yes
28859 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28862 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
28863 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
28864 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
28865 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
28866 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
28867 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
28868 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
28871 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
28872 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
28873 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
28874 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28876 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
28877 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
28878 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
28879 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
28881 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
28882 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
28883 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
28887 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
28888 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
28889 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
28890 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
28892 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
28893 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
28894 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
28895 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
28897 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28899 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
28900 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
28902 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
28903 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
28904 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
28909 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28910 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28912 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
28913 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
28914 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
28915 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
28916 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
28917 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
28918 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
28919 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
28920 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
28921 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
28922 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
28923 taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
28924 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
28928 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
28929 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
28931 The server sends back a challenge.
28933 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
28934 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
28937 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
28941 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
28942 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
28943 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
28945 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
28946 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
28947 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
28948 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
28949 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
28950 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
28951 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
28952 for other things. For example:
28957 server_password = \
28958 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
28960 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28961 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28967 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
28968 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
28969 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
28973 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
28974 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
28977 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
28978 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
28981 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
28982 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
28983 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
28989 client_username = msn/msn_username
28990 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
28991 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
28993 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
28994 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
29000 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29001 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29003 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
29004 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
29005 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
29006 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
29007 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
29008 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
29009 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
29010 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
29011 The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
29012 (&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
29013 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
29014 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
29015 by the server configuration.
29017 The client presents an identity in-clear.
29018 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
29019 and for clients to only attempt,
29020 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
29022 One possible use, compatible with the
29023 K-9 Mail Android client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
29024 is for using X509 client certificates.
29026 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
29027 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
29028 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
29029 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
29030 client certificates only.
29032 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
29033 client-certificate authentication is being done.
29035 The client must present a certificate,
29036 for which it must have been requested via the
29037 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
29038 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29039 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
29040 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
29042 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
29043 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
29044 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
29046 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
29047 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
29048 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29049 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
29050 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
29051 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
29052 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
29054 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
29056 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
29057 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29058 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
29059 "in &(external)& authenticator"
29060 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
29061 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29063 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
29064 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
29065 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
29066 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
29067 an identity for authentication and
29068 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
29070 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
29071 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
29072 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
29073 string expansions that also use them for other things.
29075 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
29076 Once an identity has been received,
29077 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
29078 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
29079 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
29080 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
29081 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
29082 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
29083 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
29084 string as the error text.
29088 ext_ccert_san_mail:
29090 public_name = EXTERNAL
29092 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
29093 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
29094 {$tls_in_peercert}}
29095 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
29096 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
29097 server_set_id = $auth1
29099 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
29100 of your configured trust-anchors
29101 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
29102 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
29104 &*Note*&: up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN.
29105 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
29106 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
29110 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
29111 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
29112 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
29114 .option client_send external string&!! unset
29115 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
29116 identity being asserted.
29122 public_name = EXTERNAL
29124 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
29125 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
29129 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
29130 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
29136 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29137 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29139 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
29140 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
29141 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
29142 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
29143 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
29144 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
29145 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
29146 authentication based on client certificates.
29148 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
29149 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
29150 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
29151 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
29152 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
29153 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
29155 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
29156 for which it must have been requested via the
29157 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
29158 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29160 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
29161 run immediately after a TLS connection being negotiated
29162 (due to either STARTTLS or TLS-on-connect)
29163 and can authenticate the connection.
29164 If it does, SMTP authentication is not subsequently offered.
29166 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
29169 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
29170 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
29172 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
29173 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
29174 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
29175 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
29176 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
29177 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
29179 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
29180 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
29181 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
29183 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
29190 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
29191 {$tls_in_peercert}}
29192 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
29195 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
29196 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
29197 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
29199 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
29201 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
29202 of your configured trust-anchors
29203 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
29204 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
29206 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
29207 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
29208 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
29210 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
29212 . An alternative might use
29214 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
29216 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
29217 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
29218 . This would help for per-device use.
29220 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
29221 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
29223 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
29224 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
29227 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
29228 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
29229 a connect- or helo-ACL.
29233 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29234 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29236 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
29237 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
29238 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
29239 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
29240 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
29243 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
29244 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
29245 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
29246 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
29247 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
29248 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
29249 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
29250 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
29251 certificates are used.
29253 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
29254 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
29255 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
29256 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
29257 between them is encrypted.
29259 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
29260 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
29261 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
29262 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
29265 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
29266 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
29267 in order to get TLS to work.
29271 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
29273 .cindex "submissions protocol"
29274 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
29275 .cindex "smtps protocol"
29276 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
29277 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
29278 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
29279 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
29280 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
29281 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
29282 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
29283 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
29285 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
29286 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
29287 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
29289 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
29290 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
29291 reassigned for other use.
29292 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
29294 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
29295 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
29296 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
29298 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
29299 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
29300 the most common use is expected to be:
29302 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
29304 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
29305 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
29306 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
29307 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
29308 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
29311 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
29312 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
29319 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
29320 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
29321 TLS is supported in Exim using either the OpenSSL or GnuTLS library.
29322 To build Exim to use OpenSSL you need to set
29328 To build Exim to use GnuTLS, you need to set
29334 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
29335 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
29337 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
29340 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
29341 cannot be the path of a directory
29342 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
29343 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
29345 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
29347 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
29348 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
29349 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
29350 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
29351 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
29353 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
29354 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
29355 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
29356 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
29357 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
29358 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
29359 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
29362 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
29363 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
29365 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
29366 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
29367 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
29368 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
29370 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option,
29371 it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
29373 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
29374 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
29375 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
29376 implementation, then patches are welcome.
29378 The output from "exim -bV" will show which (if any) support was included
29380 Also, the macro "_HAVE_OPENSSL" or "_HAVE_GNUTLS" will be defined.
29384 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
29385 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
29386 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
29387 but not the chosen filename.
29388 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
29389 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
29391 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
29392 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
29393 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
29394 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
29396 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
29397 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
29398 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
29399 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
29400 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
29401 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
29402 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
29404 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
29405 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
29406 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
29407 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
29408 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
29410 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
29411 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
29412 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
29413 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
29414 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
29415 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
29417 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
29418 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
29419 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
29421 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
29422 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
29423 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
29424 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
29427 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
29430 # chown exim:exim new-params
29431 # chmod 0600 new-params
29432 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
29433 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
29434 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
29435 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
29436 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
29437 # chmod 0400 new-params
29438 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
29440 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
29441 stalling is removed.
29443 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
29444 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
29445 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
29446 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
29447 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
29448 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
29449 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
29450 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
29451 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
29452 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
29453 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
29455 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
29456 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
29457 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
29458 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
29460 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
29461 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
29462 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
29463 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
29464 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
29467 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
29468 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
29469 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
29470 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
29471 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
29472 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
29473 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
29474 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
29475 directly to this function call.
29476 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
29477 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
29478 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
29479 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
29482 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
29484 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
29485 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
29486 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
29489 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
29490 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
29491 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
29495 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
29498 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
29499 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
29502 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
29503 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
29505 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
29506 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
29509 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
29510 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
29511 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
29512 not be moved to the end of the list.
29515 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
29518 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
29519 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
29522 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29523 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
29524 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
29525 choice of clients used:
29527 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
29528 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29533 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
29535 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
29538 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
29539 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
29540 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
29541 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
29543 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
29545 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
29549 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
29551 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
29552 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
29553 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
29554 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
29555 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
29556 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
29557 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
29558 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
29559 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
29560 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
29562 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
29563 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
29565 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
29566 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
29567 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
29568 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
29569 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
29570 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
29572 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
29573 "Priority strings". This is online as
29574 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
29575 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
29576 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
29577 then the example code
29578 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
29579 on that site can be used to test a given string.
29583 # Disable older versions of protocols
29584 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
29587 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
29588 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
29589 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
29591 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29592 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
29593 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
29594 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
29598 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29604 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
29605 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
29606 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
29607 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
29608 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
29609 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
29610 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
29611 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
29613 If STARTTLS is to be used you
29614 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
29616 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
29617 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
29618 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
29621 554 Security failure
29623 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
29624 rejected with a 554 error code.
29626 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
29627 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
29629 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
29630 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
29631 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
29632 from someone able to intercept the communication.
29634 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
29636 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
29638 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
29639 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
29641 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
29642 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
29643 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
29644 that goes with it. These files need to be
29645 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
29646 always be given as full path names.
29647 The key must not be password-protected.
29648 They can be the same file if both the
29649 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
29650 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
29651 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
29652 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
29653 the server's certificate.
29655 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
29656 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
29657 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
29658 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
29659 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
29660 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
29662 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
29663 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
29664 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
29666 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
29667 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
29668 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
29671 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
29672 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
29673 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
29675 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
29677 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
29678 with the parameters contained in the file.
29679 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
29684 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
29685 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
29686 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
29687 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
29693 for a way of generating file data.
29695 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
29696 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
29697 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
29698 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
29699 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
29701 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29702 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29703 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
29704 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
29705 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
29706 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
29707 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
29708 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
29709 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
29711 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
29712 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
29713 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
29714 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
29715 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
29716 documentation for more details.
29718 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
29719 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
29722 .subsection "Requesting and verifying client certificates"
29723 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29724 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29725 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
29726 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
29727 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
29728 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
29729 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
29730 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
29731 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
29732 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
29733 an explicit file or,
29734 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
29735 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
29737 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
29740 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
29741 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
29742 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
29744 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
29746 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
29748 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
29749 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
29751 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
29752 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
29753 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
29754 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
29755 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
29756 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
29757 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
29758 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
29759 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
29760 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
29762 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
29763 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
29764 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
29765 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
29767 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
29768 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
29769 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
29770 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
29771 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
29772 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
29775 .subsection "Caching of static server configuration items" "SSECTserverTLScache"
29776 .cindex certificate caching
29777 .cindex privatekey caching
29778 .cindex crl caching
29779 .cindex ocsp caching
29780 .cindex ciphers caching
29781 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
29782 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
29783 .cindex tls_certificate caching
29784 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
29785 .cindex tls_crl caching
29786 .cindex tls_ocsp_file caching
29787 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
29788 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
29789 .cindex caching certificate
29790 .cindex caching privatekey
29791 .cindex caching crl
29792 .cindex caching ocsp
29793 .cindex caching ciphers
29794 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
29795 If any of the main configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&,
29796 &%tls_crl%& and &%tls_ocsp_file%& have values with no
29797 expandable elements,
29798 then the associated information is loaded at daemon startup.
29799 It is made available
29800 to child processes forked for handling received SMTP connections.
29802 This caching is currently only supported under Linux and FreeBSD.
29804 If caching is not possible, for example if an item has to be dependent
29805 on the peer host so contains a &$sender_host_name$& expansion, the load
29806 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
29808 The cache is invalidated and reloaded after any changes to the directories
29809 containing files specified by these options.
29811 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
29812 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
29813 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
29814 The latter case is not automatically invalidated;
29815 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
29816 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
29817 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
29818 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
29820 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
29821 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executable.
29823 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
29824 save significant time and processing on every TLS connection
29830 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
29831 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29832 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29833 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
29834 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
29835 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
29836 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
29837 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
29838 within the &(smtp)& transport.
29840 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
29841 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
29842 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
29843 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
29844 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
29845 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
29847 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
29848 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
29849 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
29850 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
29851 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
29854 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
29855 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
29856 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
29857 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
29858 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
29859 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
29860 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
29861 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
29862 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
29863 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
29866 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
29867 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
29869 This is an optional thing for TLS connections, although either end
29871 If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
29872 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
29874 &*Note*&: Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
29875 for client use (they are usable for server use).
29876 As the TLS protocol has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
29877 in failed connections.
29879 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
29880 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
29882 the system default set (depending on library version),
29884 or (depending on library version) a directory.
29885 The client verifies the server's certificate
29886 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
29887 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
29888 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
29889 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
29891 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
29892 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
29893 or need not succeed respectively.
29895 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
29896 name checks are made on the server certificate.
29897 The match against this list is, as per other Exim usage, the
29898 IP for the host. That is most closely associated with the
29899 name on the DNS A (or AAAA) record for the host.
29900 However, the name that needs to be in the certificate
29901 is the one at the head of any CNAME chain leading to the A record.
29902 The option defaults to always checking.
29904 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
29905 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
29906 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
29908 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
29909 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
29910 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
29913 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
29914 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
29915 for OCSP to be relevant.
29918 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
29919 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
29920 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
29921 alternative hosts, if any.
29924 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
29925 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
29926 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
29930 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
29931 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
29932 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
29933 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
29934 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
29936 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
29937 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
29938 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
29939 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
29940 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
29941 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
29942 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
29943 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
29944 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
29945 outgoing connection.
29949 .subsection "Caching of static client configuration items" SECTclientTLScache
29950 .cindex certificate caching
29951 .cindex privatekey caching
29952 .cindex crl caching
29953 .cindex ciphers caching
29954 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
29955 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
29956 .cindex tls_certificate caching
29957 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
29958 .cindex tls_crl caching
29959 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
29960 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
29961 .cindex caching certificate
29962 .cindex caching privatekey
29963 .cindex caching crl
29964 .cindex caching ciphers
29965 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
29966 If any of the transport configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&
29967 and &%tls_crl%& have values with no
29968 expandable elements,
29969 then the associated information is loaded per smtp transport
29970 at daemon startup, at the start of a queue run, or on a
29971 command-line specified message delivery.
29972 It is made available
29973 to child processes forked for handling making SMTP connections.
29975 This caching is currently only supported under Linux.
29977 If caching is not possible, the load
29978 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
29980 The cache is invalidated in the daemon
29981 and reloaded after any changes to the directories
29982 containing files specified by these options.
29984 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
29985 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
29986 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
29987 The latter case is not automatically invaludated;
29988 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
29989 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
29990 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
29991 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
29993 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
29994 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executable.
29996 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
29997 save significant time and processing on every TLS connection
30003 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
30004 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
30007 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
30008 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
30009 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
30010 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
30011 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
30012 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
30013 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
30014 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
30017 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
30018 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
30021 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
30022 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
30023 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
30024 be of limited use in that environment.
30026 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
30027 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
30028 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
30029 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
30030 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
30032 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
30033 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
30034 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
30035 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
30036 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
30038 If DANE validated the connection attempt then the value of the &%tls_sni%& option
30039 is forced to the name of the destination host, after any MX- or CNAME-following.
30041 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
30042 received from a client.
30043 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
30045 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
30046 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
30047 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
30050 &%tls_certificate%&
30056 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
30061 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
30062 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
30063 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
30064 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
30065 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
30066 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
30067 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
30069 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
30072 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
30073 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
30074 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
30075 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
30077 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
30078 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
30079 built, then you have SNI support).
30083 .cindex ALPN "general information"
30084 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
30085 There is a TLS feature related to SNI
30086 called Application Layer Protocol Name (ALPN).
30087 This is intended to declare, or select, what protocol layer will be using a TLS
30089 The client for the connection proposes a set of protocol names, and
30090 the server responds with a selected one.
30091 It is not, as of 2021, commonly used for SMTP connections.
30092 However, to guard against misdirected or malicious use of web clients
30093 (which often do use ALPN) against MTA ports, Exim by default check that
30094 there is no incompatible ALPN specified by a client for a TLS connection.
30095 If there is, the connection is rejected.
30097 As a client Exim does not supply ALPN by default.
30098 The behaviour of both client and server can be configured using the options
30099 &%tls_alpn%& and &%hosts_require_alpn%&.
30100 There are no variables providing observability.
30101 Some feature-specific logging may appear on denied connections, but this
30102 depends on the behaviour of the peer
30103 (not all peers can send a feature-specific TLS Alert).
30105 This feature is available when Exim is built with
30106 OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later or GnuTLS 3.2.0 or later;
30107 the macro _HAVE_TLS_ALPN will be defined when this is so.
30111 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
30113 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
30114 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
30115 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
30116 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
30117 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
30118 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
30119 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
30120 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
30121 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
30122 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
30124 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
30125 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
30126 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
30127 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
30128 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
30129 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
30130 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
30132 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
30133 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
30134 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
30135 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
30136 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
30137 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
30138 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
30139 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
30140 and delay other deliveries to that host.
30142 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
30143 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
30144 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
30145 information is recorded.
30147 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
30148 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
30149 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
30154 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
30155 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
30156 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
30157 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
30158 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
30159 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
30161 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
30162 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
30163 document is currently at
30165 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
30167 and their FAQ is at
30169 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
30172 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
30173 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
30175 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
30176 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
30177 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
30178 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
30181 .subsection "Certificate chains" SECID186
30182 A file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
30183 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
30184 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
30185 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
30186 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
30187 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
30188 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
30189 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
30190 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
30191 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
30192 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
30193 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
30195 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
30196 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
30197 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
30198 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
30202 .subsection "Self-signed certificates" SECID187
30203 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
30204 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
30205 with OpenSSL, like this:
30206 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
30207 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
30209 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
30212 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
30213 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
30214 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
30215 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
30216 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
30217 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
30218 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
30220 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
30221 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
30222 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
30223 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
30224 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
30225 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
30227 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
30228 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
30229 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
30230 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
30231 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
30232 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
30233 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
30234 be a sensible resolution).
30236 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
30237 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
30238 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
30240 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
30241 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
30242 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
30243 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
30244 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
30245 signed with that self-signed certificate.
30247 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
30248 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
30249 Open-source PKI book, available online at
30250 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
30253 .subsection "Revoked certificates"
30254 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
30255 .cindex "revocation list"
30256 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
30257 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
30258 There are three ways for a certificate to be made unusable
30262 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
30263 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
30264 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
30265 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
30266 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
30268 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
30269 file from every certificate authority they know of.
30272 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
30273 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
30274 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
30275 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
30276 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
30277 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
30279 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
30280 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
30281 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
30282 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
30285 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
30286 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
30287 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
30288 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
30289 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
30290 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
30291 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
30292 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
30294 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
30295 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
30296 support for OCSP stapling is included.
30298 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
30299 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
30300 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
30301 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
30302 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
30304 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
30305 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
30306 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
30307 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
30308 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
30311 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
30312 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
30315 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
30316 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
30317 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
30318 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
30319 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
30320 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
30322 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
30323 not any of the chain from CA to it.
30325 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
30328 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
30329 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
30330 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
30332 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
30333 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
30334 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
30339 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
30340 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
30343 .section "TLS Resumption" "SECTresumption"
30344 .cindex TLS resumption
30345 TLS Session Resumption for TLS 1.2 and TLS 1.3 connections can be used (defined
30346 in RFC 5077 for 1.2). The support for this requires GnuTLS 3.6.3 or OpenSSL 1.1.1
30349 Session resumption (this is the "stateless" variant) involves the server sending
30350 a "session ticket" to the client on one connection, which can be stored by the
30351 client and used for a later session. The ticket contains sufficient state for
30352 the server to reconstruct the TLS session, avoiding some expensive crypto
30353 calculation and (on TLS1.2) one full packet roundtrip time.
30356 Operational cost/benefit:
30358 The extra data being transmitted costs a minor amount, and the client has
30359 extra costs in storing and retrieving the data.
30361 In the Exim/Gnutls implementation the extra cost on an initial connection
30362 which is TLS1.2 over a loopback path is about 6ms on 2017-laptop class hardware.
30363 The saved cost on a subsequent connection is about 4ms; three or more
30364 connections become a net win. On longer network paths, two or more
30365 connections will have an average lower startup time thanks to the one
30366 saved packet roundtrip. TLS1.3 will save the crypto cpu costs but not any
30369 .cindex "hints database" tls
30370 Since a new hints DB is used on the TLS client,
30371 the hints DB maintenance should be updated to additionally handle "tls".
30376 The session ticket is encrypted, but is obviously an additional security
30377 vulnarability surface. An attacker able to decrypt it would have access
30378 all connections using the resumed session.
30379 The session ticket encryption key is not committed to storage by the server
30380 and is rotated regularly (OpenSSL: 1hr, and one previous key is used for
30381 overlap; GnuTLS 6hr but does not specify any overlap).
30382 Tickets have limited lifetime (2hr, and new ones issued after 1hr under
30383 OpenSSL. GnuTLS 2hr, appears to not do overlap).
30385 There is a question-mark over the security of the Diffie-Helman parameters
30386 used for session negotiation.
30391 The &%log_selector%& "tls_resumption" appends an asterisk to the tls_cipher "X="
30394 The variables &$tls_in_resumption$& and &$tls_out_resumption$&
30395 have bits 0-4 indicating respectively
30396 support built, client requested ticket, client offered session,
30397 server issued ticket, resume used. A suitable decode list is provided
30398 in the builtin macro _RESUME_DECODE for in &%listextract%& expansions.
30403 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& main option specifies a hostlist for which
30404 exim, operating as a server, will offer resumption to clients.
30405 Current best practice is to not offer the feature to MUA connection.
30406 Commonly this can be done like this:
30408 tls_resumption_hosts = ${if inlist {$received_port}{587:465} {:}{*}}
30410 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
30411 is offered and/or accepted.
30413 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& smtp transport option performs the
30414 equivalent function for operation as a client.
30415 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
30416 is attempted (if a stored session is available) or the information
30417 stored (if supplied by the peer).
30423 In a resumed session:
30425 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_cipher$& will have values different
30426 to the original (under GnuTLS).
30428 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_ocsp$& will be "not requested" or "no response",
30429 and the &%hosts_require_ocsp%& smtp trasnport option will fail.
30430 . XXX need to do something with that hosts_require_ocsp
30436 .section DANE "SECDANE"
30438 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
30439 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
30440 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
30441 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
30442 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
30443 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
30445 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
30446 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
30447 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
30449 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
30450 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
30452 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and communicate via side-channel) copies of server certificates
30453 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
30454 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
30456 DANE requires a server operator to do three things:
30458 Run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
30459 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
30460 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
30463 Add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
30465 Offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
30468 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
30469 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
30470 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
30471 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
30473 .subsection "DNS records"
30474 A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
30475 "Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
30476 For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
30477 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
30479 The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
30480 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
30481 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
30482 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
30483 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
30484 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
30486 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
30487 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
30488 does require careful arrangement.
30489 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
30490 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
30491 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
30492 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
30493 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
30495 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
30496 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
30498 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
30499 "MTA-STS", described below.
30501 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
30502 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
30503 connections to you.
30504 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
30505 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
30506 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
30507 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
30508 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
30509 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
30511 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
30512 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
30513 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
30514 random serial numbers.
30515 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
30516 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
30517 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
30518 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
30520 The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
30521 a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
30523 For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
30526 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
30527 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
30532 are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
30534 An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
30537 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
30540 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
30541 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
30544 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
30546 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
30547 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
30548 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
30549 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
30551 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
30552 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
30554 .subsection "Interaction with OCSP"
30555 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
30556 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
30557 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
30560 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
30561 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
30565 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
30566 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
30567 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
30568 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
30569 control the OCSP request.
30571 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
30572 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
30575 .subsection "Client configuration"
30576 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
30577 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
30578 The &"require"& variant will result in failure if the target host is not
30579 DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
30580 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
30582 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
30584 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using DNSSEC.
30585 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
30586 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
30587 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
30589 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
30590 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
30591 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
30592 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
30593 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
30594 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
30595 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
30597 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
30601 tls_try_verify_hosts
30602 tls_verify_certificates
30604 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
30608 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
30609 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
30611 The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
30612 set to &"never"&, and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
30614 .subsection Observability
30615 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
30617 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
30618 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
30619 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
30620 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
30622 .cindex DANE reporting
30623 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
30624 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
30625 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
30626 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
30627 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
30628 Section 4.3 of that document.
30630 .subsection General
30631 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
30633 DANE is specified in RFC 6698. It decouples certificate authority trust
30634 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
30636 It does retain the need to trust the assurances provided by the DNSSEC tree.
30638 There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS (RFC 8461), which
30639 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website.
30640 The discovery of the address for that website does not (per standard)
30641 require DNSSEC, and could be regarded as being less secure than DANE
30644 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
30645 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
30646 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
30649 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
30650 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
30651 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
30653 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
30654 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
30655 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
30656 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
30657 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
30658 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
30659 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
30663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30664 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30666 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
30667 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
30668 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
30669 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
30670 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
30671 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
30672 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
30673 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
30674 one very small ACL:
30678 accept hosts = one.host.only
30680 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
30681 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
30683 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
30684 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
30685 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
30686 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
30687 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
30688 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
30689 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
30690 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30693 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
30694 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
30695 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30698 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
30699 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
30700 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
30701 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
30702 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
30703 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
30704 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
30705 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
30706 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
30707 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
30708 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
30709 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
30710 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
30711 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
30712 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
30713 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
30714 .cindex "WELLKNOWN" "ACL for"
30715 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
30716 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
30717 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
30718 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
30721 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
30722 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
30723 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
30724 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
30725 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
30726 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
30727 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
30728 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
30729 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
30730 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
30731 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
30732 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
30733 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
30734 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
30735 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
30736 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
30737 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
30738 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
30739 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
30740 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
30741 .irow &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& "ACL for WELLKNOWN"
30744 For example, if you set
30746 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
30748 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
30749 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
30750 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
30751 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
30752 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
30753 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
30754 testing as possible at RCPT time.
30757 .subsection "The non-SMTP ACLs" SECnonSMTP
30758 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
30759 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
30760 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
30761 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
30762 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
30763 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
30764 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
30765 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
30766 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
30767 in any of these ACLs.
30769 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
30770 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
30771 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
30772 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
30773 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
30774 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
30775 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
30776 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
30778 control = suppress_local_fixups
30780 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
30781 run, it is too late.
30783 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30784 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30786 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
30787 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
30788 temporary error for these kinds of message.
30791 .subsection "The SMTP connect ACL" SECconnectACL
30792 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
30793 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
30794 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
30795 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
30796 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
30797 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
30798 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
30799 &%smtp_banner%& option.
30801 For tls-on-connect connections, the ACL is run before the TLS connection
30802 is accepted; if the ACL does not accept then the TCP connection is dropped without
30803 any TLS startup attempt and without any SMTP response being transmitted.
30806 .subsection "The EHLO/HELO ACL" SECheloACL
30807 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
30808 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
30809 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
30810 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
30811 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
30812 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
30813 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
30814 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
30816 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
30817 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
30818 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
30820 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
30821 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
30822 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
30823 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
30827 .subsection "The DATA ACLs" SECdataACLS
30828 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
30829 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
30830 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
30831 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
30832 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
30833 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
30834 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
30835 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
30836 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
30838 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
30839 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
30840 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
30841 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
30842 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
30843 associated with the DATA command.
30845 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
30846 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
30847 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
30848 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
30849 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
30850 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
30851 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
30852 the data specified is received.
30854 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
30855 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
30856 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
30857 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
30858 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
30861 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
30862 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
30863 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
30864 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
30866 .subsection "The SMTP DKIM ACL" SECTDKIMACL
30867 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
30868 enabled (which is the default).
30870 If, for a specific message, an ACL control
30871 &*dkim_disable_verify*&
30872 has been set, this &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is not called.
30874 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
30875 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
30876 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
30878 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
30880 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30883 .subsection "The SMTP MIME ACL" SECID194
30884 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30885 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30887 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
30890 .subsection "The SMTP PRDR ACL" SECTPRDRACL
30891 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
30892 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
30893 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
30894 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
30895 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
30896 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
30899 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
30900 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
30901 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
30902 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
30903 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
30904 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
30905 for some or all recipients.
30907 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
30908 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
30909 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
30910 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
30911 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
30913 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
30914 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
30915 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
30917 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
30918 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
30920 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
30921 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
30922 the feature was not requested by the client.
30924 .subsection "The SMTP WELLKNOWN ACL" SECTWELLKNOWNACL
30925 .cindex "WELLKNOWN" "ACL for"
30926 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_wellknown%&"
30927 The &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
30928 with WELLKNOWN support enabled.
30930 The ACL determines the response to an SMTP WELLKNOWN command, using the normal
30931 accept/defer/deny verbs for the response code,
30932 and a new &"control=wellknown"& modifier.
30933 This modifier takes a single option, separated by a '/'
30934 character, which must be the name of a file containing the response
30935 cleartext. The modifier is expanded before use in the usual way before
30936 it is used. The configuration is responsible for picking a suitable file
30937 to return and, most importantly, not returning any unexpected file.
30938 The argument for the SMTP verb will be available in the &$smtp_command_argument$&
30939 variable and can be used for building the file path.
30940 If the file path given in the modifier is empty or inacessible, the control will
30946 accept control = wellknown/\
30947 ${lookup {${xtextd:$smtp_command_argument}} \
30948 dsearch,key=path,filter=file,ret=full \
30949 {$spooldir/wellknown.d}}
30951 File content will be encoded in &"xtext"& form, and line-wrapping
30952 for line-length limitation will be done before transmission.
30953 A response summary line will be prepended, with the (pre-encoding) file size.
30955 The above example uses the expansion operator ${xtextd:<coded-string>}
30956 which is needed to decode the xtext-encoded key from the SMTP verb.
30958 Under the util directory there is a "mailtest" utility which can be used
30959 to test/retrieve WELLKNOWN items. Syntax is
30961 mailtest -h host.example.com -w security.txt
30964 WELLKNOWN is a ESMTP extension providing access to extended
30965 information about the server. It is modelled on the webserver
30966 facilities documented in RFC 8615 and can be used for a security.txt
30967 file and could be used for ACME handshaking (RFC 8555).
30969 Exim will advertise WELLKNOWN support in the EHLO response
30970 .oindex &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%&
30971 (conditional on a new option &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%&)
30972 and service WELLKNOWN smtp verbs having a single parameter
30973 giving a key for an item of "site-wide metadata".
30974 The verb and key are separated by whitespace,
30975 and the key is xtext-encoded (per RFC 3461 section 4).
30978 .subsection "The QUIT ACL" SECTQUITACL
30979 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
30980 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
30981 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
30982 does not in fact control any access.
30983 For this reason, it may only accept
30984 or warn as its final result.
30986 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
30987 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
30988 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
30989 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
30991 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
30992 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
30994 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
30995 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
30998 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
30999 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
31000 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
31001 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
31002 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
31005 .subsection "The not-QUIT ACL" SECTNOTQUITACL
31006 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
31007 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
31008 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
31009 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
31010 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
31011 situation even worse.
31013 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
31014 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
31015 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
31018 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
31019 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
31020 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
31021 connection. The possible values are:
31023 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
31024 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
31025 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
31026 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
31027 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
31028 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
31029 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
31030 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
31031 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
31032 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
31034 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
31035 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
31036 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
31037 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
31038 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
31042 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
31043 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
31044 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
31045 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
31047 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
31048 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
31050 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
31051 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
31052 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
31053 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
31054 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
31056 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
31057 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
31058 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
31061 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
31062 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
31063 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
31064 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
31065 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
31066 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
31068 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
31069 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
31070 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
31072 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
31073 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
31074 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
31075 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
31077 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
31078 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
31079 matches the string.
31081 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
31082 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
31083 want to have something like
31085 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
31087 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
31088 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
31094 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
31095 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
31096 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
31097 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
31098 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
31099 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
31100 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
31101 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
31102 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
31104 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
31105 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
31106 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
31109 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
31110 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
31111 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
31112 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
31114 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
31115 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
31116 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
31117 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
31118 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
31119 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
31120 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
31122 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
31123 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
31126 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
31127 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
31128 recipients; it may create new recipients.
31132 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
31133 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
31134 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
31135 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
31136 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
31137 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
31139 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
31140 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
31141 used to accept or reject anything.
31143 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
31144 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
31145 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
31146 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
31148 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&,
31150 and &%acl_smtp_wellknown%&),
31151 the action when the ACL
31152 is not defined is &"deny"&. This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be
31153 defined in order to receive any messages over an SMTP connection.
31154 For an example, see the ACL in the default configuration file.
31158 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
31159 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
31161 .vindex &$local_part$&
31162 .vindex &$sender_address$&
31163 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
31164 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
31165 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
31166 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
31167 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
31168 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
31169 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
31170 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
31172 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
31173 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
31174 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
31177 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
31178 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
31179 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
31180 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
31181 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
31184 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
31185 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
31186 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
31187 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
31188 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
31189 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
31190 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
31191 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
31197 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
31198 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
31199 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
31200 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
31201 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
31202 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
31203 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
31204 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
31205 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
31206 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
31207 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
31208 unencrypted connections.
31211 accept encrypted = *
31212 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
31214 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
31216 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
31217 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
31218 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
31219 option to do this.)
31223 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
31224 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
31225 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
31226 An individual ACL definition consists of a number of statements.
31227 Each statement starts
31228 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
31229 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
31230 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
31232 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
31233 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
31234 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
31237 deny dnslists = list1.example
31238 dnslists = list2.example
31240 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
31241 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
31242 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
31243 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
31244 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
31246 The definition of an ACL ends where another starts,
31247 or a different configuration section starts.
31250 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
31251 The ACL verbs are as follows:
31254 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
31255 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
31256 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
31257 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
31258 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
31259 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
31260 check a RCPT command:
31262 accept domains = +local_domains
31266 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
31267 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
31268 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
31269 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
31272 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
31273 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
31274 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
31277 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
31278 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
31279 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
31280 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
31281 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
31282 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
31284 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
31285 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
31287 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
31288 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
31289 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
31291 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
31292 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
31293 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
31298 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
31299 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
31300 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
31301 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
31302 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
31303 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
31304 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
31308 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
31309 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
31310 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
31313 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31315 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
31319 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
31320 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
31321 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
31322 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
31323 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
31324 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
31325 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
31326 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
31327 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
31329 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
31330 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
31331 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
31335 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
31336 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
31337 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
31339 drop condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
31340 message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
31342 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
31343 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
31346 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
31347 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
31348 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
31349 example, when checking a RCPT command,
31351 require message = Sender did not verify
31354 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
31355 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
31356 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
31357 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
31360 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
31361 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
31362 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
31363 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
31364 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
31365 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
31366 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
31368 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
31369 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
31370 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
31371 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
31372 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
31374 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
31375 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
31376 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
31377 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
31378 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
31379 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
31383 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31384 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
31385 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
31386 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
31388 warn !verify = sender
31389 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
31393 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
31395 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
31396 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
31397 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
31398 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
31399 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
31403 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
31404 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
31405 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
31406 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
31407 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
31408 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
31409 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
31410 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
31411 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
31412 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
31414 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
31415 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
31416 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
31417 on the same SMTP connection.
31419 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
31420 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
31421 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
31424 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
31425 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
31426 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
31428 accept hosts = whatever
31429 set acl_m4 = some value
31430 accept authenticated = *
31431 set acl_c_auth = yes
31433 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
31434 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
31435 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
31437 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
31438 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
31439 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
31440 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
31441 error is generated.
31443 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
31444 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
31447 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
31448 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
31449 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
31450 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
31452 deny domains = *.dom.example
31453 !verify = recipient
31455 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
31456 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
31457 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
31458 two statements are equivalent:
31460 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
31461 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
31463 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
31464 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
31466 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
31467 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
31468 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
31470 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
31471 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
31472 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
31473 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
31475 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
31476 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
31477 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
31478 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
31479 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
31480 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
31481 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
31483 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
31484 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
31485 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
31486 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
31487 message is handled.
31489 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
31490 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
31491 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
31492 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
31494 require message = Can't verify sender
31496 message = Can't verify recipient
31498 message = This message cannot be used
31500 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
31501 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
31502 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
31503 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
31504 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
31505 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
31507 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
31508 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
31509 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
31510 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
31513 !senders = *@my.domain.example
31514 message = Invalid sender from client host
31516 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
31517 by which time Exim has set up the message.
31521 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
31522 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
31523 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
31526 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31527 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
31528 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
31529 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
31531 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31532 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
31533 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
31534 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
31535 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
31536 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
31537 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
31538 write rather ugly lines like this:
31540 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
31542 Instead, all you need is
31544 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
31547 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31548 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
31549 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
31550 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
31551 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
31552 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
31553 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
31554 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
31556 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
31557 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
31558 in several different ways. For example:
31560 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
31561 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
31562 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
31566 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
31568 accept ...some conditions
31571 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
31572 other words, when the conditions are all true.
31575 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
31577 accept ...some conditions...
31579 ...some more conditions...
31581 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
31582 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
31583 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
31587 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
31588 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
31591 warn ...some conditions...
31595 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
31596 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
31600 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
31601 &%require%& verb. For example:
31603 require control = no_multiline_responses
31607 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
31608 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
31610 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
31611 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
31612 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
31613 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
31614 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
31615 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
31617 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
31620 deny ...some conditions...
31623 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
31624 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
31627 ...some conditions...
31629 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
31630 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
31632 warn ...some conditions...
31638 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
31639 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
31640 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
31641 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
31642 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
31643 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
31644 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
31648 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
31649 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
31650 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
31651 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
31652 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
31653 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
31654 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
31657 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31658 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
31659 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
31660 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
31662 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
31663 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
31665 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
31668 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
31669 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
31671 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
31672 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
31673 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
31676 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
31677 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
31678 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
31679 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
31680 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
31681 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
31684 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31685 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
31686 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
31689 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
31690 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
31691 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
31692 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
31693 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
31694 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
31696 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
31697 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
31698 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
31699 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
31700 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
31701 logging rejections.
31704 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
31705 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
31706 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
31707 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
31708 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
31709 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
31710 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
31711 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
31713 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
31714 &` log_reject_target =`&
31716 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
31717 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
31721 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31722 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
31723 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
31724 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
31725 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
31726 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
31727 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
31730 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
31731 &` control = freeze`&
31732 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
31734 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
31735 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
31736 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
31739 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
31740 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
31744 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31745 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
31746 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
31747 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
31748 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
31749 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
31750 &%accept%& for details.)
31752 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
31753 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
31754 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
31755 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
31756 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
31758 require message = Host not recognized
31761 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
31764 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
31765 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
31766 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
31767 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
31768 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
31769 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
31770 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
31771 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
31772 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
31775 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
31776 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
31777 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
31779 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
31780 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
31782 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
31783 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
31784 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
31787 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
31788 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
31790 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
31791 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
31793 If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
31795 A long message line will also be split into multi-line SMTP responses,
31796 on word boundaries if possible.
31798 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31799 While the text is being expanded, the &$acl_verify_message$& variable
31800 contains any message previously set.
31801 Afterwards, &$acl_verify_message$& is cleared.
31803 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
31804 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
31805 However, the original message is available in the variable
31806 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
31807 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
31808 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
31809 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
31811 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
31812 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
31813 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
31814 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
31815 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
31816 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
31820 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31821 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
31822 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
31823 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
31825 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
31827 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
31828 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
31829 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
31830 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
31833 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31834 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
31835 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
31836 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
31839 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
31840 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
31841 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
31842 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
31845 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
31846 .cindex "UDP communications"
31847 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
31848 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
31849 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
31850 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
31851 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
31852 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
31853 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
31856 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
31857 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
31864 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
31865 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
31866 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
31869 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
31870 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
31871 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
31872 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
31873 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
31874 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
31875 not work without it. For example:
31877 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
31878 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
31880 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
31881 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
31882 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
31883 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
31884 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
31887 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
31888 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
31889 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
31890 .cindex "case of local parts"
31891 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31892 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
31893 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
31894 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
31895 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
31896 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
31899 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
31900 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
31901 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
31902 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
31903 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
31905 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
31906 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
31909 warn control = caseful_local_part
31910 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
31912 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
31914 control = caselower_local_part
31916 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
31917 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
31920 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
31921 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
31922 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
31923 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
31925 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
31926 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
31927 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
31928 is used for all recipients of the message,
31929 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
31930 and data is copied from one to the other.
31932 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
31933 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
31934 If a recipient-verify callout
31936 connection is subsequently
31937 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
31938 any subsequent recipients and the data,
31939 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
31941 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
31942 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
31943 Note also that headers cannot be
31944 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
31945 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
31946 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
31947 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
31948 this will affect the timestamp.
31950 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
31951 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
31952 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
31953 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
31956 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
31957 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
31958 before the entire message has been received from the source.
31959 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
31963 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
31964 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
31965 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
31966 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
31967 before the acceptance "<=" line.
31969 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
31971 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
31972 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
31973 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
31974 and does not queue the message.
31975 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
31977 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
31979 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
31982 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
31983 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
31984 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
31985 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
31986 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
31987 by default called &'debuglog'&.
31989 Logging set up by the control will be maintained across spool residency.
31991 Options are a slash-separated list.
31992 If an option takes an argument, the option name and argument are separated by
31993 an equals character.
31994 Several options are supported:
31996 tag=<&'suffix'&> The filename can be adjusted with thise option.
31997 The argument, which may access any variables already defined,
31998 is appended to the default name.
32000 opts=<&'debug&~options'&> The argument specififes what is to be logged,
32001 using the same values as the &`-d`& command-line option.
32003 stop Logging started with this control may be
32004 stopped by using this option.
32006 kill Logging started with this control may be
32007 stopped by using this option.
32008 Additionally the debug file will be removed,
32009 providing one means for speculative debug tracing.
32011 pretrigger=<&'size'&> This option specifies a memory buffuer to be used
32012 for pre-trigger debug capture.
32013 Debug lines are recorded in the buffer until
32014 and if) a trigger occurs; at which time they are
32015 dumped to the debug file. Newer lines displace the
32016 oldest if the buffer is full. After a trigger,
32017 immediate writes to file are done as normal.
32019 trigger=<&'reason'&> This option selects cause for the pretrigger buffer
32020 see above) to be copied to file. A reason of &*now*&
32021 take effect immediately; one of &*paniclog*& triggers
32022 on a write to the panic log.
32025 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
32029 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
32030 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
32031 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
32032 control = debug/kill
32033 control = debug/opts=+all/pretrigger=1024/trigger=paniclog
32034 control = debug/trigger=now
32038 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
32039 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
32040 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
32041 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
32042 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
32045 .vitem &*control&~=&~dmarc_disable_verify*&
32046 .cindex "disable DMARC verify"
32047 .cindex "DMARC" "disable verify"
32048 This control turns off DMARC verification processing entirely. For details on
32049 the operation and configuration of DMARC, see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
32052 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
32053 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
32054 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
32055 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
32056 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
32057 strings or to numeric value.
32058 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
32059 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
32060 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
32062 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
32063 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
32064 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
32065 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
32066 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
32069 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
32070 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
32071 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
32072 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
32073 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
32074 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
32075 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
32076 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
32078 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
32079 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
32080 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
32081 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
32082 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
32083 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
32087 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
32088 .cindex "fake defer"
32089 .cindex "defer, fake"
32091 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
32092 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
32093 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
32094 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
32095 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
32097 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
32098 .cindex "fake rejection"
32099 .cindex "rejection, fake"
32101 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
32102 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
32103 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
32104 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
32105 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
32106 the same SMTP connection.
32108 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
32109 message is supplied, the following is used:
32111 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
32112 550-kept for evaluation.
32113 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
32114 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
32116 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
32118 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
32119 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
32120 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
32121 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
32122 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
32123 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
32126 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
32127 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
32128 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
32129 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
32131 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
32132 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
32133 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
32134 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
32135 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
32136 disables such output flushing.
32138 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
32139 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32140 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
32141 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
32142 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
32143 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
32145 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
32146 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
32147 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
32148 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
32149 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
32150 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
32151 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
32152 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
32153 to be useful in production.
32155 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
32156 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
32157 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
32158 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
32159 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
32161 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
32162 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
32163 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
32164 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
32165 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
32166 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
32169 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
32170 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
32171 verification failed"&) is sent.
32173 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
32177 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
32178 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
32180 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
32181 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
32182 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
32183 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
32184 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
32185 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
32186 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
32187 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
32189 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue/*&<&'options'&>* &&&
32190 &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
32191 .oindex "&%queue%&"
32192 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
32193 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
32194 .cindex queueing "forcing in ACL"
32195 .cindex "first pass routing"
32196 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
32197 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
32198 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
32200 If used with no options set,
32201 no immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
32202 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option or &'-odq'& command-line option.
32204 If the &'first_pass_route'& option is given then
32205 the behaviour is like the command-line &'-oqds'& option;
32206 a delivery process is started which stops short of making
32207 any SMTP delivery. The benefit is that the hints database will be updated for
32208 the message being waiting for a specific host, and a later queue run will be
32209 able to send all such messages on a single connection.
32211 The control only applies to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that
32212 may be received in the same SMTP connection.
32214 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
32215 .cindex "message" "submission"
32216 .cindex "submission mode"
32217 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
32218 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
32219 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
32220 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
32221 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
32222 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
32223 late (the message has already been created).
32225 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
32226 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
32227 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
32228 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
32229 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
32231 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
32232 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
32233 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
32234 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
32235 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
32238 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
32239 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
32241 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
32243 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
32246 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
32247 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
32248 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
32249 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
32252 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
32253 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
32255 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
32256 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
32258 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
32260 .vitem &*control&~=&~wellknown*&
32261 This control sets up a response data file for a WELLKNOWN SMTP command.
32262 It may only be used in an ACL servicing that command.
32263 For details see section &<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>&.
32267 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
32268 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
32271 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
32273 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
32274 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
32276 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
32278 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
32283 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
32284 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
32285 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
32286 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
32287 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
32288 to an incoming message, as in this example:
32290 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32291 dialup.mail-abuse.org
32292 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
32294 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
32295 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
32296 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
32297 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
32298 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
32301 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
32302 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
32304 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
32305 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
32306 contains one or more newlines that
32307 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
32308 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
32309 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
32311 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
32312 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
32313 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
32314 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
32315 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
32316 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
32317 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
32318 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
32319 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
32320 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
32321 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
32323 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
32324 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
32326 until they are added to the
32327 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
32328 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
32329 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
32330 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
32331 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
32332 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
32333 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
32335 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
32337 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
32338 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
32340 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
32341 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
32343 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
32344 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
32346 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
32347 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
32348 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
32349 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
32352 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
32353 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
32354 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
32355 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
32356 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
32357 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
32358 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
32361 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
32362 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
32363 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
32364 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
32365 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
32367 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
32368 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
32369 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
32370 to be a header name first.) For example:
32372 warn add_header = \
32373 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
32375 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
32376 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
32377 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
32378 up in reverse order.
32380 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
32381 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
32382 system filter or in a router or transport.
32386 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
32387 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
32388 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
32389 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
32390 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
32391 from an incoming message, as in this example:
32393 warn message = Remove internal headers
32394 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
32396 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
32397 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
32398 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
32399 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
32400 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
32401 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
32403 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
32404 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
32406 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
32407 list of header specifiers.
32408 If a specifier does not start with a circumflex (^)
32409 then it is treated as a header name.
32410 The header name matching is case insensitive.
32411 If it does, then it is treated as a (front-anchored)
32412 regular expression applied to the whole header.
32414 &*Note*&: The colon terminating a header name will need to be doubled
32415 if used in an RE, and there can legitimately be whitepace before it.
32419 remove_header = \N^(?i)Authentication-Results\s*::\s*example.org;\N
32422 List expansion is not performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
32423 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
32424 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
32426 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
32427 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
32428 warn message = Remove internal headers
32429 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
32431 Header specifiers for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
32432 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
32433 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
32434 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
32435 a non-existent header. Further header specifiers for removal may be accumulated
32436 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which matching headers are removed
32437 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, remove specifiers are
32438 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are acted on after
32439 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
32440 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
32441 would have been removed.
32443 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
32444 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
32445 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
32446 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
32447 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
32448 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
32449 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
32450 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
32451 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
32453 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
32454 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
32456 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
32457 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
32459 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
32460 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
32462 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
32463 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
32464 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
32465 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
32468 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
32469 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
32470 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
32475 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
32476 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
32477 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
32478 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
32479 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
32480 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32482 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
32483 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
32484 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
32485 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
32486 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
32487 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
32488 The conditions are as follows:
32492 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
32493 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
32494 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
32495 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
32496 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
32497 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
32498 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
32499 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
32500 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
32501 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
32502 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
32503 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
32505 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
32506 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
32507 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
32508 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
32509 The name and values are expanded separately.
32510 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
32511 will act as argument separators.
32513 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
32514 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
32515 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
32516 conditions are tested.
32518 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
32519 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
32520 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
32521 for different local users or different local domains.
32523 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
32524 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
32525 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
32526 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
32527 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
32528 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
32529 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
32534 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
32535 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
32536 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
32537 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
32538 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
32539 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
32540 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
32541 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
32542 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
32543 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
32544 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
32545 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
32548 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
32549 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
32550 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32551 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
32552 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
32553 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
32554 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
32555 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32557 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
32558 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
32559 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
32560 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32561 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
32562 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
32563 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
32564 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
32565 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
32566 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
32568 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32569 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
32570 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
32571 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
32572 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
32573 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks that the domain
32574 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
32575 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
32576 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
32579 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
32580 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
32583 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
32584 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
32585 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
32586 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
32587 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
32588 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
32589 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
32595 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
32596 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
32597 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
32598 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
32599 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
32600 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
32601 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
32603 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32605 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
32606 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
32607 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
32609 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
32610 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
32611 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
32612 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
32613 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
32614 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
32616 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
32617 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
32619 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32620 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
32622 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
32623 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
32624 statement can then check the IP address.
32626 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
32627 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
32628 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
32629 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
32631 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
32632 message = $host_data
32634 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
32636 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
32637 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
32638 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
32639 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
32640 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
32641 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks that the local
32642 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
32643 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
32644 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
32645 the next &%local_parts%& test.
32647 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
32648 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
32649 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
32650 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
32651 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32652 content-scanning extension
32653 and only after a DATA command.
32654 It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
32655 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32657 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
32658 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
32659 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
32660 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32661 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
32662 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
32663 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
32666 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
32667 .cindex "rate limiting"
32668 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
32669 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
32671 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
32672 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
32673 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
32674 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
32675 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks the entire
32676 recipient address against a list of recipients.
32678 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
32679 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
32680 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
32681 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32682 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
32683 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
32684 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32686 .vitem &*seen&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
32687 .cindex "&%seen%& ACL condition"
32688 This condition can be used to test if a situation has been previously met,
32689 for example for greylisting.
32690 Details are given in section &<<SECTseen>>&.
32692 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32693 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
32694 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
32695 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
32696 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32697 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
32698 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
32699 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
32700 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
32701 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
32702 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
32703 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
32704 influence the sender checking.
32706 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
32707 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
32709 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
32710 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
32711 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
32712 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
32713 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
32714 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
32718 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
32719 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
32721 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
32722 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
32723 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
32724 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32725 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
32726 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32728 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
32729 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32730 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
32731 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
32732 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
32733 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
32734 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
32735 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
32736 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
32737 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
32739 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
32740 .cindex "CSA verification"
32741 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
32742 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
32743 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
32745 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
32746 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32747 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
32748 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
32749 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
32750 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32752 This usually means an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
32753 It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
32754 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
32755 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
32757 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
32758 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
32759 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
32761 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
32762 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32763 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
32764 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
32765 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
32766 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
32767 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32768 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
32769 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
32770 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
32771 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
32772 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
32773 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
32774 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
32775 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
32777 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
32778 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
32779 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
32780 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
32783 !verify = header_sender
32784 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
32787 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
32788 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32789 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
32790 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
32791 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
32792 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32793 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
32794 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
32795 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
32796 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
32797 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
32798 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
32799 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
32802 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
32803 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
32807 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
32808 common as they used to be.
32810 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
32811 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32812 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
32813 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
32814 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
32815 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
32816 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
32817 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
32818 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
32819 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
32820 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
32821 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
32822 independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
32824 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
32825 option), this condition is always true.
32828 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
32829 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
32830 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
32831 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
32832 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
32833 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
32834 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
32835 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
32836 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
32838 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
32839 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
32841 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
32842 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
32845 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
32846 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32847 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
32848 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
32849 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
32850 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
32851 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
32852 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
32853 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
32854 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
32855 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
32856 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
32857 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
32858 value for the child address.
32860 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
32861 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32862 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
32863 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
32864 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
32865 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
32866 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
32867 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
32868 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
32869 original IP address.
32871 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
32872 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
32874 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
32875 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
32877 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
32878 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32879 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
32880 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
32881 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
32882 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
32883 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
32884 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
32885 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
32887 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
32888 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
32889 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
32890 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
32891 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
32892 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
32893 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
32895 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
32896 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
32897 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
32899 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
32900 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32901 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
32902 verified as a sender.
32904 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
32905 (eg. is generated from the received message)
32906 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
32908 verify = sender=${listquote{/}{${address:$h_sender:}}}
32914 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
32915 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
32916 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32917 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
32918 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
32919 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
32920 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
32921 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
32922 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
32923 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
32925 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
32926 dialups.mail-abuse.org
32928 the following records are looked up:
32930 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32931 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
32933 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
32934 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
32935 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
32936 use two separate conditions:
32938 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32939 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
32941 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
32942 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
32943 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
32946 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
32947 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
32948 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
32949 following special items in the list:
32950 .itable none 0 0 2 25* left 75* left
32951 .irow "+include_unknown" "behave as if the item is on the list"
32952 .irow "+exclude_unknown" "behave as if the item is not on the list (default)"
32953 .irow "+defer_unknown " "give a temporary error"
32955 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
32956 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
32957 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
32958 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
32960 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
32962 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
32963 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
32965 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32966 warn dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
32967 message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
32969 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
32971 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
32972 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
32973 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
32974 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
32975 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
32976 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
32978 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
32979 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
32980 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
32984 .subsection "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" SECID201
32985 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
32986 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
32987 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
32988 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
32990 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
32992 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
32993 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
32994 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
32995 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
33000 .subsection "DNS lists keyed on domain names" SECID202
33001 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
33002 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
33003 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
33004 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
33005 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
33006 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
33008 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
33009 message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
33011 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
33012 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
33013 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
33014 up by this example is
33016 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
33018 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
33019 addresses. For example:
33021 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33022 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
33024 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
33025 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
33030 .subsection "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" SECTmulkeyfor
33031 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
33032 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
33033 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
33034 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
33035 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
33036 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
33037 either to double the separators like this:
33039 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
33041 or to change the separator character, like this:
33043 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
33045 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
33046 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
33047 occurs. Consider this condition:
33049 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
33051 The DNS lookups that occur are:
33053 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
33054 a.domain.black.list.tld
33056 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
33057 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
33058 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
33059 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
33060 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
33061 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
33062 error for a previous item.
33064 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
33065 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
33067 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
33068 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
33070 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
33071 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
33073 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
33074 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
33075 $sender_address_domain} }} }
33076 message = The mail servers for the domain \
33077 $sender_address_domain \
33078 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
33081 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
33082 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
33083 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
33084 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
33086 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
33088 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
33089 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
33091 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
33092 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
33097 .subsection "Data returned by DNS lists" SECID203
33098 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
33099 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
33100 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
33101 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
33102 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
33103 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
33104 .irow 127.1.0.1 "RBL"
33105 .irow 127.1.0.2 "DUL"
33106 .irow 127.1.0.3 "DUL and RBL"
33107 .irow 127.1.0.4 "RSS"
33108 .irow 127.1.0.5 "RSS and RBL"
33109 .irow 127.1.0.6 "RSS and DUL"
33110 .irow 127.1.0.7 "RSS and DUL and RBL"
33112 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
33113 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
33114 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
33116 Values returned by a properly running DBSBL should be in the 127.0.0.0/8
33117 range. If a DNSBL operator loses control of the domain, lookups on it
33118 may start returning other addresses. Because of this, Exim now ignores
33119 returned values outside the 127/8 region.
33122 .subsection "Variables set from DNS lists" SECID204
33123 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
33124 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
33125 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
33126 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
33127 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
33128 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
33129 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
33130 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
33131 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
33132 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
33133 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
33134 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
33135 cases, for example:
33137 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
33139 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
33140 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
33141 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
33142 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
33144 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
33146 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
33147 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
33149 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
33150 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
33151 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
33152 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
33153 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
33156 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
33157 &-- even if these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
33158 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
33160 deny hosts = !+local_networks
33161 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
33163 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
33168 .subsection "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" SECTaddmatcon
33169 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
33170 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
33171 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
33174 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
33176 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
33177 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
33178 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
33179 describes how multiple records are handled.
33181 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
33182 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
33183 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
33185 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33187 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
33188 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
33189 first. For example:
33191 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
33192 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
33195 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
33196 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
33197 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
33198 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
33199 tested. For example:
33201 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
33203 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
33204 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
33205 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
33207 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
33209 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
33214 .subsection "Negated DNS matching conditions" SECID205
33215 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
33218 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33220 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
33221 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
33223 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33225 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
33226 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
33227 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
33228 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
33230 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
33231 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
33233 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
33234 previous example is precisely equivalent to
33236 deny dnslists = a.b.c
33237 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33239 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
33240 Consider this example:
33242 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33244 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
33247 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
33249 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33251 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
33252 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
33253 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
33255 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
33257 Negation can also be used with a bitwise-and restriction.
33258 The dnslists condition with only be trus if a result is returned
33259 by the lookup which, anded with the restriction, is all zeroes.
33262 deny dnslists = zen.spamhaus.org!&0.255.255.0
33268 .subsection "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" SECThanmuldnsrec
33269 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
33270 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
33271 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
33272 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
33273 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
33275 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
33277 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
33278 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
33279 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
33280 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
33281 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
33282 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
33285 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
33286 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
33287 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
33289 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
33290 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
33293 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
33295 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33296 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
33298 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
33300 for the condition to be true.
33303 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
33304 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
33306 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
33307 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
33309 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
33311 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33312 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
33314 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
33315 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
33317 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
33319 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33320 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
33322 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
33324 for the condition to be false.
33326 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
33327 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
33332 .subsection "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" SECTmordetinf
33333 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
33334 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
33335 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
33336 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
33337 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
33338 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
33339 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
33340 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
33343 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
33344 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
33345 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
33346 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
33347 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
33348 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
33349 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
33352 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
33353 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
33355 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
33356 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
33358 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
33359 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
33360 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
33361 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
33362 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
33363 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
33365 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
33366 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
33367 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
33370 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
33371 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
33372 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
33373 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
33375 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
33376 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
33377 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
33381 .subsection "DNS lists and IPv6" SECTmorednslistslast
33382 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
33383 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
33384 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
33385 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
33386 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
33388 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
33389 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33391 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
33392 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
33393 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
33395 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
33397 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
33398 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
33400 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
33401 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
33403 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
33404 dnslists = some.list.example
33407 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
33408 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
33409 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
33411 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
33415 .section "Previously seen user and hosts" "SECTseen"
33416 .cindex "&%seen%& ACL condition"
33417 .cindex greylisting
33418 The &%seen%& ACL condition can be used to test whether a
33419 situation has been previously met.
33420 It uses a hints database to record a timestamp against a key.
33421 The syntax of the condition is:
33423 &`seen =`& <&'optional flag'&><&'time interval'&> &`/`& <&'options'&>
33428 defer seen = -5m / key=${sender_host_address}_$local_part@$domain
33430 in a RCPT ACL will implement simple greylisting.
33432 The parameters for the condition are
33433 a possible minus sign,
33435 then, slash-separated, a list of options.
33436 The interval is taken as an offset before the current time,
33437 and used for the test.
33438 If the interval is preceded by a minus sign then the condition returns
33439 whether a record is found which is before the test time.
33440 Otherwise, the condition returns whether one is found which is since the
33443 Options are read in order with later ones overriding earlier ones.
33445 The default key is &$sender_host_address$&.
33446 An explicit key can be set using a &%key=value%& option.
33448 If a &%readonly%& option is given then
33449 no record create or update is done.
33450 If a &%write%& option is given then
33451 a record create or update is always done.
33452 An update is done if the test is for &"since"&.
33453 If none of those hold and there was no existing record,
33454 a record is created.
33456 Creates and updates are marked with the current time.
33458 Finally, a &"before"& test which succeeds, and for which the record
33459 is old enough, will be refreshed with a timestamp of the test time.
33460 This can prevent tidying of the database from removing the entry.
33461 The interval for this is, by default, 10 days.
33462 An explicit interval can be set using a
33463 &%refresh=value%& option.
33465 Note that &"seen"& should be added to the list of hints databases
33466 for maintenance if this ACL condition is used.
33469 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
33470 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
33471 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
33472 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
33473 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
33474 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
33475 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
33476 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
33477 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
33478 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
33480 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
33482 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
33483 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
33485 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
33486 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
33487 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
33490 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
33491 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
33492 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
33493 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
33494 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
33495 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
33496 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
33497 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
33498 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
33500 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
33501 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
33502 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
33503 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
33505 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
33506 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
33507 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
33508 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
33509 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
33510 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
33511 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
33512 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
33513 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
33514 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
33516 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
33517 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
33518 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
33521 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
33522 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
33523 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
33524 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
33525 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
33526 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
33528 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
33529 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
33530 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
33531 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
33532 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
33533 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
33534 the &%count=%& option.
33537 .subsection "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" ratoptmea
33538 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
33541 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33542 This option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
33543 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
33544 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
33547 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33548 This option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
33549 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
33550 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
33551 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
33554 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33555 This option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
33556 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
33557 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
33558 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
33559 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
33560 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
33561 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
33564 .cindex "rate limiting" per_rcpt
33565 This option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
33566 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
33567 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, or &%acl_smtp_data%& ACLs. In
33568 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
33569 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
33570 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
33571 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
33574 .cindex "rate limiting" per_addr
33575 This option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
33576 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
33577 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
33578 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
33582 .cindex "rate limiting" per_cmd
33583 This option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
33584 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
33585 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
33586 multiple different commands.
33589 .cindex "rate limiting" count
33590 This option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
33592 A value is required, after an equals sign.
33593 For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
33594 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&.
33595 If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
33596 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
33597 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&).
33598 The count does not have to be an integer.
33601 .cindex "rate limiting" unique
33602 This option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
33606 .subsection "Ratelimit update modes" ratoptupd
33607 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
33608 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
33609 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
33610 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
33612 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
33613 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
33615 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
33616 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
33617 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
33618 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
33622 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
33623 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
33624 (max $sender_rate_limit)
33627 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
33628 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
33629 (max $sender_rate_limit)
33632 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
33633 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
33634 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
33635 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
33636 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
33637 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
33640 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
33641 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
33642 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
33643 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
33644 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
33647 .subsection "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" ratoptfast
33648 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
33649 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
33650 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
33651 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
33652 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
33655 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
33656 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
33657 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
33658 up to the given limit.
33659 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
33660 consists of refusing the message, and
33661 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
33662 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
33663 likely not what is wanted.
33665 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
33666 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
33667 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
33668 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
33669 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
33670 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
33671 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
33672 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
33674 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
33678 .subsection "Limiting the rate of different events" ratoptuniq
33679 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
33680 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
33681 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
33682 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
33683 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
33684 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
33685 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
33686 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
33688 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
33689 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
33690 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
33691 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
33692 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
33693 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
33695 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
33696 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
33699 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
33700 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
33701 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
33702 required increases with larger limits.
33704 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
33705 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
33706 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
33707 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
33708 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
33709 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
33710 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
33711 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
33712 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
33716 .subsection "Using rate limiting" useratlim
33717 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
33718 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
33719 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
33720 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
33721 message. For example:
33723 # Log all senders' rates
33724 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
33725 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
33727 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
33728 # at the decimal point.
33729 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
33730 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
33731 $sender_rate_limit }s
33733 # Keep authenticated users under control
33734 deny authenticated = *
33735 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
33737 # System-wide rate limit
33738 defer ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
33739 message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
33741 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
33742 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
33743 defer ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
33744 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
33745 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
33746 message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
33747 messages per $sender_rate_period
33749 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
33750 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
33751 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
33752 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
33753 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
33754 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
33755 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
33759 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
33760 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
33761 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
33762 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
33763 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
33764 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
33765 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
33766 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
33767 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
33769 verify = sender/callout
33770 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
33772 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
33773 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
33774 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
33775 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
33776 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
33777 The available options are as follows:
33780 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
33781 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
33782 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
33784 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
33785 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
33786 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
33787 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
33789 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
33790 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
33792 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
33793 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
33794 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
33795 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
33797 If the &%quota%& option is specified for recipient verify,
33798 successful routing to an appendfile transport is followed by a call into
33799 the transport to evaluate the quota status for the recipient.
33800 No actual delivery is done, but verification will succeed if the quota
33801 is sufficient for the message (if the sender gave a message size) or
33802 not already exceeded (otherwise).
33805 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
33806 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
33807 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
33808 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
33809 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
33810 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
33813 warn !verify = sender
33814 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
33816 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
33817 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
33818 verification failure.
33819 This variable is cleared at the end of processing the ACL verb.
33821 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
33822 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
33825 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
33826 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
33828 &%route%&: Routing failed.
33830 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
33831 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
33832 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
33834 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
33836 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
33838 &%quota%&: The quota check for a local recipient did non pass.
33841 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
33842 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
33844 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
33845 address verification to:
33848 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
33854 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
33855 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
33856 .cindex "callout" "verification"
33857 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
33858 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
33859 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
33860 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
33861 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
33862 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
33863 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
33864 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
33865 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
33868 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
33869 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
33870 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
33871 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
33872 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
33873 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
33875 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
33876 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
33877 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
33878 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
33879 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
33881 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
33882 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
33883 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
33884 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
33885 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
33886 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
33887 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
33888 supplies a host list.
33889 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
33891 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
33892 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
33893 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
33894 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
33895 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
33896 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
33897 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
33899 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
33900 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
33901 following SMTP commands are sent:
33903 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
33905 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
33908 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
33911 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
33914 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
33915 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
33916 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
33917 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
33918 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
33919 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
33921 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
33922 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
33923 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
33924 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
33925 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
33927 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
33928 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
33929 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
33930 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
33931 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
33933 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
33934 .cindex "de-tainting" "using recipient verify"
33935 A recipient callout which gets a 2&'xx'& code
33936 will assign untainted values to the
33937 &$domain_data$& and &$local_part_data$& variables,
33938 corresponding to the domain and local parts of the recipient address.
33943 .subsection "Additional parameters for callouts" CALLaddparcall
33944 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
33945 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
33946 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
33948 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
33950 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
33951 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
33952 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
33956 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
33957 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
33958 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
33961 verify = sender/callout=5s
33963 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
33964 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
33965 the &%connect%& parameter.
33968 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
33969 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
33970 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
33971 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
33973 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
33975 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
33977 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
33978 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
33979 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
33980 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
33981 updated in this circumstance.
33983 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
33984 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
33985 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
33986 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
33987 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
33988 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
33991 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
33992 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
33993 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
33994 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
33995 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
33996 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
33997 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
33998 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
33999 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
34000 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
34002 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
34004 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
34007 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34008 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
34009 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
34012 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
34014 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
34015 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
34016 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
34017 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
34018 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
34021 .vitem &*no_cache*&
34022 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
34023 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
34024 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
34026 .vitem &*postmaster*&
34027 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
34028 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
34029 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
34030 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
34031 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
34032 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
34033 made, until the cache record expires.
34035 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
34036 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
34037 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
34040 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
34042 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
34043 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
34045 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
34047 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
34048 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
34049 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
34050 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
34054 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
34055 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
34056 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
34057 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
34058 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
34060 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
34062 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
34063 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
34064 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
34065 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
34066 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
34068 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
34069 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
34070 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34072 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
34074 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34075 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
34076 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
34077 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
34078 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
34080 .vitem &*use_sender*&
34081 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34083 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
34085 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
34086 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
34087 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
34088 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
34089 usefulness of callout caching.
34092 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34094 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
34096 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
34097 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
34098 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
34099 when that is used for the connections.
34100 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
34101 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
34102 if the use_sender option is used,
34103 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
34104 and if no other callouts intervene.
34107 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
34108 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
34109 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
34110 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
34111 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
34112 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
34113 these circumstances.
34115 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
34116 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
34117 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
34118 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
34119 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
34120 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
34121 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
34123 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
34124 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
34125 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
34126 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
34131 .subsection "Callout caching" SECTcallvercache
34132 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
34133 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
34134 .cindex "caching" "callout"
34135 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
34136 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
34137 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
34138 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
34139 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
34140 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
34142 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
34143 the failure. However, for subsequent failures that use the cache data, this message
34146 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
34147 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
34148 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
34150 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
34151 commands up to and including
34155 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
34156 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
34157 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
34158 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
34159 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
34160 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
34161 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
34163 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
34164 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
34165 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
34166 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
34167 will eventually be noticed.
34169 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
34170 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
34171 behaviour will be the same.
34175 .section "Quota caching" "SECTquotacache"
34176 .cindex "hints database" "quota cache"
34177 .cindex "quota" "cache, description of"
34178 .cindex "caching" "quota"
34179 Exim caches the results of quota verification
34180 in order to reduce the amount of resources used.
34181 The &"callout"& hints database is used.
34183 The default cache periods are five minutes for a positive (good) result
34184 and one hour for a negative result.
34185 To change the periods the &%quota%& option can be followed by an equals sign
34186 and a number of optional paramemters, separated by commas.
34189 verify = recipient/quota=cachepos=1h,cacheneg=1d
34191 Possible parameters are:
34193 .vitem &*cachepos&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34194 .cindex "quota cache" "positive entry expiry, specifying"
34195 Set the lifetime for a positive cache entry.
34196 A value of zero seconds is legitimate.
34198 .vitem &*cacheneg&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34199 .cindex "quota cache" "negative entry expiry, specifying"
34200 As above, for a negative entry.
34202 .vitem &*no_cache*&
34203 Set both positive and negative lifetimes to zero.
34205 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
34206 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
34207 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
34208 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
34209 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
34210 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
34213 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
34215 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
34216 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
34217 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
34218 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
34219 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
34220 550 Sender verification failed
34222 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
34223 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
34224 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
34225 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
34228 verify = sender/no_details
34231 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
34232 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
34233 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
34234 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
34235 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
34236 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
34237 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
34240 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
34241 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
34242 verification also fails.
34244 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
34245 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
34248 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
34249 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
34250 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
34253 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
34255 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
34256 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
34257 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
34258 verification to succeed.
34260 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
34261 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
34262 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
34263 option. For example:
34265 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
34267 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
34268 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
34270 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
34271 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
34272 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
34273 address and a report is output for each of them.
34277 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
34278 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
34279 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
34280 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
34281 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
34282 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
34283 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
34287 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
34288 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
34289 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
34290 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
34291 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
34292 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
34294 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
34295 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
34296 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
34297 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
34300 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
34302 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
34304 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
34305 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
34307 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
34308 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
34311 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
34312 use for the DNS query. The default is:
34314 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
34316 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
34317 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
34318 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
34319 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
34322 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
34324 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
34325 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
34326 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
34328 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
34329 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
34330 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
34331 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
34332 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
34333 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
34334 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
34335 of legitimate HELO domains.
34337 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
34338 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
34339 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
34340 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
34343 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
34345 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
34346 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
34347 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
34352 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
34353 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
34354 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
34355 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
34356 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
34357 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
34358 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
34359 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
34361 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
34362 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
34363 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
34364 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
34365 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
34366 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
34367 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
34368 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
34370 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
34371 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
34374 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
34375 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
34378 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
34379 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
34382 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
34384 recipients = +batv_senders
34385 message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
34387 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
34389 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
34390 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
34391 !condition = $prvscheck_result
34392 message = Invalid reverse path signature.
34394 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
34395 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
34396 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
34397 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
34398 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
34400 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
34401 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
34402 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
34403 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
34404 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
34405 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
34406 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
34408 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
34409 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
34410 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
34411 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
34415 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
34417 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
34418 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
34419 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
34422 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
34425 external_smtp_batv:
34427 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
34428 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
34429 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
34430 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
34433 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
34437 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
34438 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
34439 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
34440 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
34441 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
34442 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
34443 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
34444 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
34445 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
34446 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
34448 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
34449 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
34450 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
34451 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
34452 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
34453 same host is fulfilling both functions,
34455 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
34457 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
34458 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
34459 system to arbitrary domains.
34462 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
34463 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
34464 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
34465 example, suppose you want to do the following:
34468 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
34469 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
34470 &'my.dom2.example'&.
34472 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
34473 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
34475 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
34476 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
34480 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
34482 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
34483 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
34484 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
34486 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
34490 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
34491 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
34493 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
34494 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
34495 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
34496 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
34497 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
34498 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
34499 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
34503 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
34504 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
34505 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
34506 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
34507 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
34512 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34513 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34515 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
34516 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
34517 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
34518 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
34519 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
34520 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
34523 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
34524 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
34525 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
34526 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
34527 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
34529 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
34530 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
34531 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
34534 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
34535 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
34537 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
34538 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
34539 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
34541 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
34542 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
34544 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
34547 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
34550 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
34551 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
34552 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
34553 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
34554 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
34555 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
34557 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
34558 temporarily created in a file called:
34560 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
34562 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
34563 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
34564 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
34565 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
34566 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
34568 control = no_mbox_unspool
34570 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
34571 same directory by default.
34575 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
34576 .cindex "virus scanning"
34577 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
34578 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
34579 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
34580 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
34581 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
34582 in memory and thus are much faster.
34584 Since message data needs to have arrived,
34585 the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
34587 &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
34588 &%acl_smtp_mime%& or
34591 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
34592 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
34594 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
34595 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
34596 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
34597 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
34599 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
34601 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
34603 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
34605 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
34607 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
34608 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
34609 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
34613 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
34614 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
34615 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
34616 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
34617 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
34618 This scanner type takes one option,
34619 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
34620 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
34621 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
34622 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
34623 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
34624 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
34625 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
34627 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
34628 If &`pass_unscanned`&
34629 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
34630 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
34635 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
34636 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
34637 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
34639 If you omit the argument, the default path
34640 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
34642 If you use a remote host,
34643 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
34644 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
34645 For information about available commands and their options you may use
34647 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
34653 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
34654 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
34655 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
34657 .vitem &%aveserver%&
34658 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
34659 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
34660 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
34661 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
34664 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
34669 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
34670 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
34671 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
34672 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
34673 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
34675 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
34676 a UNIX socket specification,
34677 a TCP socket specification,
34678 or a (global) option.
34680 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
34681 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
34682 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
34683 and the second a port number,
34684 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
34685 These per-server options are supported:
34687 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
34690 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
34691 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
34693 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
34697 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
34698 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
34699 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
34700 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
34701 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
34703 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
34705 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
34706 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
34707 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
34708 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
34710 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
34711 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
34712 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
34713 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
34714 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
34715 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
34716 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
34717 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
34718 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
34720 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
34721 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
34722 (Connection refused)
34725 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
34726 contributing the code for this scanner.
34729 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
34730 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
34731 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
34732 type takes 3 mandatory options:
34735 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
34736 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
34739 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
34740 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
34741 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
34742 the &"trigger"& expression.
34745 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
34746 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
34747 &"name"& expression.
34750 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
34752 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
34754 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
34755 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
34756 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
34757 configuration setting:
34759 av_scanner = cmdline:\
34760 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
34761 found in file:'(.+)'
34764 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
34765 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
34767 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
34768 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
34769 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
34770 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
34773 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
34774 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
34776 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
34777 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
34780 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
34781 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
34782 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
34786 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
34788 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
34790 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
34791 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
34792 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
34793 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
34796 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
34798 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
34801 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
34802 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
34803 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
34805 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
34807 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
34808 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
34810 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
34811 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
34812 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
34813 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
34814 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
34817 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
34819 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
34822 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
34823 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
34824 though some documentation was available in English.
34825 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
34826 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
34827 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
34829 The only option for this scanner type is
34830 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
34831 provided that mksd has
34832 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
34834 av_scanner = mksd:2
34836 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
34839 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
34840 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
34841 running on the local machine.
34842 There are four options:
34843 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
34844 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
34845 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
34846 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
34847 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
34850 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
34852 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
34853 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
34854 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
34855 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
34856 specify an empty element to get this.
34859 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
34860 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
34861 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
34862 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
34863 client communication. For example:
34865 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
34867 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
34871 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
34872 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
34875 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
34876 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
34877 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
34878 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
34879 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
34880 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
34883 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
34884 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
34885 The first element can then be one of
34888 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
34889 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
34892 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
34893 the condition fails immediately.
34895 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
34896 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
34897 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
34898 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
34899 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
34902 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
34903 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
34904 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
34906 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
34907 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
34910 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
34912 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
34914 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
34915 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
34916 is set to record the actual address used.
34918 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
34919 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
34920 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
34921 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
34924 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
34925 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
34927 Here is a very simple scanning example:
34930 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34932 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
34934 deny malware = */defer_ok
34935 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34937 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
34938 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
34940 av_scanner = $acl_m0
34942 in the main Exim configuration.
34944 deny set acl_m0 = sophie
34946 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34948 deny set acl_m0 = aveserver
34950 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34954 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
34955 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
34956 .cindex "spam scanning"
34957 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
34959 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
34960 score and a report for the message.
34961 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
34963 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
34964 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
34965 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
34967 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
34969 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
34971 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
34972 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
34975 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
34976 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
34977 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
34978 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
34979 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
34980 configuration as follows (example):
34982 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
34984 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
34985 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
34986 iptables firewall, consider setting
34987 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
34988 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
34989 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
34990 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
34994 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
34996 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
34998 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
35001 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
35002 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
35003 filename instead of an address/port pair:
35005 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
35007 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
35008 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
35009 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
35010 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
35012 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
35013 192.168.2.11 783 : \
35016 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
35017 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
35018 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
35021 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
35022 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
35023 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
35024 take care to not double the separator.
35026 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
35027 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
35028 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
35029 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
35031 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
35033 The supported options are:
35035 pri=<priority> Selection priority
35036 weight=<value> Selection bias
35037 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
35038 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
35039 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
35040 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
35043 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
35044 higher values being tried first.
35045 The default priority is 1.
35047 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
35048 Within a priority set
35049 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
35050 The default value for selection bias is 1.
35052 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
35053 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
35054 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
35055 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
35057 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
35058 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
35060 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
35061 The default value is two minutes.
35063 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
35064 a failed connect is made.
35065 The default is to not retry.
35067 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
35068 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
35069 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
35072 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
35073 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
35074 is set to record the actual address used.
35076 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
35077 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
35080 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35082 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
35083 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
35084 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
35085 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
35086 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
35089 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
35090 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
35091 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
35092 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
35093 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
35095 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
35096 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
35098 or the use of PRDR,
35099 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
35100 are needed to use this feature.
35102 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
35103 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
35104 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
35107 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
35108 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
35109 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
35112 deny condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
35114 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35117 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
35118 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
35119 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
35120 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
35122 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
35123 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
35125 Except for &$spam_report$&,
35126 these variables are saved with the received message so are
35127 available for use at delivery time.
35130 .vitem &$spam_score$&
35131 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
35132 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
35134 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
35135 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
35136 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
35137 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
35138 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
35140 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
35141 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
35142 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
35143 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
35144 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
35145 spam bar is 50 characters.
35147 .vitem &$spam_report$&
35148 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
35149 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
35150 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
35151 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
35152 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
35153 unencoded in headers.
35155 .vitem &$spam_action$&
35156 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
35157 spam score versus threshold.
35158 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
35162 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
35163 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
35164 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
35166 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
35167 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
35168 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
35169 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
35170 spam condition, like this:
35172 deny spam = joe/defer_ok
35173 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35175 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
35177 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
35180 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
35181 warn spam = nobody:true
35182 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
35183 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
35185 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
35186 # is over threshold
35188 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
35190 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
35191 deny spam = nobody:true
35192 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
35193 message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
35198 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
35199 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
35200 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
35201 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
35202 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
35203 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
35204 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
35205 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
35206 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
35207 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
35210 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
35211 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
35212 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
35213 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
35214 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
35215 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
35216 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
35218 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
35219 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
35220 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
35221 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
35222 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
35224 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
35225 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
35226 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
35227 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
35228 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
35231 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
35233 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
35237 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
35239 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
35240 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
35241 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
35242 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
35244 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
35245 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
35246 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
35247 the full path and filename.
35249 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
35250 filename, and the default path is then used.
35252 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
35253 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages.
35254 The variable &$mime_filename$& will have the suggested name for the file.
35255 Note however that this might contain anything, and is very difficult
35256 to safely use as all or even part of the filename.
35257 If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
35258 automatically unlinked.
35260 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
35261 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
35262 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
35263 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
35264 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
35266 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
35267 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
35268 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
35270 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
35271 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
35272 available in the MIME ACL:
35275 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
35276 &$mime_anomaly_text$&
35277 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_level$&
35278 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_text$&
35279 If there are problems decoding, these variables contain information on
35280 the detected issue.
35282 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
35283 .vindex &$mime_boundary$&
35284 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$& below), it should
35285 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
35286 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
35287 contains the empty string.
35289 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
35290 .vindex &$mime_charset$&
35291 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
35292 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
35298 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
35299 case-insensitively.
35301 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
35302 .vindex &$mime_content_description$&
35303 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
35304 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
35305 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
35306 only used for display purposes.
35308 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
35309 .vindex &$mime_content_disposition$&
35310 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
35311 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
35313 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
35314 .vindex &$mime_content_id$&
35315 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
35316 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
35318 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
35319 .vindex &$mime_content_size$&
35320 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
35321 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
35322 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
35323 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
35325 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
35326 .vindex &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
35327 This variable contains the normalized content of the
35328 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
35329 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
35331 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
35332 .vindex &$mime_content_type$&
35333 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
35334 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
35335 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
35339 application/octet-stream
35343 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
35346 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
35347 .vindex &$mime_decoded_filename$&
35348 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
35349 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
35350 containing the decoded data.
35355 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
35356 .vindex &$mime_filename$&
35357 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
35358 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
35359 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
35362 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
35364 found, this variable contains the empty string.
35366 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
35367 .vindex &$mime_is_coverletter$&
35368 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
35369 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
35370 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
35372 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
35373 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
35377 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
35380 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
35381 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
35384 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
35385 and the rest are attachments.
35388 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
35391 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
35392 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
35393 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
35395 deny !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
35396 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
35397 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
35398 message = HTML mail is not accepted here
35401 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
35402 .vindex &$mime_is_multipart$&
35403 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
35404 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
35405 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
35406 want to carry out specific actions on them.
35408 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
35409 .vindex &$mime_is_rfc822$&
35410 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
35411 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
35412 decoding is fully recursive.
35414 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
35415 .vindex &$mime_part_count$&
35416 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
35417 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
35418 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
35419 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
35420 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
35421 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
35426 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
35427 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
35428 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
35429 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
35430 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
35432 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
35433 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
35434 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
35435 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
35436 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
35438 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
35439 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
35440 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
35441 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
35442 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
35443 32K characters are checked.
35445 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
35446 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
35447 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
35448 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
35449 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
35451 deny regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
35452 message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
35454 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
35455 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
35456 matching regular expression.
35457 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
35458 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
35460 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
35468 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35469 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35471 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
35472 "Local scan function"
35473 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
35474 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
35475 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
35476 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
35477 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
35479 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
35480 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
35481 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
35482 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
35483 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
35485 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
35486 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
35487 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
35488 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
35490 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
35491 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
35492 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
35493 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
35495 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
35496 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
35497 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
35498 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
35499 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
35500 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
35501 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
35502 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
35503 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
35507 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
35508 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
35509 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
35510 function is before building Exim, by setting
35511 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
35512 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
35513 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
35514 directory, so you might set
35516 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
35517 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
35519 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&;
35520 the source file(s) for it should first #define LOCAL_SCAN
35521 and then #include "local_scan.h".
35523 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
35524 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
35525 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
35526 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
35527 _src/local_scan.c_.
35529 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
35530 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
35532 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
35534 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
35539 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
35540 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
35541 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
35542 You must include this line near the start of your code:
35545 #include "local_scan.h"
35547 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
35548 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
35549 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
35550 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
35551 It also makes available the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
35552 strings and pointers to character strings:
35554 #define CS (char *)
35555 #define CCS (const char *)
35556 #define CSS (char **)
35557 #define US (unsigned char *)
35558 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
35559 #define USS (unsigned char **)
35561 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
35563 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
35565 The arguments are as follows:
35568 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
35569 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
35570 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
35572 The descriptor is positioned at character 26 of the file, which is the first
35573 character of the body itself, because the first 26 characters (19 characters
35574 before Exim 4.97) are the message id followed by &`-D`& and a newline.
35575 If you rewind the file, you should use the
35576 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
35577 case this changes in some future version.
35579 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
35580 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
35583 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
35586 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
35587 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
35588 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
35589 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
35590 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
35591 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
35593 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
35594 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
35595 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
35597 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
35598 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
35599 queued without immediate delivery.
35601 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
35602 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
35603 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
35604 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
35605 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
35608 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
35609 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
35610 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
35613 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
35614 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
35615 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
35616 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
35617 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
35618 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
35619 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
35621 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
35622 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
35623 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
35626 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
35627 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
35628 &%-oe%& command line options.
35632 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
35633 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
35634 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
35635 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
35636 want to do this, you must have the line
35638 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
35640 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
35641 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
35642 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
35645 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
35646 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
35647 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
35648 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
35649 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
35650 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
35652 static int my_integer_option = 42;
35653 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
35655 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
35656 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
35657 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
35660 int local_scan_options_count =
35661 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
35663 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
35664 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
35668 my_string = some string of text...
35670 The available types of option data are as follows:
35673 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
35674 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
35675 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
35676 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
35677 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
35678 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
35681 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
35682 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
35683 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
35684 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
35687 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
35688 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
35691 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
35692 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
35693 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
35694 printed with the suffix K or M.
35696 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
35697 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
35698 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
35699 always output in octal.
35701 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
35702 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
35703 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
35705 .vitem &*opt_time*&
35706 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
35707 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
35710 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
35711 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
35715 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
35716 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
35717 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
35718 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
35719 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
35720 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
35721 C variables are as follows:
35724 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
35725 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
35726 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
35728 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
35729 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
35730 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
35732 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
35733 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
35734 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
35735 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
35738 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
35739 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
35740 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
35743 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
35744 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
35748 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
35749 selected, you should use code like this:
35751 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
35752 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
35754 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
35755 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
35756 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
35758 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
35759 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
35762 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
35763 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
35765 .vitem &*const&~uschar&~*headers_charset*&
35766 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
35768 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
35769 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
35770 &%-bh%& command line option.
35772 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
35773 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
35774 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
35776 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
35777 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
35778 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
35779 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
35781 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
35782 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
35783 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
35785 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
35786 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
35788 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
35789 The number of accepted recipients.
35791 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
35792 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
35793 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
35794 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
35795 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
35796 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
35797 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
35798 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
35799 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
35800 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
35801 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
35802 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
35804 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
35805 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
35807 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
35808 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
35809 locally-submitted messages.
35811 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
35812 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
35813 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
35815 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
35816 The name of the sending host, if known.
35818 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
35819 The port on the sending host.
35821 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
35822 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
35824 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
35825 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
35827 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
35828 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
35829 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
35833 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
35834 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
35835 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
35836 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
35841 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
35842 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
35844 .vitem &*int&~type*&
35845 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
35846 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
35847 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
35848 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
35849 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
35850 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
35852 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
35853 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
35856 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
35857 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
35858 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
35863 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
35864 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
35867 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
35868 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
35870 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
35871 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
35872 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
35873 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
35875 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
35876 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
35877 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
35878 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
35879 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
35880 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
35881 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
35882 is NULL for all recipients.
35887 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
35888 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
35889 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
35890 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
35894 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
35895 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
35897 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
35898 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
35899 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
35900 for the process in &%newumask%&.
35902 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
35903 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
35904 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
35905 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
35906 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
35908 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
35910 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
35911 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
35912 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
35913 return value is as follows:
35918 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
35924 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
35930 The process timed out.
35934 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
35937 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
35938 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
35939 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
35940 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
35941 forks a subprocess that is running
35943 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
35945 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
35946 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
35947 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
35948 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
35950 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
35951 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
35952 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
35953 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
35956 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
35957 *sender_authentication)*&
35958 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
35961 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
35963 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
35966 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
35967 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
35968 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
35969 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
35970 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
35972 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
35973 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
35976 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
35977 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
35978 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
35979 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
35980 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
35981 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
35982 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
35983 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
35985 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
35986 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
35987 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
35988 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
35989 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
35990 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
35992 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
35993 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
35994 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
35995 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
35997 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
35998 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
35999 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
36000 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
36001 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
36002 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
36003 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
36004 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
36005 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
36006 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
36008 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
36009 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
36011 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
36012 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
36015 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
36016 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
36017 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
36018 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
36019 match the specification, the function does nothing.
36022 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
36023 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
36024 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
36025 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
36026 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
36027 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
36029 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
36031 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
36032 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
36033 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
36034 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
36035 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
36038 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
36039 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
36040 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
36041 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
36042 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
36043 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
36044 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
36045 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
36047 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
36048 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
36049 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
36050 .itable none 0 0 2 15* left 85* left
36051 .irow &`OK`& "match succeeded"
36052 .irow &`FAIL`& "match failed"
36053 .irow &`DEFER`& "match deferred"
36055 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
36056 inability to contact a database.
36058 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
36060 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
36061 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
36062 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
36064 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
36066 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
36067 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
36068 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
36070 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
36072 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
36075 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
36077 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
36078 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
36079 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
36080 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
36081 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
36082 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
36085 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
36087 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
36088 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
36089 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
36090 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
36091 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
36092 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
36095 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
36096 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
36097 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
36098 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
36100 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
36101 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
36102 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
36103 value afterwards. For example:
36105 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
36106 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
36107 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
36110 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
36111 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
36112 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
36113 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
36120 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
36121 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
36122 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
36123 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
36124 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
36125 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
36126 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
36127 binary string is returned with an error message.
36129 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
36130 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
36131 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
36133 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
36134 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
36135 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
36136 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
36137 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
36139 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
36140 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
36141 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
36143 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
36144 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
36145 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
36146 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
36150 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
36151 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
36154 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
36155 The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
36156 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
36157 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
36158 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
36159 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
36160 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
36161 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
36164 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
36165 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
36167 The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
36168 (when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
36169 This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
36170 sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
36172 The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API/ABI.
36173 Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent, at which point the
36174 ABI version number was incremented.
36176 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
36177 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
36178 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
36179 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
36180 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
36181 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
36182 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
36184 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
36185 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
36187 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
36188 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
36189 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
36190 multiple output lines.
36192 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
36194 guarantee a flush of
36195 pending output, and therefore does not test
36196 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
36197 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
36198 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
36199 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
36200 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
36203 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int,BOOL)*&
36204 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
36205 chunk of memory whose size is given by the first argument.
36206 The second argument should be given as TRUE if the memory will be used for
36207 data possibly coming from an attacker (eg. the message content),
36208 FALSE if it is locally-sourced.
36209 Exim bombs out if it ever
36210 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
36212 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int,BOOL)*&
36213 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
36214 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
36216 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
36219 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
36222 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
36223 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
36224 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
36225 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
36226 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
36227 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
36233 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
36234 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
36235 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
36236 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
36237 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
36238 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
36239 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
36242 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
36243 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
36244 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
36245 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
36247 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
36248 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
36250 store_pool = POOL_PERM
36252 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
36253 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
36254 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
36255 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
36257 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
36258 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
36259 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
36260 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
36267 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36268 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36270 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
36271 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
36272 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
36273 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
36274 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
36275 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
36276 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
36277 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
36279 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
36280 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
36281 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
36282 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
36283 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
36285 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
36286 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
36287 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
36288 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
36289 .cindex retry condition
36290 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
36291 prevent it happening on retries.
36293 .vindex "&$domain$&"
36294 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
36295 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
36296 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
36297 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
36298 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
36299 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
36300 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
36303 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
36304 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
36305 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
36306 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
36307 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
36308 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
36309 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
36311 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
36312 system_filter_user = exim
36314 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
36315 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
36316 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
36317 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
36318 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
36319 by the &%reply%& command.
36322 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
36323 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
36324 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
36325 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
36327 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
36328 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
36332 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
36333 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
36334 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
36335 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
36336 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
36337 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
36340 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
36341 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
36342 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
36343 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
36344 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
36345 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
36346 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
36348 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
36349 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
36350 succeed, it will not be tried again.
36351 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
36352 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
36354 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
36355 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
36356 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
36357 to which users' filter files can refer.
36361 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
36362 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
36363 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
36364 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
36365 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
36369 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
36370 .cindex "freezing messages"
36371 .cindex "message" "freezing"
36372 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
36373 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
36374 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
36375 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
36376 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
36377 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
36378 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
36379 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
36380 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
36382 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
36384 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
36386 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
36387 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
36388 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
36389 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
36390 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
36393 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
36394 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
36395 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
36396 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
36398 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
36399 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
36400 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
36401 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
36402 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
36403 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
36404 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
36405 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
36406 message. For example:
36408 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
36409 because it contains attachments that we are \
36410 not prepared to receive."
36413 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
36414 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
36415 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
36416 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
36417 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
36418 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
36421 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
36422 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
36424 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
36425 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
36426 generated by the filter.
36428 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
36430 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
36431 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
36437 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
36438 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
36443 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
36444 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
36445 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
36446 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
36447 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
36449 headers add <string>
36450 headers remove <string>
36452 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
36453 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
36454 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
36455 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
36456 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
36458 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
36459 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
36460 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
36463 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
36464 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
36467 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
36468 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
36469 space after input continuations is ignored.
36471 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
36472 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
36473 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
36474 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
36475 header with the same name, they are all removed.
36477 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
36478 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
36479 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
36480 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
36481 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
36482 used for all recipients of the message.
36484 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
36485 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
36486 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
36487 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
36488 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
36489 until the message is actually being written (see section
36490 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
36492 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
36493 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
36494 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
36495 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
36496 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
36497 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
36498 modified more than once.
36500 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
36501 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
36504 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
36505 headers remove "Subject"
36506 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
36507 headers remove "Old-Subject"
36512 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
36513 .cindex "envelope from"
36514 .cindex "envelope sender"
36515 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
36517 errors_to <some address>
36519 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
36520 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
36521 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
36524 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
36526 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
36527 address if its delivery failed.
36531 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
36532 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
36533 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
36534 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
36535 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
36536 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
36537 such as &$local_part_data$& and &$domain_data$& can be used,
36538 and indeed, the choice of filter file could be made dependent on them.
36539 This is an example of a router which implements such a filter:
36544 domains = +local_domains
36545 file = /central/filters/$local_part_data
36550 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
36551 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
36552 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
36553 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
36555 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
36556 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
36557 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
36558 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
36560 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
36561 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
36562 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
36569 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36570 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36572 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
36573 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
36574 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
36575 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
36576 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
36577 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
36578 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
36579 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
36581 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
36582 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
36583 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
36584 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
36585 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
36587 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
36588 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
36589 loopback interface specially in any way.
36591 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
36592 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
36597 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
36598 .cindex "message" "submission"
36599 .cindex "submission mode"
36600 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
36601 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
36602 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
36603 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
36605 control = submission
36607 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
36608 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
36609 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
36610 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
36611 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
36612 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
36614 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
36615 control = submission
36617 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
36618 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
36619 is used to separate options. For example:
36621 control = submission/sender_retain
36623 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
36624 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
36625 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
36626 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
36627 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
36628 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
36629 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
36631 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
36632 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
36635 control = submission/domain=some.domain
36637 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
36638 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
36639 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
36640 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
36642 accept authenticated = *
36643 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
36644 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
36645 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
36647 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
36648 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
36649 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
36651 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
36653 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
36656 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
36658 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
36659 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
36660 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
36661 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
36663 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
36664 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
36665 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
36666 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
36667 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
36668 spoof another's address.
36670 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
36671 .cindex "line endings"
36672 .cindex "carriage return"
36674 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
36675 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
36676 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
36677 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
36678 use CRLF or just CR.
36680 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
36681 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
36682 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
36683 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
36684 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
36685 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
36686 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
36687 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
36691 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
36694 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
36695 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
36698 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
36699 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
36700 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
36701 people trying to play silly games.
36703 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
36704 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
36705 line and a bare LF in a body line is replaced with a space.
36707 If the first header line received in a message does not end with CRLF, a subsequent
36708 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
36715 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
36716 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
36717 .cindex "address" "qualification"
36718 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
36719 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
36720 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
36721 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
36722 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
36724 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
36725 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
36726 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
36727 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
36728 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
36730 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
36731 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
36732 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
36733 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
36734 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
36735 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
36736 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
36737 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
36742 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
36743 .cindex "&""From""& line"
36744 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
36745 .cindex "sender" "address"
36746 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
36747 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
36748 .cindex "envelope from"
36749 .cindex "envelope sender"
36750 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
36751 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
36752 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
36753 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
36755 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
36756 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
36758 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
36759 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
36760 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
36761 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
36762 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
36763 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
36764 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
36765 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
36766 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
36768 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
36769 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
36770 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
36771 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
36772 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
36773 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
36774 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
36776 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
36777 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
36778 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
36780 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
36781 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
36782 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
36783 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
36787 .section "Header lines"
36788 .subsection "Resent- header lines" SECID220
36790 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
36791 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
36792 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
36793 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
36794 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
36797 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
36798 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
36801 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
36802 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
36806 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
36807 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
36809 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
36810 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
36811 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
36813 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
36816 For a locally-submitted message,
36817 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
36818 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
36819 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
36820 included in log lines in this case.
36822 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
36823 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
36829 .subsection Auto-Submitted: SECID221
36830 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
36831 includes the header line:
36833 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
36836 .subsection Bcc: SECID222
36837 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
36838 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
36839 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
36840 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
36841 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
36844 .subsection Date: SECID223
36846 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
36847 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
36848 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
36850 .subsection Delivery-date: SECID224
36851 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
36852 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
36853 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
36854 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
36855 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
36856 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
36857 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
36861 .subsection Envelope-to: SECID225
36862 .chindex Envelope-to:
36863 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
36864 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
36865 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
36866 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
36867 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
36868 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
36872 .subsection From: SECTthefrohea
36874 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
36875 .cindex "message" "submission"
36876 .cindex "submission mode"
36877 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
36878 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
36881 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
36882 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
36884 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
36885 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
36887 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
36888 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
36889 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
36891 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
36892 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
36894 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
36895 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
36899 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
36901 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
36902 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
36903 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
36904 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
36905 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
36906 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
36907 &%qualify_domain%&.
36909 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
36910 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
36911 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
36912 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
36915 .subsection Message-ID: SECID226
36916 .chindex Message-ID:
36917 .cindex "message" "submission"
36918 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
36919 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
36920 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
36921 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
36922 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
36923 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
36924 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
36925 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
36926 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
36927 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
36930 .subsection Received: SECID227
36932 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
36933 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
36934 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
36936 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
36937 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
36938 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
36939 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
36941 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
36942 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
36943 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
36946 .subsection References: SECID228
36947 .chindex References:
36948 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
36949 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
36950 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
36951 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
36952 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
36953 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
36954 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
36955 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
36956 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
36960 .subsection Return-path: SECID229
36961 .chindex Return-path:
36962 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
36963 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
36964 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
36965 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
36966 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
36967 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
36971 .subsection Sender: SECTthesenhea
36972 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
36973 .cindex "message" "submission"
36975 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
36976 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
36977 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
36978 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
36981 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
36982 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
36983 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
36984 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
36985 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
36986 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
36987 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
36988 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
36989 line is added to the message.
36991 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
36992 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
36993 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
36994 options true at the same time.
36996 .cindex "submission mode"
36997 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
36998 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
36999 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
37000 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
37002 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
37003 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
37004 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
37005 created as follows:
37008 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
37009 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
37010 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
37012 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
37013 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
37015 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
37016 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
37019 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
37020 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
37021 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
37022 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
37024 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
37025 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
37026 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
37027 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
37031 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
37032 "SECTheadersaddrem"
37033 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
37034 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
37035 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
37036 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
37037 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
37038 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
37039 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
37041 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
37042 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
37043 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
37044 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
37045 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
37046 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
37048 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
37049 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
37050 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
37052 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
37053 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
37054 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
37056 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
37057 X-added-second: another added header line
37059 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
37061 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
37062 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
37063 Each header-line is separately expanded.
37065 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
37066 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
37067 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
37068 not part of the names. For example:
37070 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
37073 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
37074 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
37075 Each item is separately expanded.
37076 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
37077 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
37078 will act as list separators.
37080 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
37081 items are expanded at routing time,
37082 and then associated with all addresses that are
37083 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
37084 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
37085 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
37087 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
37088 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
37089 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
37090 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
37092 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
37093 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
37094 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
37097 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
37098 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
37099 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
37100 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
37101 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
37102 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
37103 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
37105 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
37106 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
37107 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
37108 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
37110 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
37111 the following consequences:
37114 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
37115 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
37116 to it, at all times.
37118 Header lines that are added by a router's
37119 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
37120 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
37122 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
37123 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
37125 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
37126 a later router or by a transport.
37128 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
37129 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
37131 headers_remove = subject
37132 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
37136 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
37137 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
37143 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
37144 .cindex "address" "constructed"
37145 .cindex "constructed address"
37146 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
37149 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
37153 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
37155 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
37156 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
37157 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
37158 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
37159 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
37160 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
37161 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
37162 there is no password file entry.
37165 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
37166 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
37167 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
37168 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
37169 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
37170 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
37171 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
37172 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
37176 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
37177 .cindex "case of local parts"
37178 .cindex "local part" "case of"
37179 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
37180 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
37181 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
37182 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
37183 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
37184 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
37187 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
37188 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
37189 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
37190 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
37191 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
37195 domains = +local_domains
37196 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
37197 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
37200 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
37201 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
37202 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
37203 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
37204 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
37208 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
37209 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
37210 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
37211 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
37212 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
37213 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
37214 empty components for compatibility.
37218 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
37219 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
37220 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
37221 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
37222 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
37223 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
37225 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
37226 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
37227 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
37228 example, a header such as
37232 might get rewritten as
37234 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
37236 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
37237 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
37240 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
37241 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
37242 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
37243 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
37244 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
37245 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
37246 .ecindex IIDmesproc
37250 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37251 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37253 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
37254 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
37255 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
37256 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
37257 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
37258 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
37259 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
37262 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
37264 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
37266 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
37269 For mail delivery, the following are available:
37272 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
37274 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
37277 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
37280 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
37281 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
37284 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
37285 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
37286 used to contain the envelope information.
37290 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
37291 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
37292 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
37293 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
37294 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
37297 .cindex "SIZE" "option on MAIL command"
37298 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
37299 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
37300 processing is the same in both cases.
37302 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
37303 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
37304 extension is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
37305 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
37306 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
37307 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
37308 .cindex "transport" "filter"
37309 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
37310 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
37313 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
37314 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
37315 required for the transaction.
37317 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
37318 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
37319 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
37320 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
37321 is called for verification.
37323 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
37324 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
37325 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
37327 .cindex "carriage return"
37329 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
37330 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
37331 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
37334 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
37335 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
37336 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
37337 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
37338 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
37339 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
37340 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
37341 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
37342 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
37344 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
37345 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
37346 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
37347 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
37349 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
37350 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
37351 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
37352 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
37354 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
37355 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
37356 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
37357 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
37358 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected.
37359 If it finds one, it arranges to attempt that message on the same connection.
37361 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
37362 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
37364 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37365 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
37366 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
37367 square bracket of the IP address.
37372 .subsection "Errors in outgoing SMTP" SECToutSMTPerr
37373 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
37374 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
37375 .cindex "host" "error"
37376 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
37377 message errors, and recipient errors.
37380 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
37381 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
37382 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
37385 Connection refused or timed out,
37387 Any error response code on connection,
37389 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
37391 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
37393 I/O errors at any time,
37395 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
37396 the &"."& at the end of the data.
37399 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
37400 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
37401 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
37402 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
37403 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
37404 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
37405 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
37406 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
37408 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
37409 .cindex "message" "error"
37410 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
37411 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
37412 message errors are:
37415 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
37418 Timeout after MAIL,
37420 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
37421 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
37422 connection at any other time.
37425 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
37426 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
37427 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
37428 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
37429 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
37430 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
37431 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
37432 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
37433 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
37434 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
37436 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
37437 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
37438 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
37441 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
37442 .cindex "recipient" "error"
37443 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
37444 recipient errors are:
37447 Any error response to RCPT,
37449 Timeout after RCPT.
37452 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
37453 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
37454 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
37455 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
37456 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
37457 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
37458 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
37459 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
37460 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
37461 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
37462 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
37463 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
37464 the retry clock is reset.
37466 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
37467 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
37468 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
37469 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
37470 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
37471 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
37472 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
37473 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
37474 recipient's retry time.
37477 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
37478 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
37479 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
37480 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
37481 until the next delivery attempt.
37483 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
37484 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
37485 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
37486 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
37487 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
37490 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
37491 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
37492 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
37493 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
37494 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
37495 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
37496 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
37498 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
37499 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
37500 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
37501 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
37502 then to be treated as a host error.
37504 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
37505 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
37506 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
37507 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
37508 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
37513 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
37514 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
37515 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
37518 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
37519 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
37520 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
37522 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
37524 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
37525 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
37526 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
37527 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
37528 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
37529 stream and exits with an error code.
37531 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
37532 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
37533 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
37534 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
37536 .cindex "carriage return"
37538 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
37539 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
37540 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
37542 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
37543 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
37544 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
37546 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
37547 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
37548 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
37549 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
37550 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
37551 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
37552 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
37553 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
37555 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
37556 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
37557 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
37558 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
37559 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
37560 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
37561 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
37562 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
37563 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
37565 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
37566 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
37567 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
37569 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
37570 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
37571 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
37572 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
37573 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
37575 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
37576 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
37577 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
37578 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
37579 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
37580 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
37581 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
37583 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
37584 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
37585 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
37586 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
37587 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
37589 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
37590 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
37591 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
37592 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
37593 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
37594 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
37595 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
37596 a delivery process.
37598 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
37599 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
37600 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
37601 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
37602 however, available with &'inetd'&.
37604 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
37605 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
37606 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
37607 section &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&.
37609 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
37610 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
37611 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
37615 .subsection "Unrecognized SMTP commands" SECID234
37616 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
37617 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
37618 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
37619 the error response to the last command. The default value for
37620 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
37621 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
37622 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
37625 .subsection "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" SECID235
37626 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
37627 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
37628 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
37629 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
37630 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
37631 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
37632 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
37633 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
37634 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
37635 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
37639 .subsection "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" SECID236
37640 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
37641 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
37642 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
37643 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
37644 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
37645 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
37646 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
37648 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
37649 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
37650 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
37651 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
37652 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
37655 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
37656 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
37657 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
37659 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
37660 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
37661 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
37662 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
37663 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
37668 .subsection "The VRFY and EXPN commands" SECID237
37669 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
37670 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
37671 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
37673 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
37674 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
37675 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
37676 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
37677 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
37678 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
37679 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
37680 SMTP response codes.
37682 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
37683 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
37684 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
37685 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
37686 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
37687 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
37688 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
37689 VRFY verification failures are logged in the main log for consistency with
37694 .subsection "The ETRN command" SECTETRN
37695 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
37696 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
37697 Most modern installations never need to use this.
37698 It is used for managing messages queued for an intermittently-connecting
37699 destination (eg. one using a dialup connection).
37701 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_etrn%&"
37702 The command is only available if permitted by an ACL
37703 specfied by the main-section &%acl_smtp_etrn%& option.
37705 RFC 1985 describes an ESMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
37706 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
37707 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
37708 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
37709 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
37711 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
37712 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
37713 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
37714 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
37715 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
37716 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
37717 argument. For example,
37725 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
37726 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
37727 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
37728 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
37729 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
37731 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
37732 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
37733 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
37734 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
37735 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
37736 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
37737 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
37738 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
37740 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
37741 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
37742 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
37743 whatever the form of its argument. For
37746 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
37747 $sender_host_address
37749 .vindex "&$domain$&"
37750 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
37751 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
37752 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
37753 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
37754 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
37755 for it to change them before running the command.
37759 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
37760 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
37761 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
37762 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
37763 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
37764 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
37765 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
37766 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
37767 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
37768 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
37769 runs for RCPT commands:
37773 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
37777 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
37778 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
37779 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
37780 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
37781 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
37782 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
37783 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
37784 envelope along with the message.
37786 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
37787 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
37788 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
37789 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
37790 can be used to specify it.
37792 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
37793 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
37794 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
37795 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
37796 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
37799 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
37800 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
37801 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
37806 driver = manualroute
37807 transport = smtp_appendfile
37808 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
37812 driver = appendfile
37813 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
37818 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
37819 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
37820 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
37824 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
37825 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
37826 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
37827 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
37828 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
37829 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
37830 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
37831 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
37832 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
37833 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
37835 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
37836 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
37838 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
37839 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
37840 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
37841 make some use of automatically, for example:
37843 554 Unexpected end of file
37844 Transaction started in line 10
37845 Error detected in line 14
37847 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
37850 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
37851 The error message was:
37853 501 '>' missing at end of address
37855 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
37856 The error was detected in line 12.
37857 The SMTP command at fault was:
37859 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
37861 1 previous message was successfully processed.
37862 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
37864 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
37865 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
37867 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
37868 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
37872 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37873 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37875 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
37876 "Customizing messages"
37877 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
37878 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
37879 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
37880 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
37881 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
37883 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
37884 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
37885 option. Exim also adds the line
37887 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
37889 to all warning and bounce messages,
37892 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
37893 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
37894 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
37895 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
37896 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
37897 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
37898 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
37900 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
37901 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
37902 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
37903 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
37904 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
37907 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
37908 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
37909 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
37910 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
37911 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
37912 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
37913 option, rounded to a whole number.
37915 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
37918 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
37919 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
37921 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
37922 failing addresses with their error messages.
37924 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
37925 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
37927 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
37928 The fields exist for back-compatibility
37931 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
37932 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
37933 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
37935 Subject: Mail delivery failed
37936 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
37937 {: returning message to sender}}
37939 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
37941 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
37942 {that you sent }{sent by
37946 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
37947 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
37949 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
37951 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
37954 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
37956 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
37959 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
37960 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
37961 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
37962 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
37963 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
37967 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
37968 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
37970 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
37971 the delayed addresses.
37973 The third item then ends the message.
37976 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
37977 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
37979 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
37980 $warn_message_delay
37982 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
37984 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
37985 {that you sent }{sent by
37989 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
37990 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
37992 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
37993 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
37994 The date of the message is: $h_date
37996 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
37998 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
37999 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
38000 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
38001 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
38002 the message will be returned to you.
38004 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
38005 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
38006 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
38007 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
38008 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
38009 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
38010 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
38011 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
38017 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38018 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38020 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
38021 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
38022 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
38026 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
38027 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
38028 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
38029 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
38030 routing explicitly:
38032 send_to_smart_host:
38033 driver = manualroute
38034 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
38035 transport = remote_smtp
38037 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
38038 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
38039 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
38040 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
38041 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
38046 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
38047 .cindex "mailing lists"
38048 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
38049 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
38050 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
38052 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
38053 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
38054 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
38055 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
38059 domains = lists.example
38060 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38063 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
38066 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
38067 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
38068 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
38069 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
38071 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
38072 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
38075 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
38076 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
38077 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
38078 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
38079 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
38081 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
38082 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
38083 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
38084 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
38085 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
38086 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
38087 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
38088 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
38089 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
38093 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
38094 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
38095 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
38096 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
38097 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
38098 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
38099 addresses are not rigorously checked.
38101 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
38102 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
38103 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
38104 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
38105 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
38109 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
38110 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
38111 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
38112 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
38113 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
38114 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
38115 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
38116 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
38117 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
38118 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
38120 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
38121 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
38122 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
38123 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
38124 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
38125 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
38126 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
38127 pre-existing messages.
38129 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
38130 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
38131 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
38132 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
38133 one level of expansion anyway.
38137 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
38138 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
38139 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
38140 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
38141 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
38142 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
38144 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
38145 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
38149 domains = lists.example
38150 local_part_suffix = -request
38151 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file {/usr/lists}}
38152 file = /usr/lists/${local_part_data}-request
38157 domains = lists.example
38158 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38159 senders = ${if exists {$local_part_data} {lsearch;$local_part_data}{*}}
38160 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38163 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
38168 domains = lists.example
38170 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
38172 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
38173 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
38174 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
38177 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
38178 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
38179 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
38180 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
38181 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
38182 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
38183 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
38184 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
38185 &"unrouteable address"& error.
38187 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
38188 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
38189 the address, giving a suitable error message.
38194 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
38196 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
38197 .cindex "envelope from"
38198 .cindex "envelope sender"
38199 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
38200 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
38201 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
38202 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
38203 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
38204 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
38206 .oindex &%errors_to%&
38207 .oindex &%return_path%&
38208 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
38209 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
38210 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
38211 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
38212 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
38213 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
38214 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
38220 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
38221 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
38223 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
38224 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
38225 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
38226 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
38227 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
38228 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
38229 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
38232 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
38234 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
38235 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
38236 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
38237 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
38238 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
38239 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
38241 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
38242 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
38243 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
38244 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
38248 domains = ! +local_domains
38250 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
38251 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
38254 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
38255 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
38256 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
38257 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
38260 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
38261 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
38262 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
38263 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
38264 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
38268 domains = ! +local_domains
38269 transport = remote_smtp
38271 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
38272 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
38275 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
38276 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
38277 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
38278 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
38281 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
38282 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
38283 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
38284 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
38285 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
38286 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
38294 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
38295 .cindex "virtual domains"
38296 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
38297 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
38301 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
38302 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
38303 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
38305 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
38306 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
38307 have login accounts on that host.
38310 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
38311 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
38312 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
38313 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
38314 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
38315 to a router of this form:
38319 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
38320 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain_data}}
38323 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
38324 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
38325 domain that is being processed.
38326 The &(dsearch)& lookup used results in an untainted version of &$domain$&
38327 being placed into the &$domain_data$& variable.
38329 When the router runs, it looks up the local
38330 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
38331 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
38332 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
38334 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
38335 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
38336 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
38337 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
38339 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
38340 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
38341 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
38345 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
38346 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
38347 transport = my_mailboxes
38349 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
38350 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
38351 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
38352 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
38353 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
38357 driver = appendfile
38358 file = /var/mail/$domain_data/$local_part_data
38361 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
38362 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
38364 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
38365 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
38366 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
38367 information about the domains.
38371 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
38372 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
38373 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
38374 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
38375 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
38376 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
38377 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
38378 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
38379 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
38380 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
38381 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
38382 example, consider this router:
38387 file = $home/.forward
38388 local_part_suffix = -*
38389 local_part_suffix_optional
38392 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
38393 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
38394 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
38395 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
38397 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
38398 save /home/$local_part_data/Mail/special
38401 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
38402 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
38403 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
38404 control over which suffixes are valid.
38406 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
38407 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
38413 local_part_suffix = -*
38414 local_part_suffix_optional
38415 file = ${lookup {.forward$local_part_suffix} dsearch,ret=full {$home} {$value}fail}
38418 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
38419 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
38420 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
38421 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
38422 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
38426 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
38427 .cindex "vacation processing"
38428 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
38429 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
38430 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
38431 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
38432 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
38435 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
38436 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
38437 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
38438 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
38440 spqr, vacation-spqr
38443 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
38444 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
38445 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
38446 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
38447 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
38451 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
38452 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
38456 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
38457 .cindex "message" "copying every"
38458 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
38459 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
38460 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
38461 each day's messages.
38463 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
38464 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
38465 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
38466 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
38470 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
38471 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
38472 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
38473 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
38474 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
38475 permanently connected.
38477 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
38478 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
38479 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
38482 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
38483 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
38484 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
38485 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
38486 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
38487 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
38488 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
38489 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
38491 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
38492 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
38493 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
38494 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
38495 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
38496 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
38499 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
38500 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
38501 intermittent host. For example:
38503 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
38505 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
38506 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
38507 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
38508 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
38509 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
38510 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
38513 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
38514 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
38515 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
38516 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
38517 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
38518 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
38519 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
38523 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
38524 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
38525 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
38526 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
38527 delivered immediately.
38529 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
38530 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
38531 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
38532 .cindex "first pass routing"
38533 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
38534 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
38535 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
38536 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
38537 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
38538 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
38539 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
38540 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
38541 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
38542 single SMTP connection.
38546 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38549 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
38550 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
38551 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
38552 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
38553 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
38554 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
38555 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
38556 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
38557 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
38558 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
38561 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
38562 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
38563 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
38564 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
38565 email is not desirable.
38567 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
38568 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
38569 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
38570 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
38571 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
38572 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
38573 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
38575 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
38576 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
38577 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
38578 before sending a message to the smart host.
38580 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
38581 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
38582 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
38584 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
38585 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
38586 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
38587 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
38588 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
38589 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
38590 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
38592 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
38596 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
38597 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
38599 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
38600 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
38601 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
38602 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
38603 successful, a zero return code is given.
38605 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
38606 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
38607 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
38608 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
38609 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
38612 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
38613 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
38614 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
38616 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
38617 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
38618 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
38619 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
38620 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
38622 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
38623 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
38624 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
38626 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
38627 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
38628 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
38629 are ever generated.
38631 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
38633 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
38634 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
38635 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
38638 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
38639 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
38640 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
38641 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
38642 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
38643 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
38648 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38649 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38651 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
38652 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
38653 .cindex "log" "types of"
38654 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
38659 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
38660 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
38661 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
38662 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
38663 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
38664 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
38665 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
38666 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
38668 .cindex "reject log"
38669 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
38670 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
38671 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
38672 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
38673 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
38674 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
38675 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
38676 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
38677 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
38680 .cindex "panic log"
38681 .cindex "system log"
38682 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
38683 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
38684 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
38685 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
38686 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
38687 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
38688 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
38689 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
38690 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
38693 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
38694 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
38695 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
38697 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
38700 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
38701 ways of changing this:
38704 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
38709 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
38711 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
38714 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
38718 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
38719 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
38720 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
38721 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
38722 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
38723 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
38728 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
38729 .cindex "log" "destination"
38730 .cindex "log" "to file"
38731 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
38733 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
38734 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
38735 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
38736 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
38737 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
38738 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
38739 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
38741 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
38742 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
38743 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
38744 references to the host name:
38746 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
38748 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
38749 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
38750 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
38751 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
38752 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
38755 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
38756 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
38757 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
38758 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
38759 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
38760 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
38761 implying the use of a default path.
38763 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
38764 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
38765 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
38766 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. If no such item exists, log
38767 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
38768 equivalent to the configuration file setting:
38770 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
38772 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
38773 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
38774 that is where the logs are written.
38776 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
38777 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
38779 Here are some examples of possible Makefile settings:
38781 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
38782 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
38783 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
38784 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
38786 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
38791 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
38792 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38793 .cindex "cycling logs"
38794 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38795 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
38796 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
38797 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
38798 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
38799 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
38800 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
38802 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
38803 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
38804 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
38805 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
38806 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
38807 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
38808 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
38809 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
38810 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
38811 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
38812 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
38817 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
38818 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
38819 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
38820 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
38821 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
38822 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
38823 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
38824 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
38826 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
38827 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
38828 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
38829 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
38831 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
38832 examples of names generated by the above examples:
38834 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
38835 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
38836 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
38837 /var/log/exim/main.200212
38839 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
38840 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
38841 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
38842 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
38844 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
38845 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
38846 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
38847 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
38848 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
38849 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
38852 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
38853 /var/log/exim-panic.log
38854 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
38855 /var/log/exim/panic
38859 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
38860 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
38861 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
38862 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
38863 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
38864 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
38865 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
38866 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
38867 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
38868 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
38869 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
38870 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
38871 the time and host name to each line.
38872 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
38875 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
38877 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
38879 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
38882 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
38883 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
38884 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
38885 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
38887 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
38888 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
38889 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
38890 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
38891 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
38892 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
38893 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
38894 RFC 3164, you should set
38896 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
38898 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
38899 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
38901 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
38902 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
38903 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
38904 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
38905 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
38906 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
38907 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
38908 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
38909 name, and pid as added by syslog:
38911 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
38912 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
38913 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
38914 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
38917 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
38920 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
38921 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
38922 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
38923 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
38925 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
38926 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
38927 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
38928 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
38929 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
38930 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
38932 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
38933 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
38934 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
38937 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
38939 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
38940 without modification.
38942 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
38943 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
38944 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
38949 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
38950 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
38951 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
38952 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
38953 timestamp. The flags are:
38954 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
38955 .irow &%<=%& "message arrival"
38956 .irow &%(=%& "message fakereject"
38957 .irow &%=>%& "normal message delivery"
38958 .irow &%->%& "additional address in same delivery"
38959 .irow &%>>%& "cutthrough message delivery"
38960 .irow &%*>%& "delivery suppressed by &%-N%&"
38961 .irow &%**%& "delivery failed; address bounced"
38962 .irow &%==%& "delivery deferred; temporary problem"
38966 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
38967 .cindex "log" "reception line"
38968 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
38969 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
38970 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
38972 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
38973 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
38974 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
38976 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
38977 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
38978 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
38982 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
38986 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
38987 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
38988 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
38989 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
38990 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
38991 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
38992 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
38993 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
38994 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
38995 name in parentheses.
38997 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
38998 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
38999 the log containing text like these examples:
39001 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
39002 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
39004 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
39007 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
39008 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
39011 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
39012 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
39013 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
39014 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
39015 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
39016 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
39017 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
39018 suite that was used.
39020 .cindex log protocol
39021 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
39022 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
39023 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
39024 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
39025 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
39026 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
39027 authenticator name.
39029 .cindex "size" "of message"
39030 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
39031 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
39032 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
39033 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
39036 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
39037 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
39041 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
39042 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
39043 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
39044 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
39045 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
39046 to fit it on the page:
39048 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
39049 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
39050 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
39051 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
39052 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
39054 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
39055 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
39056 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
39057 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
39058 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
39060 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
39061 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
39062 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
39063 option, this is logged too, as a second colon-separated list item.
39064 Optionally (see the &%smtp_mailauth%& &%log_selector%&) there may be a third list item.
39066 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
39067 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
39069 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
39071 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
39072 parentheses afterwards.
39074 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
39075 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
39076 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
39077 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
39078 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the
39079 remote IP address (and port if enabled)
39080 in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
39081 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
39082 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
39083 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
39084 TLS cipher information is still available.
39086 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
39087 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
39088 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
39089 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
39090 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
39092 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
39093 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
39095 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
39096 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
39099 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
39100 .cindex "discarded messages"
39101 .cindex "message" "discarded"
39102 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
39103 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
39104 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
39106 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
39107 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
39109 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
39110 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
39112 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
39113 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
39117 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
39118 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
39120 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
39121 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
39123 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
39124 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
39125 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
39127 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
39128 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
39130 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
39131 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
39132 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
39136 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
39137 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
39138 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
39139 following form is logged:
39141 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
39142 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
39144 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
39145 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
39147 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
39148 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
39149 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
39150 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
39151 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
39153 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
39154 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
39155 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
39156 flagged with &`**`&.
39160 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
39161 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
39162 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
39163 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
39164 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
39168 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
39171 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
39173 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
39174 at the end of its processing.
39179 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
39180 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
39181 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
39182 the following table:
39184 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
39185 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
39186 &`Ci `& connection identifier
39187 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
39188 &`CV `& certificate verification status
39189 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
39190 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
39191 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
39192 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
39193 &`DT `& on &`=>`&, &'=='& and &'**'& lines: time taken for, or to attempt, a delivery
39194 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
39195 &`H `& host name and IP address
39196 &`I `& local interface used
39197 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
39198 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
39199 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
39200 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
39201 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
39202 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
39203 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
39204 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
39205 &`Q `& alternate queue name
39206 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
39207 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
39208 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
39209 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
39210 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
39211 &`S `& size of message in bytes
39212 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
39213 &`ST `& shadow transport name
39214 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
39215 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
39216 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
39217 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
39218 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
39222 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
39223 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
39224 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
39227 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
39228 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
39229 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
39230 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
39231 during the first delivery attempt.
39233 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
39234 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
39235 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
39237 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
39238 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
39239 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
39240 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
39241 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
39244 .cindex "error" "ignored"
39245 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
39248 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
39249 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
39251 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
39252 failed. The delivery was discarded.
39254 A delivery set up by a router configured with
39255 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
39256 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
39260 failed. The delivery was discarded.
39263 .cindex DKIM "log line"
39264 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
39265 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
39272 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
39273 .cindex "log" "selectors"
39274 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
39275 default logging to the main log, or you can request additional logging. The value of
39276 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
39279 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
39281 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
39282 selection marked by asterisks:
39283 .itable none 0 0 3 2.8in left 10pt center 3in left
39284 .irow &`8bitmime`& "received 8BITMIME status"
39285 .irow &`acl_warn_skipped`& * "skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL"
39286 .irow &`address_rewrite`& "address rewriting"
39287 .irow &`all_parents`& "all parents in => lines"
39288 .irow &`arguments`& "command line arguments"
39289 .irow &`connection_id`& "connection identifier"
39290 .irow &`connection_reject`& * "connection rejections"
39291 .irow &`delay_delivery`& * "immediate delivery delayed"
39292 .irow &`deliver_time`& "time taken to attempt delivery"
39293 .irow &`delivery_size`& "add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines"
39294 .irow &`dkim`& * "DKIM verified domain on <= lines"
39295 .irow &`dkim_verbose`& "separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature; DKIM signing"
39296 .irow &`dnslist_defer`& * "defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups"
39297 .irow &`dnssec`& "DNSSEC secured lookups"
39298 .irow &`etrn`& * "ETRN commands"
39299 .irow &`host_lookup_failed`& * "as it says"
39300 .irow &`ident_timeout`& "timeout for ident connection"
39301 .irow &`incoming_interface`& "local interface & port on <= and => lines"
39302 .irow &`incoming_port`& "remote port on <= lines"
39303 .irow &`lost_incoming_connection`& * "as it says (includes timeouts)"
39304 .irow &`millisec`& "millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times"
39305 .irow &`msg_id`& * "on <= lines, Message-ID: header value"
39306 .irow &`msg_id_created`& "on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added"
39307 .irow &`outgoing_interface`& "local interface on => lines"
39308 .irow &`outgoing_port`& "add remote port to => lines"
39309 .irow &`queue_run`& * "start and end queue runs"
39310 .irow &`queue_time`& "time on queue for one recipient"
39311 .irow &`queue_time_exclusive`& "exclude recieve time from QT times"
39312 .irow &`queue_time_overall`& "time on queue for whole message"
39313 .irow &`pid`& "Exim process id"
39314 .irow &`pipelining`& "PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines"
39315 .irow &`proxy`& "proxy address on <= and => lines"
39316 .irow &`receive_time`& "time taken to receive message"
39317 .irow &`received_recipients`& "recipients on <= lines"
39318 .irow &`received_sender`& "sender on <= lines"
39319 .irow &`rejected_header`& * "header contents on reject log"
39320 .irow &`retry_defer`& * "&<quote>&retry time not reached&</quote>&"
39321 .irow &`return_path_on_delivery`& "put return path on => and ** lines"
39322 .irow &`sender_on_delivery`& "add sender to => lines"
39323 .irow &`sender_verify_fail`& * "sender verification failures"
39324 .irow &`size_reject`& * "rejection because too big"
39325 .irow &`skip_delivery`& * "delivery skipped in a queue run"
39326 .irow &`smtp_confirmation`& * "SMTP confirmation on => lines"
39327 .irow &`smtp_connection`& "incoming SMTP connections"
39328 .irow &`smtp_incomplete_transaction`& "incomplete SMTP transactions"
39329 .irow &`smtp_mailauth`& "AUTH argument to MAIL commands"
39330 .irow &`smtp_no_mail`& "session with no MAIL commands"
39331 .irow &`smtp_protocol_error`& "SMTP protocol errors"
39332 .irow &`smtp_syntax_error`& "SMTP syntax errors"
39333 .irow &`subject`& "contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines"
39334 .irow &`tls_certificate_verified`& * "certificate verification status"
39335 .irow &`tls_cipher`& * "TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines"
39336 .irow &`tls_peerdn`& "TLS peer DN on <= and => lines"
39337 .irow &`tls_resumption`& "append * to cipher field"
39338 .irow &`tls_sni`& "TLS SNI on <= lines"
39339 .irow &`unknown_in_list`& "lookup failed in list match"
39340 .irow &`all`& "&*all of the above*&"
39342 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
39343 section &<<SECID99>>&
39345 More details on each of these items follows:
39349 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
39350 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
39351 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
39352 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
39353 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
39354 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
39356 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
39357 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
39358 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
39359 this log selector is set.
39361 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
39362 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
39363 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
39364 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
39365 such users cannot access the log).
39367 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
39368 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
39369 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
39370 parentheses between them.
39372 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
39373 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
39374 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
39375 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
39376 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
39377 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
39378 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
39379 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
39380 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
39381 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
39382 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
39383 between the caller and Exim.
39385 .cindex log "connection identifier"
39386 .cindex connection "identifier logging"
39387 &%connection_id%&: An identifier for the accepted connection is added to
39388 connection start and end lines and to message accept lines.
39389 The identifier is tagged by Ci=.
39390 The value is PID-based, so will reset on reboot and will wrap.
39392 .cindex log "connection rejections"
39393 .cindex connection "rejection logging"
39394 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
39395 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
39397 .cindex log "delayed delivery"
39398 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
39399 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
39400 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
39401 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
39402 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
39404 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
39405 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
39406 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
39407 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39408 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
39410 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
39411 .cindex "size" "of message"
39412 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
39413 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
39415 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
39416 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
39417 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
39418 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
39420 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
39421 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
39422 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
39423 Also, on message delivery lines signing information (domain and selector)
39424 is added, tagged with DKIM=.
39426 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
39427 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
39428 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
39429 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
39430 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
39433 .cindex dnssec logging
39434 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
39435 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
39436 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
39437 It does not cover helo-name verification.
39438 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
39440 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
39441 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
39442 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
39443 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
39444 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
39445 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
39447 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
39448 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
39449 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
39450 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
39451 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
39453 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
39454 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
39455 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
39456 client's ident port times out.
39458 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
39459 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
39460 .cindex "log" "local interface"
39461 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
39462 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
39463 .cindex "interface" "logging"
39464 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
39465 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
39466 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
39467 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
39468 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing
39469 &"=>"&, &"->"&, &"=="& and &"**"& lines.
39470 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
39472 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
39473 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
39474 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
39475 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
39476 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
39477 on a proxied connection
39478 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
39479 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
39481 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
39482 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
39483 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
39484 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
39485 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
39486 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
39487 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
39488 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
39489 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
39490 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
39491 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
39493 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
39494 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
39495 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
39497 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
39498 .cindex millisecond logging
39499 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
39500 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
39501 appended to the seconds value.
39503 .cindex "log" "message id"
39504 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
39506 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
39507 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
39508 (submission mode) without one.
39509 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
39511 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
39512 .cindex "log" "local interface"
39513 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
39514 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
39515 .cindex "interface" "logging"
39516 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
39517 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
39518 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
39519 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
39521 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
39522 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
39523 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
39524 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
39525 containing => tags) following the IP address.
39526 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
39527 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
39528 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
39529 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
39530 local port is a random ephemeral port.
39532 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
39533 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
39534 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
39535 immediately after the time and date.
39537 .cindex log pipelining
39538 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
39539 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
39540 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
39541 The field is a single "L".
39543 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
39544 the field has a minus appended.
39546 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
39547 If Exim is built without the DISABLE_PIPE_CONNECT build option
39548 accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
39549 offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
39550 Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
39553 .cindex "log" "queue run"
39554 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
39555 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
39557 .cindex "log" "queue time"
39558 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
39559 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
39561 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39562 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
39564 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
39565 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
39566 example, &`QT=3m45s`&.
39568 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
39569 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
39570 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
39571 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39572 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
39574 .cindex "log" "recipients"
39575 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
39576 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
39577 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
39578 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
39580 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
39583 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
39584 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
39585 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
39586 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
39588 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
39589 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
39590 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
39591 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
39592 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
39594 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
39595 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
39596 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
39597 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
39600 .cindex "log" "return path"
39601 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
39602 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
39603 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
39604 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
39606 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
39607 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
39608 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
39609 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
39610 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
39612 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
39613 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
39614 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
39615 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
39618 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
39619 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
39622 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
39623 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
39624 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
39625 queue run because it another process is already delivering it or because
39627 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
39628 .cindex "&""message is frozen""&"
39629 The message that is written is either &"spool file is locked"& or
39630 &"message is frozen"&.
39632 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
39633 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
39634 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
39635 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
39636 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
39637 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
39640 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
39641 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
39642 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
39643 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
39644 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
39645 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
39646 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
39647 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
39648 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
39649 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
39651 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
39652 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
39653 reset if the daemon is restarted.
39654 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
39655 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
39656 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
39657 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
39658 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
39660 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
39661 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
39662 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
39663 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
39664 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
39665 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
39667 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
39668 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
39669 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
39670 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
39671 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
39672 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
39673 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
39674 already have their own log lines.
39676 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
39677 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
39678 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
39679 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
39680 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
39681 the same logging options.
39683 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
39684 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
39688 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
39689 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
39690 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
39691 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
39692 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
39694 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
39695 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
39696 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
39697 was accepted or used.
39699 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
39700 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
39701 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
39702 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
39703 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
39704 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
39705 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
39706 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
39708 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
39709 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
39710 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
39711 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
39712 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
39713 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
39714 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
39715 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
39716 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
39718 .cindex "log" "subject"
39719 .cindex "subject, logging"
39720 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
39721 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
39722 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
39723 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
39724 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
39726 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
39728 .cindex DANE logging
39729 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
39730 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
39732 using a CA trust anchor,
39733 &`CV=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
39734 and &`CV=no`& if not.
39736 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
39737 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
39738 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39739 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
39741 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
39742 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
39743 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39744 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
39745 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
39747 .cindex "log" "TLS resumption"
39748 .cindex "TLS" "logging session resumption"
39749 &%tls_resumption%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39750 connection and the TLS session resumed one used on a previous TCP connection,
39751 an asterisk is appended to the X= cipher field in the log line.
39753 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
39754 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
39755 .cindex SNI logging
39756 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
39757 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
39758 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
39760 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
39761 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
39762 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed, or because
39763 a bad IP address was in the list.
39767 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
39768 .cindex "message" "log file for"
39769 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
39770 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
39771 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
39772 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
39773 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
39774 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
39775 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
39776 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
39777 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
39778 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
39779 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
39781 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
39782 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
39783 &%message_logs%& option false.
39789 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39790 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39792 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
39793 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
39794 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
39795 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
39796 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
39798 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
39799 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
39800 "list what Exim processes are doing"
39801 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
39802 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
39803 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
39804 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
39806 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
39807 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
39808 "extract statistics from the log"
39809 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
39810 "check address acceptance from given IP"
39811 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
39812 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
39813 .irow &<<SECTdumpdb>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
39814 .irow &<<SECTtidydb>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
39815 .irow &<<SECTfixdb>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
39816 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
39817 .irow &<<SECTexim_msgdate>>& &'exim_msgdate'& "Message Ids for humans (exim_msgdate)"
39820 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
39821 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
39822 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
39827 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
39828 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
39829 .cindex "process, querying"
39831 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
39832 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
39833 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
39834 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
39835 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
39836 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
39837 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
39838 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
39840 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
39841 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
39842 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
39845 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
39846 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
39847 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
39848 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
39849 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
39851 .itable none 0 0 2 30* left 70* left
39852 .irow &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD`& "the command for running &'ps'&"
39853 .irow &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG`& "the argument for &'ps'&"
39854 .irow &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG`& "the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output"
39855 .irow &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG`& "the argument for the &'kill'& command"
39857 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
39859 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
39860 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
39861 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
39862 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
39863 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
39864 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
39866 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
39867 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
39871 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
39872 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
39873 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
39874 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
39878 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
39882 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
39883 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
39886 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
39887 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
39888 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
39892 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
39893 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
39894 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
39896 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
39897 Match against the size field.
39899 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
39900 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
39902 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
39903 Match messages that are older than the given time.
39906 Match only frozen messages.
39909 Match only non-frozen messages.
39911 .vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
39912 Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
39915 The following options control the format of the output:
39919 Display only the count of matching messages.
39922 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
39926 Display message ids only.
39929 Brief format &-- one line per message.
39932 Display messages in reverse order.
39935 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
39938 The following options give alternates for configuration:
39941 .vitem &*-C*&&~<&'config&~file'&>
39942 is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
39943 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
39945 .vitem &*-E*&&~<&'path'&>
39946 can be used to specify a path for the exim binary,
39947 overriding the built-in one.
39950 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
39951 At least one selection option, or either the &*-c*& or &*-h*& option, must be given.
39955 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
39956 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
39957 .cindex "queue" "summary"
39958 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
39959 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
39960 running a command such as
39962 exim -bp | exiqsumm
39964 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
39965 it, as in the following example:
39967 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
39969 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
39970 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
39971 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
39972 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
39974 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
39975 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
39976 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
39977 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
39978 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
39979 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
39982 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
39983 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
39984 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
39985 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
39986 level"& addresses).
39991 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
39993 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
39994 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
39995 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
39996 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
39997 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
39998 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
39999 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
40000 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
40001 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
40002 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
40004 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
40006 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
40008 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
40009 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
40010 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
40012 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
40013 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
40014 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
40015 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
40016 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
40018 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
40019 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
40020 regular expression.
40022 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
40023 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
40025 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
40026 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
40030 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
40031 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
40032 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
40033 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
40034 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
40035 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
40038 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
40039 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
40040 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
40041 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
40042 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
40045 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
40046 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
40047 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
40048 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
40049 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
40050 the &%--help%& option.
40053 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
40054 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
40055 .cindex "cycling logs"
40056 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
40057 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
40058 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
40059 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
40060 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
40061 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
40062 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
40064 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
40065 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
40067 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
40068 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
40069 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
40073 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
40074 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
40075 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
40076 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
40077 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
40078 logs are handled similarly.
40080 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
40081 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
40082 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
40083 any existing log files.
40085 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
40086 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
40087 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
40088 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
40089 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
40091 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
40093 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
40094 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
40098 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
40099 .cindex "statistics"
40100 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
40101 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
40102 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
40103 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
40104 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
40106 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
40107 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
40108 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
40109 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
40110 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
40112 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
40114 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
40115 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
40116 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
40117 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
40118 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
40119 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
40120 also produced per user.
40122 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
40123 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
40124 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
40125 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
40126 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
40128 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
40129 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
40130 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
40131 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
40132 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
40133 an entirely separate message.
40135 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
40136 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
40137 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
40138 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
40139 least one address that failed.
40141 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
40142 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
40143 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
40144 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
40145 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
40146 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
40147 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
40149 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
40150 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
40151 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
40153 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
40154 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
40155 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
40157 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
40160 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
40161 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
40162 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
40163 .cindex "checking access"
40164 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
40165 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
40166 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
40167 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
40168 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
40169 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
40171 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
40172 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
40174 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
40176 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
40177 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
40178 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
40179 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
40182 550 Relay not permitted
40184 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
40185 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
40186 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
40187 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
40190 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
40191 -f himself@there.example
40193 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
40194 mandatory arguments.
40196 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
40197 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
40198 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
40202 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
40203 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
40204 .cindex "building DBM files"
40205 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
40206 .cindex "lower casing"
40207 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
40208 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
40209 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
40210 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
40211 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
40212 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
40214 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
40215 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
40216 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
40217 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
40220 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
40221 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
40222 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
40226 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
40227 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
40228 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
40229 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
40231 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
40233 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
40234 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
40236 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
40237 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
40238 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
40239 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
40240 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
40241 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
40243 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
40244 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
40245 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
40246 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
40247 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
40248 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
40249 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
40255 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
40256 .cindex "retry" "times"
40257 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
40258 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
40259 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
40260 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
40261 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
40262 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
40263 output. For example:
40265 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
40266 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
40267 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
40268 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
40269 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
40270 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
40271 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
40272 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
40273 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
40274 past final cutoff time
40276 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
40277 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
40278 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
40279 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
40280 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
40281 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
40284 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
40285 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
40286 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
40287 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
40288 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
40289 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
40293 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
40294 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
40295 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
40296 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
40297 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
40298 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
40299 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
40302 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
40304 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
40307 &'callout'&: the callout cache
40309 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
40311 &'tls'&: TLS session resumption data
40313 &'misc'&: other hints data
40316 The &'misc'& database is used for
40319 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
40320 &(smtp)& transport)
40322 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
40325 Recording EHLO-time facilities advertised by hosts
40327 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
40332 .subsection "exim_dumpdb" "SECTdumpdb"
40333 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
40334 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
40335 &'exim_dumpdb'& program,
40336 taking as arguments the spool and database names.
40337 An option &'-z'& may be given to request times in UTC;
40338 otherwise times are in the local timezone.
40339 An option &'-k'& may be given to dump only the record keys.
40340 For example, to dump the retry database:
40342 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
40344 For the retry database
40345 two lines of output are produced for each entry:
40347 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
40348 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
40350 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
40351 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
40352 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
40353 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
40354 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
40355 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
40356 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
40357 and a textual description of the error.
40359 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
40360 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
40361 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
40364 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
40365 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
40366 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
40367 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
40368 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
40369 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
40374 .subsection "exim_tidydb" "SECTtidydb"
40375 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
40376 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
40377 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
40378 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
40379 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
40380 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
40381 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
40382 updated sufficiently often.
40384 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
40385 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
40386 the retry database:
40388 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
40390 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
40391 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
40392 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
40393 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
40394 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
40395 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
40396 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
40397 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
40398 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
40399 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
40400 whenever it removes information from the database.
40402 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
40403 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
40404 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
40405 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
40406 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
40408 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
40409 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
40410 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
40411 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
40412 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
40413 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
40414 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
40417 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
40418 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
40423 .subsection "exim_fixdb" "SECTfixdb"
40424 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
40425 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
40426 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
40427 getting round problems in a live system. Its interface
40428 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
40429 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
40432 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
40433 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
40434 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
40435 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
40436 by new data, for example:
40440 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
40441 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
40442 used as optional separators.
40444 Both displayed and input times are in the local timezone by default.
40445 If an option &'-z'& is used on the command line, displayed times
40451 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
40452 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
40453 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
40454 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
40455 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
40456 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
40457 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
40458 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
40459 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
40460 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
40461 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
40462 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
40463 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
40467 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
40470 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
40473 .vitem &%-interval%&
40474 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
40475 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
40477 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
40478 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
40481 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
40484 Suppress verification output.
40486 .vitem &%-retries%&
40487 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
40488 the lock (default 10).
40490 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
40491 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
40492 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
40493 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
40496 .vitem &%-timeout%&
40497 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
40498 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
40499 default), a non-blocking call is used.
40502 Generate verbose output.
40505 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
40506 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
40507 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
40508 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
40509 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
40510 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
40511 more than 30 minutes old.
40513 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
40514 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
40515 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
40516 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
40517 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
40518 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
40520 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
40521 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
40522 suppresses all output except error messages.
40526 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
40528 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
40530 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
40531 <&'some commands'&>
40534 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
40535 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
40538 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
40539 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
40541 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
40542 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
40545 .section "Message Ids for humans (exim_msgdate)" "SECTexim_msgdate"
40546 .cindex "exim_msgdate"
40547 The &'exim_msgdate'& utility is written by Andrew Aitchison and included in the Exim distribution.
40548 This Perl script converts an Exim Mesage ID back into a human readable form.
40549 For details of &'exim_msgdate'&'s options, run &'exim_msgdate'& with the &%--help%& option.
40551 Section &<<SECTmessiden>>& (Message identification) describes Exim Mesage IDs.
40553 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40554 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40556 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
40557 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
40558 .cindex "X-windows"
40559 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
40560 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
40561 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
40562 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
40563 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
40564 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
40565 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
40566 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
40570 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
40571 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
40572 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
40573 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
40574 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
40575 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
40576 parameters are for.
40578 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
40579 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
40580 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
40582 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
40584 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
40585 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
40586 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
40587 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
40588 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
40590 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
40591 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
40593 Eximon*background: gray94
40595 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
40596 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
40597 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
40598 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
40599 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
40600 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
40601 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
40604 Eximon*highlight: gray
40607 .cindex "admin user"
40608 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
40609 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
40611 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
40612 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
40613 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
40614 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
40615 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
40617 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
40618 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
40619 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
40620 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
40621 different parts of the display.
40626 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
40627 .cindex "stripchart"
40628 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
40629 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
40630 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
40631 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
40632 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
40633 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
40634 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
40635 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
40636 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
40638 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
40639 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
40640 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
40641 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
40643 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
40644 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
40645 to a single partition.
40647 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
40648 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
40649 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
40650 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
40651 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
40652 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
40653 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
40658 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
40659 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
40660 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
40661 .cindex "window size"
40662 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
40663 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
40664 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
40665 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
40666 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
40667 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
40669 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
40670 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
40671 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
40672 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
40674 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
40675 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
40676 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
40677 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
40678 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
40679 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
40681 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
40682 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
40683 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
40687 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
40688 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
40689 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
40690 the main log is maintained.
40691 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
40692 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
40693 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
40694 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
40695 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
40697 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
40698 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
40699 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
40700 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
40701 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
40702 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
40703 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
40704 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
40705 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
40706 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
40707 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
40709 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
40710 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
40711 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
40712 It cannot go further back up the log.
40714 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
40715 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
40716 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
40717 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
40718 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
40719 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
40721 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
40722 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
40723 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
40724 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
40725 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
40726 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
40728 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
40729 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
40730 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
40731 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
40732 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
40733 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
40734 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
40735 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
40736 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
40741 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
40742 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
40743 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
40744 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
40745 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
40746 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
40747 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
40748 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
40749 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
40750 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
40752 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
40753 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
40754 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
40755 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
40756 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
40757 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
40758 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
40760 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
40761 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
40762 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
40763 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
40764 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
40765 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
40766 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
40768 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
40769 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
40770 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
40771 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
40773 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
40774 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
40775 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
40776 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
40777 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
40778 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
40779 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
40782 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
40783 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
40785 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
40786 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
40787 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
40788 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
40789 display is updated.
40793 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
40794 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
40795 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
40796 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
40797 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
40800 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
40801 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
40802 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
40803 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
40804 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
40806 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
40808 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
40812 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
40813 in a new text window.
40815 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
40816 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
40817 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
40819 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
40820 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
40821 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
40822 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
40824 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
40825 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
40826 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
40827 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
40828 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
40830 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
40831 that the message be frozen.
40833 .cindex "thawing messages"
40834 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
40835 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
40836 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
40837 that the message be thawed.
40839 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
40840 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
40841 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
40842 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
40844 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
40845 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
40848 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
40849 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
40850 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
40851 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
40852 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
40853 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
40854 which case no action is taken.
40856 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
40857 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
40858 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
40859 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
40860 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
40861 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
40862 case no action is taken.
40864 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
40865 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
40867 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
40868 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
40869 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
40870 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
40871 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
40872 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
40873 the address is qualified with that domain.
40876 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
40877 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
40878 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
40879 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
40880 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
40881 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
40882 if no output is generated.
40884 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
40885 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
40886 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
40887 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
40889 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
40890 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
40891 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
40898 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40899 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40901 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
40902 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
40903 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
40904 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
40906 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
40907 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
40908 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
40909 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
40910 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
40911 its security as compared with other MTAs.
40913 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
40914 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
40915 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
40916 as soon as possible.
40919 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
40920 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
40921 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
40922 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
40923 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
40924 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
40927 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
40928 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
40929 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
40930 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
40931 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
40932 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
40934 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
40935 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
40936 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
40937 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
40940 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
40941 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
40942 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
40943 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
40944 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
40945 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
40946 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
40947 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
40948 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
40952 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
40953 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
40954 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
40955 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
40956 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
40957 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
40958 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
40960 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
40963 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
40964 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
40965 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
40966 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
40967 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
40972 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
40974 .cindex "root privilege"
40975 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
40976 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
40977 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
40978 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
40979 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
40980 is required for two things:
40983 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
40984 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
40987 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
40988 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
40992 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
40993 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
40994 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
40995 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
40996 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
40997 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
40998 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
40999 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
41001 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
41002 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
41003 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
41005 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
41006 uid and gid in the following cases:
41011 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
41012 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
41013 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
41014 the calling process.
41015 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
41016 option may not be used at all.
41017 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
41018 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
41019 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
41024 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
41025 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
41028 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
41029 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
41030 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
41031 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
41032 testing address verification
41035 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
41038 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
41039 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
41042 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
41045 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
41046 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
41047 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
41048 will be used during message reception.
41050 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
41051 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
41053 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
41054 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
41055 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
41056 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
41057 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
41058 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
41059 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
41060 generating bounce and warning messages.
41062 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
41063 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
41064 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
41065 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
41067 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
41068 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
41074 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
41075 .cindex "privilege, running without"
41076 .cindex "unprivileged running"
41077 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
41078 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
41079 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
41080 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
41081 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
41082 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
41083 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
41087 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
41088 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
41089 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
41090 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
41092 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
41093 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
41094 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
41095 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
41096 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
41098 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
41099 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
41100 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
41103 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
41104 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
41105 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
41107 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
41108 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
41109 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
41110 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
41111 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
41112 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
41113 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
41114 address this problem at this time.
41116 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
41117 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
41118 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
41119 be used in the most straightforward way.
41121 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
41122 number of restrictions on what you can do:
41125 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
41126 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
41127 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
41128 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
41129 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
41131 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
41132 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
41134 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
41135 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
41136 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
41137 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
41139 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
41140 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
41143 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
41144 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
41145 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
41147 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
41148 owned by the Exim user.
41150 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
41151 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
41152 mailboxes need to be created manually.
41157 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
41158 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
41159 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
41160 gives more security at essentially no cost.
41162 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
41163 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
41168 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
41169 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
41170 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
41174 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
41175 .cindex "security" "local commands"
41176 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
41177 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
41178 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
41179 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
41180 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
41183 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
41184 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
41185 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
41186 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
41187 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
41189 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
41190 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
41191 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
41192 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
41193 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
41194 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
41195 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
41197 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
41198 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
41199 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
41201 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
41202 taint checking might apply to their usage.
41204 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
41205 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
41206 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
41208 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
41209 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
41210 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
41212 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
41213 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
41214 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
41215 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
41221 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
41222 .cindex "security" "data sources"
41223 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
41224 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
41225 .cindex "PCRE2" "security"
41226 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
41227 are some issues to be aware of:
41230 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
41232 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
41234 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
41235 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE2. Be aware of what
41236 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
41237 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
41238 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
41239 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
41242 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
41243 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
41244 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
41246 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
41247 expected to yield one result.
41253 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
41254 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
41255 .cindex "IP source routing"
41256 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
41257 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
41258 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
41259 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
41263 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
41264 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
41265 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
41270 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
41271 .cindex "trusted users"
41272 .cindex "admin user"
41273 .cindex "privileged user"
41274 .cindex "user" "trusted"
41275 .cindex "user" "admin"
41276 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
41277 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
41278 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
41279 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
41280 permit a remote host to be specified.
41283 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
41284 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
41285 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
41286 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
41287 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
41288 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
41290 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
41291 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
41292 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
41293 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
41294 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
41296 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
41297 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
41298 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
41299 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
41300 includes the contents of files on the spool.
41304 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
41305 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
41306 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
41307 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
41308 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
41309 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
41311 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
41312 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
41313 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
41314 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
41315 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
41316 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
41319 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
41320 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
41321 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
41322 This affects most of the checking options,
41323 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
41326 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
41327 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
41328 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
41329 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
41330 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
41331 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
41335 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
41336 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
41337 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
41338 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
41339 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
41344 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
41345 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
41346 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
41347 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
41352 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
41353 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
41354 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
41355 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
41356 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
41360 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
41361 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
41362 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
41366 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
41367 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
41368 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
41369 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
41370 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
41371 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
41372 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
41374 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
41375 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
41380 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
41381 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
41382 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
41383 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
41387 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
41388 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
41389 enough to hold the result.
41390 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
41395 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41396 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41398 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
41399 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
41400 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
41401 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
41402 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
41403 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
41404 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
41405 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
41406 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
41407 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
41408 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
41409 themselves are recoverable.
41411 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
41412 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
41413 and should not be used as such.
41415 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
41416 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
41417 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
41420 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
41421 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
41422 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
41423 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
41424 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
41426 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
41427 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
41428 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
41429 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
41431 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
41433 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
41436 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
41438 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
41439 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
41440 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
41441 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
41442 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
41443 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
41444 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
41445 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
41448 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
41449 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
41450 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
41451 relics of crashes and can be removed.
41453 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
41454 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
41455 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
41456 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
41457 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
41458 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
41459 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
41460 normally the Exim user.
41462 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
41463 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
41464 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
41465 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
41466 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
41467 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
41468 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
41469 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
41471 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
41472 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
41473 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
41474 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
41476 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen.
41477 These contain variables, can appear in any
41478 order, and are omitted when not relevant.
41480 If there is a second hyphen after the first,
41481 the corresponding data is tainted.
41482 If there is a value in parentheses, the data is quoted for a lookup.
41484 The following word specifies a variable,
41485 and the remainder of the item depends on the variable.
41488 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41489 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
41490 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
41491 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
41492 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
41493 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
41494 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
41495 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
41496 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
41499 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41500 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
41501 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
41502 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
41503 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
41504 character. It may contain internal newlines.
41506 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41507 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
41508 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
41509 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
41510 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
41511 character. It may contain internal newlines.
41513 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
41514 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
41515 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
41517 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
41518 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
41519 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
41520 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
41521 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
41523 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
41524 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
41525 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
41526 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
41527 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
41529 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
41530 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
41531 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
41533 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
41534 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
41535 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
41537 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
41538 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
41539 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
41541 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
41542 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
41543 present if the number is greater than zero.
41545 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
41546 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
41547 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
41549 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
41550 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
41551 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
41553 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
41554 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
41557 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
41558 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
41559 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
41562 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
41563 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
41564 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
41565 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
41567 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
41568 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
41569 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
41571 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
41572 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
41573 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
41574 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
41575 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
41576 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
41578 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
41579 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
41580 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
41581 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
41582 supplied by the remote host, if any.
41584 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
41585 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
41586 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
41587 generated messages.
41590 The message is from a local sender.
41592 .vitem &%-localerror%&
41593 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
41595 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
41596 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
41597 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
41598 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
41600 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
41601 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
41602 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
41605 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
41606 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
41609 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
41610 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
41611 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
41613 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
41614 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
41615 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
41617 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
41618 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
41619 of &$spam_score_int$&.
41621 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
41622 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
41623 rather than Unix-format.
41624 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
41625 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
41627 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
41628 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
41629 certificate was verified by the server.
41631 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
41632 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
41633 name of the cipher suite that was used.
41635 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
41636 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
41637 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
41641 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
41642 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
41643 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
41644 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
41645 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
41646 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
41647 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
41648 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
41649 addresses are complete.
41651 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
41652 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
41653 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
41654 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
41655 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
41656 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
41658 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
41659 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
41660 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41662 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
41663 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
41664 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
41665 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
41669 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41670 darcy@austen.fict.example
41672 alice@wonderland.fict.example
41674 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
41675 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
41676 line is of the following form:
41678 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
41679 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
41681 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
41682 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
41683 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
41684 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
41685 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
41686 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
41687 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
41688 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
41691 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
41692 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
41693 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
41694 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
41695 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
41699 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
41700 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
41701 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
41702 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
41703 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
41704 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
41705 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
41706 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
41707 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
41708 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
41711 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
41712 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
41713 typical set of headers:
41715 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
41716 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
41717 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
41718 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
41719 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
41720 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
41721 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
41722 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41723 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
41724 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41725 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
41727 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
41728 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
41729 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
41730 .ecindex IIDforspo1
41731 .ecindex IIDforspo2
41732 .ecindex IIDforspo3
41734 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
41735 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
41736 an ASCII newline character.
41737 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
41738 can have an alternate format.
41739 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
41740 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
41741 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
41742 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
41743 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
41744 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
41746 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41747 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41749 .chapter "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
41750 "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC Support"
41752 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
41755 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
41756 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
41757 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
41758 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
41760 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
41761 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
41762 any original DKIM signature.
41764 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
41765 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41767 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
41769 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
41770 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
41771 (including transport filters) except cutthrough delivery.
41772 However, signing options may not depend on headers modified by
41773 routers, the transport or a transport filter.
41775 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
41776 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
41777 different signature contexts.
41780 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
41781 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
41782 Exim's standard controls.
41784 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
41785 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
41787 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
41788 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
41789 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
41790 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
41792 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
41793 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
41794 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
41795 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
41798 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
41799 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
41800 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
41801 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
41805 .subsection "Signing outgoing messages" SECDKIMSIGN
41806 .cindex DKIM signing
41808 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
41809 Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
41811 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
41813 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
41814 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
41817 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
41818 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
41819 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
41820 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
41821 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
41823 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
41824 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
41826 .option dkim_domain smtp "string list&!!" unset
41827 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
41828 After expansion, this can be a list.
41829 Each element in turn,
41831 .vindex "&$dkim_domain$&"
41832 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
41833 while expanding the remaining signing options.
41834 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
41835 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
41837 .option dkim_selector smtp "string list&!!" unset
41838 This sets the key selector string.
41839 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
41840 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
41841 .vindex "&$dkim_selector$&"
41842 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
41843 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
41844 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
41845 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
41847 To do, for example, dual-signing with RSA and EC keys
41848 this could be be used:
41850 dkim_selector = ec_sel : rsa_sel
41851 dkim_private_key = KEYS_DIR/$dkim_selector
41854 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
41855 This sets the private key to use.
41856 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
41857 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
41858 The result can either
41860 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
41862 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
41863 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
41865 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
41868 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
41869 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
41873 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
41875 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
41876 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
41878 The result file from the first command should be retained, and
41879 this option set to use it.
41880 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
41881 for the DNS TXT record.
41882 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
41886 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
41887 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
41890 Note that RFC 8301 says:
41892 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
41893 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
41896 EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
41897 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
41898 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
41899 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
41900 for some transition period.
41901 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
41904 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
41906 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
41907 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
41910 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
41912 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
41913 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
41916 Exim also supports an alternate format
41917 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
41918 of the standard, but not adopted.
41919 A future release will probably drop that support.
41921 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
41922 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
41924 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
41926 &`sha256`& &-- the default
41928 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
41931 Note that RFC 8301 says:
41933 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
41936 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
41937 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
41938 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
41939 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
41940 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
41941 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
41943 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
41944 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
41945 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
41946 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
41947 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
41949 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
41950 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
41951 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
41952 either &"1"& or &"true"&, Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
41953 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
41956 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
41957 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
41958 list of header names.
41959 Headers with these names, or the absence of such a header, will be included
41960 in the message signature.
41961 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
41962 whether or not each header is present in the message.
41963 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
41964 &"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS"&
41965 and an oversigning variant is in &"_DKIM_OVERSIGN_HEADERS"&.
41967 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
41968 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
41969 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
41971 A name can be prefixed with either an &"="& or a &"+"& character.
41972 If an &"="& prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
41974 If a &"+"& prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
41975 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
41976 name will be appended.
41978 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
41979 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
41980 If not set, no such information will be included.
41981 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the
41982 current time for the expiry tag (e.g. 1209600 for two weeks); both creation
41983 (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included unless the offset is 0 (no expiry).
41985 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
41988 .subsection "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" SECDKIMVFY
41989 .cindex DKIM verification
41991 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
41992 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
41994 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
41995 Individual classes of DKIM signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
41996 the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
41997 The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
41998 processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
42000 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
42001 Performing verification sets up information used by the
42002 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42004 For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
42005 of this section can be ignored.
42007 The results of verification are made available to the
42008 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which (for complex needs) can examine and modify them.
42009 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
42010 By default, the ACL is called once for each
42011 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
42012 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
42013 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
42014 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
42016 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
42017 a large number of expansion variables
42018 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
42019 runtime of the ACL.
42021 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
42022 more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
42023 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
42024 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
42026 The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
42027 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
42028 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
42029 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
42030 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
42031 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
42034 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
42036 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
42037 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
42038 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
42040 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
42042 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
42043 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
42044 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
42046 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
42049 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
42050 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
42052 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
42053 (such as the From: header)
42054 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
42055 and for the domain part if identities.
42056 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
42058 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
42059 for each matching signature.
42062 Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
42063 available (from most to least important):
42067 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
42068 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
42069 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
42070 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
42072 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
42073 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined
42074 (it need do no more than accept, which is the default),
42075 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
42076 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
42077 The value is maintained for the MIME, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
42079 Within the DKIM ACL,
42080 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
42082 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
42083 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42085 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
42086 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
42088 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
42089 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
42091 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
42094 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
42095 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
42096 hash-method or key-size:
42098 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
42099 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
42100 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
42101 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
42102 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
42103 set dkim_verify_status = fail
42104 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
42107 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
42108 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
42109 "fail" or "invalid". One of
42111 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
42112 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
42114 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
42115 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
42117 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
42118 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
42119 means that the message body was modified in transit.
42121 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
42122 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
42123 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
42124 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
42127 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
42129 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
42130 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
42131 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
42132 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42134 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
42135 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
42136 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
42137 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42139 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
42140 The key record selector string.
42142 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
42143 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
42144 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
42145 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
42146 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
42149 Note that RFC 8301 says:
42151 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
42153 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
42154 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
42157 To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
42158 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
42159 or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
42160 processing of such signatures.
42162 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
42163 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
42165 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
42166 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
42168 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
42169 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
42170 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
42171 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
42172 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
42173 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
42175 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
42176 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
42177 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
42178 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
42179 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
42180 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
42181 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
42182 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
42184 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
42185 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
42186 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
42188 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
42189 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
42190 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
42191 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
42192 integer size comparisons against this value.
42193 Note that Exim does not check this value.
42195 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
42196 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
42198 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
42199 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
42201 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
42202 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
42204 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
42205 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
42208 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
42209 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
42212 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
42213 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
42215 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
42216 Number of bits in the key.
42217 Valid only once the key is loaded, which is at the time the header signature
42218 is verified, which is after the body hash is.
42220 Note that RFC 8301 says:
42222 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
42223 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
42226 This is enforced by the default setting for the &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%&
42231 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
42234 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
42235 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
42236 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
42237 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42238 This condition is only usable in a DKIM ACL.
42239 This is typically used to restrict an ACL
42240 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
42243 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
42244 warn sender_domains = gmail.com
42245 dkim_signers = gmail.com
42247 log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
42250 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
42251 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
42253 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
42254 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
42255 results against the actual result of verification,
42256 given by &$dkim_verify_status$& if that is non-empty or "none" if empty.
42257 This condition may be used in DKIM, MIME, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
42259 A basic verification might be:
42261 deny !dkim_status = pass:none:invalid
42264 A more complex use could be
42265 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
42268 deny sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
42269 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
42270 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
42271 message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
42274 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
42275 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
42276 for more information of what they mean.
42278 The condition is true if the status
42279 (or any of the list of status values)
42280 is any one of the supplied list.
42286 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
42287 .cindex SPF verification
42289 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
42290 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
42291 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
42292 the &url(http://openspf.org).
42293 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
42294 . --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
42295 . --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
42298 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
42299 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
42301 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
42302 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
42303 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
42304 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
42305 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
42307 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
42308 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
42309 Performing verification sets up information used by the
42310 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42313 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
42314 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
42315 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
42316 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
42317 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
42321 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
42324 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
42325 domain in the envelope-from address.
42327 .vitem &%softfail%&
42328 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
42332 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
42335 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
42336 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
42337 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
42339 .vitem &%permerror%&
42340 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
42341 You may deny messages when this occurs.
42343 .vitem &%temperror%&
42344 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
42345 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
42348 There was an error during processing of the SPF lookup
42351 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
42352 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
42353 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
42354 short-circuit fashion.
42359 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
42360 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
42361 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
42362 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why;\
42363 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
42364 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
42365 ip=$sender_host_address
42368 Note: The above mentioned URL may not be as helpful as expected. You are
42369 encouraged to replace the link with a link to a site with more
42372 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
42375 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
42377 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
42378 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
42379 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
42380 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
42381 it for logging purposes.
42383 .vitem &$spf_received$&
42384 .vindex &$spf_received$&
42385 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header (name and
42386 content) that can be added to the message. Please note that
42387 according to the SPF draft, this header must be added at the
42388 top of the header list, i.e. with
42390 add_header = :at_start:$spf_received
42392 See section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>& for further details.
42394 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
42395 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
42397 .vitem &$spf_result$&
42398 .vindex &$spf_result$&
42399 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
42400 currently one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror,
42401 temperror, or &"(invalid)"&.
42403 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
42404 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
42405 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
42406 and required in order to obtain a result.
42408 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
42409 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
42410 .vindex &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&
42411 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
42412 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
42413 The string is generated by the SPF library from the template configured in the main config
42414 option &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&.
42418 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
42419 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
42420 .cindex SPF "best guess"
42421 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
42422 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
42423 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
42425 Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
42426 for a description of what it means.
42427 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
42429 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
42430 of the spf one. For example:
42433 deny spf_guess = fail
42434 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
42437 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
42438 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
42439 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
42442 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
42443 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
42445 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
42446 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
42447 &%spf_guess%& option.
42448 For example, the following:
42451 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
42454 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
42457 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
42459 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
42460 address as the key and an IP address
42465 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
42468 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
42469 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
42475 .subsection "SRS (Sender Rewriting Scheme)" SECTSRS
42476 .cindex SRS "sender rewriting scheme"
42477 .cindex VERP "variable envelope return path"
42479 SRS can be used to modify sender addresses when forwarding so that
42480 SPF verification does not object to them.
42481 It can also be used to identify a received bounce message as
42482 likely (or not) having been trigged by a message from the
42483 local system, and for identifying dead addresses in mailing lists.
42484 It is one implementation of a VERP (Variable Envelope Return Path) method.
42486 SRS operates by encoding the original envelope sender in a new
42487 sender local part and using a domain run by the forwarding site
42488 as the new domain for the sender. Any DSN message should be returned
42489 to this new sender at the forwarding site, which can extract the
42490 original sender from the coded local part and forward the DSN to
42493 This is a way of avoiding the breakage that SPF does to forwarding.
42494 The constructed local-part will be longer than the original,
42495 leading to possible problems with very long addresses.
42496 The changing of the sender address also hinders the tracing of mail
42499 Exim can be built to include native SRS support. To do this
42500 SUPPORT_SRS=yes must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&.
42501 If this has been done, the macros _HAVE_SRS and _HAVE_NATIVE_SRS
42503 The support is limited to SRS0-encoding; SRS1 is not supported.
42505 .cindex SRS excoding
42506 To encode an address use this expansion item:
42508 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
42509 .cindex "&%srs_encode%& expansion item"
42510 .cindex SRS "expansion item"
42511 The first argument should be a secret known and used by all systems
42512 handling the recipient domain for the original message.
42513 There is no need to periodically change this key; a timestamp is also
42515 The second argument should be given as the envelope sender address before this
42516 encoding operation.
42517 If this value is empty the the expansion result will be empty.
42518 The third argument should be the recipient domain of the message when
42519 it arrived at this system.
42520 All arguments are expanded before use.
42522 The result of the expansion is the replacement envelope-from (return path)
42526 .cindex SRS decoding
42527 To decode an address use this expansion condition:
42529 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
42530 The first argument should be the recipient local part as it was received.
42531 The second argument is the site secret.
42532 Both arguments are expanded before use.
42534 If the messages is not for an SRS-encoded recipient the condition will
42536 If it is, the condition will return true and the variable
42537 &$srs_recipient$& will be set to the decoded (original) value.
42539 If the second argument is empty then the condition returns true if
42540 the first argument is in valid SRS formet, else false.
42541 The variable &$srs_recipient$& is not set for this case.
42547 SRS_SECRET = <pick something unique for your site for this. Use on all MXs.>
42553 # if outbound, and forwarding has been done, use an alternate transport
42554 domains = ! +my_domains
42555 transport = ${if eq {$local_part@$domain} \
42556 {$original_local_part@$original_domain} \
42557 {remote_smtp} {remote_forwarded_smtp}}
42562 domains = +my_domains
42563 # detect inbound bounces which are SRS'd, and decode them
42564 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {SRS_SECRET}}
42565 data = $srs_recipient
42567 inbound_srs_failure:
42570 domains = +my_domains
42571 # detect inbound bounces which look SRS'd but are invalid
42572 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {}}
42574 data = :fail: Invalid SRS recipient address
42576 #... further routers here get inbound_srs-redirected recipients
42577 # and any that were not SRS'd
42580 # transport; should look like the non-forward outbound
42581 # one, plus the max_rcpt and return_path options
42582 remote_forwarded_smtp:
42584 # single-recipient so that $original_domain is valid
42586 # modify the envelope from, for mails that we forward
42587 return_path = ${srs_encode {SRS_SECRET} {$return_path} {$original_domain}}
42594 .section DMARC SECDMARC
42595 .cindex DMARC verification
42597 DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
42598 to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
42599 email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
42600 should read and understand how it works by visiting the website at
42601 &url(http://www.dmarc.org/).
42603 If Exim is built with DMARC support,
42604 the libopendmarc library is used.
42606 For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
42607 &url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/)
42608 to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite package
42609 repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
42610 SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
42611 This description assumes
42612 that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
42613 are in /usr/local/lib.
42615 .subsection Configuration SSECDMARCCONFIG
42616 .cindex DMARC configuration
42618 There are three main-configuration options:
42619 .cindex DMARC "configuration options"
42621 The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
42622 .oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
42623 defines the location of a text file of valid
42624 top level domains the opendmarc library uses
42625 during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
42626 the most current version can be downloaded
42627 from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat).
42628 See also the util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
42629 The default for the option is unset.
42630 If not set, DMARC processing is disabled.
42633 The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
42634 .oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
42635 defines the location of a file to log results
42636 of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
42637 contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
42638 which will manage the data, send out DMARC
42639 reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
42640 directory of this file is writable by the user
42642 The default is unset.
42644 The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
42645 .oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
42646 defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
42647 forensic report detailing alignment failures
42648 if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
42649 and you have configured Exim to send them.
42650 If set, this is expanded and used for the
42651 From: header line; the address is extracted
42652 from it and used for the envelope from.
42653 If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
42654 the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
42657 .subsection Controls SSECDMARCCONTROLS
42658 .cindex DMARC controls
42660 By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
42661 non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
42662 status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
42663 use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
42664 DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
42665 DMARC with an ACL control modifier:
42667 control = dmarc_disable_verify
42669 A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
42670 exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
42671 Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
42672 results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
42673 be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
42674 reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
42675 forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
42676 exim will send these forensic emails. It is also advised that you
42677 configure a &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& because the default sender address
42678 construction might be inadequate.
42680 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
42682 (AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
42683 not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
42684 your exim config. If you don't tell exim to send them, it will not
42687 There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
42690 .subsection ACL SSECDMARCACL
42691 .cindex DMARC "ACL condition"
42693 DMARC checks can be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
42694 &"dmarc_status"& ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
42695 call the &"spf"& condition first in the ACLs, then the &"dmarc_status"&
42696 condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
42697 for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
42698 up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
42699 occurs until a &"dmarc_status"& condition is encountered in the ACLs.
42701 The &"dmarc_status"& condition takes a list of strings on its
42702 right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
42703 on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
42704 mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
42705 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
42706 .irow &'accept'& "The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email"
42707 .irow &'reject'& "The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email"
42708 .irow &'quarantine'& "The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection"
42709 .irow &'none'& "The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral"
42710 .irow &'norecord'& "No policy section in the DMARC record for this RFC5322.From field"
42711 .irow &'nofrom'& "Unable to determine the domain of the sender"
42712 .irow &'temperror'& "Library error or dns error"
42713 .irow &'off'& "The DMARC check was disabled for this email"
42715 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
42716 meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
42717 "accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
42718 short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
42719 DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
42720 strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
42723 Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
42724 supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
42725 result is a list of colon-separated strings.
42727 Performing the check sets up information used by the
42728 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42730 Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
42731 processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
42732 expansion variables are available:
42735 .vitem &$dmarc_status$&
42736 .vindex &$dmarc_status$&
42737 .cindex DMARC result
42738 A one word status indicating what the DMARC library
42739 thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
42740 DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
42741 (if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
42742 in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
42744 .vitem &$dmarc_status_text$&
42745 .vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
42746 Slightly longer, human readable status.
42748 .vitem &$dmarc_used_domain$&
42749 .vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
42750 The domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
42752 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
42753 .vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
42754 The policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
42755 are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
42756 is any error, including no DMARC record.
42759 .subsection Logging SSECDMARCLOGGING
42760 .cindex DMARC logging
42762 By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
42763 non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
42764 create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
42765 you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
42766 DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
42767 than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
42768 processing or failure delivery issues).
42770 In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
42771 tools, you need to:
42773 Configure the global option &%dmarc_history_file%&
42775 Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
42776 import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
42779 In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
42781 Configure the global option &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
42783 Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
42784 enable sending DMARC forensic reports
42787 .subsection Example SSECDMARCEXAMPLE
42788 .cindex DMARC example
42793 warn domains = +local_domains
42794 hosts = +local_hosts
42795 control = dmarc_disable_verify
42797 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
42798 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
42800 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
42801 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
42804 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
42806 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
42808 warn dmarc_status = !accept
42810 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
42812 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
42814 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
42815 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
42817 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
42818 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
42819 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
42821 deny dmarc_status = reject
42823 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
42825 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
42832 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42833 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42835 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
42837 .cindex "proxy support"
42838 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
42840 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
42841 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
42844 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
42845 .cindex proxy inbound
42846 .cindex proxy "server side"
42847 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
42848 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
42850 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
42851 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
42852 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
42855 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
42856 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
42858 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
42859 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
42860 to distribute load.
42861 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
42862 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
42863 There is no logging if a host passes or
42864 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
42865 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
42867 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
42868 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
42869 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
42870 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
42871 automatically determines which version is in use.
42873 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
42874 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
42875 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
42876 Exim and the proxy server. The Proxy Protocol header must be received
42877 within &%proxy_protocol_timeout%&, which defaults to 3s.
42879 The following expansion variables are usable
42880 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
42882 .itable none 0 0 2 30* left 70* left
42883 .irow $proxy_external_address "IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy"
42884 .irow $proxy_external_port "Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy"
42885 .irow $proxy_local_address "IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy"
42886 .irow $proxy_local_port "Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy"
42887 .irow $proxy_session "boolean: SMTP connection via proxy"
42889 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
42890 there was a protocol error.
42891 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
42892 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
42894 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
42895 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
42896 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
42897 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
42898 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
42899 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
42900 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
42901 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
42902 A possible solution is:
42904 # Set max number of connections per host
42906 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
42907 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
42909 defer ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
42910 message = Too many connections from this IP right now
42915 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
42916 .cindex proxy outbound
42917 .cindex proxy "client side"
42918 .cindex proxy SOCKS
42919 .cindex SOCKS proxy
42920 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
42921 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
42922 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
42925 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
42926 on an smtp transport.
42927 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
42928 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
42929 Each proxy specifier is a list
42930 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
42931 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
42933 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
42934 The list of options is in the following table:
42935 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
42936 .irow &'auth'& "authentication method"
42937 .irow &'name'& "authentication username"
42938 .irow &'pass'& "authentication password"
42939 .irow &'port'& "tcp port"
42940 .irow &'tmo'& "connection timeout"
42941 .irow &'pri'& "priority"
42942 .irow &'weight'& "selection bias"
42945 More details on each of these options follows:
42948 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
42949 .cindex proxy authentication
42950 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
42951 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
42952 for access to the proxy.
42953 Default is &"none"&.
42955 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
42958 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
42961 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
42964 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
42967 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
42968 higher values being tried first.
42969 The default priority is 1.
42971 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
42972 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
42973 weighted by this value.
42974 The default value for selection bias is 1.
42977 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
42978 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
42979 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
42981 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
42982 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
42983 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
42984 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
42986 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42987 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42989 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
42990 "Internationalisation""
42991 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
42994 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
42996 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
42997 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
42998 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
43000 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
43001 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
43002 requirement, upon libidn2.
43004 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
43005 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
43006 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
43007 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
43008 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
43009 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
43010 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
43012 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
43013 international handling for the message is enabled and
43014 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
43016 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
43017 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
43018 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
43019 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
43021 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
43022 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
43023 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
43024 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
43026 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
43027 components expanded to a-label form,
43028 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
43031 .cindex log protocol
43032 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
43033 .cindex i18n logging
43034 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
43035 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
43037 The following expansion operators can be used:
43039 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
43040 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
43041 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
43042 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
43045 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
43046 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
43048 may use the following modifier:
43050 control = utf8_downconvert
43051 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
43053 This sets a flag requiring that envelope addresses are converted to
43054 a-label form before smtp delivery.
43055 This is usually for use in a Message Submission Agent context,
43056 but could be used for any message.
43058 If a value is appended it may be:
43059 .itable none 0 0 2 5* right 95* left
43060 .irow &`1`& "mandatory downconversion"
43061 .irow &`0`& "no downconversion"
43062 .irow &`-1`& "if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host"
43064 If no value is given, 1 is used.
43066 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
43067 is initially set to -1.
43069 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
43070 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
43071 or an empty string.
43072 If non-empty it overrides value previously set
43073 (due to mua_wrapper or by an ACL control).
43076 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
43077 Configurations supporting these should inspect
43078 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
43080 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
43081 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
43082 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
43084 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
43085 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
43089 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
43090 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
43091 the following expansion operator can be used:
43093 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
43096 The string is converted from the charset specified by
43097 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
43098 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
43100 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
43101 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
43102 (which has to be a single character)
43103 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
43104 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
43106 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
43107 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
43109 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
43110 by many other IMAP servers.
43114 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
43115 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
43116 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
43119 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
43120 must be representable in UTF-16.
43123 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43124 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43126 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
43130 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
43131 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
43132 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
43133 processing actions.
43135 Most installations will never need to use Events.
43136 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
43137 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
43139 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
43140 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
43141 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
43143 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
43144 An example might look like:
43145 .cindex logging custom
43147 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
43148 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
43149 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
43150 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
43151 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
43152 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
43153 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
43154 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
43155 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
43159 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
43160 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
43161 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
43164 The current list of events is:
43165 .itable all 0 0 4 25* left 10* center 15* center 50* left
43166 .row auth:fail after both "per driver per authentication attempt"
43167 .row dane:fail after transport "per connection"
43168 .row dns:fail after both "per lookup"
43169 .row msg:complete after main "per message"
43170 .row msg:defer after transport "per message per delivery try"
43171 .row msg:delivery after transport "per recipient"
43172 .row msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport "per recipient per host"
43173 .row msg:rcpt:defer after transport "per recipient"
43174 .row msg:host:defer after transport "per host per delivery try; host errors"
43175 .row msg:fail:delivery after transport "per recipient"
43176 .row msg:fail:internal after main "per recipient"
43177 .row tcp:connect before transport "per connection"
43178 .row tcp:close after transport "per connection"
43179 .row tls:cert before both "per certificate in verification chain"
43180 .row tls:fail:connect after main "per connection"
43181 .row smtp:connect after transport "per connection"
43182 .row smtp:ehlo after transport "per connection"
43183 .row smtp:fail:protocol after main "per connection"
43184 .row smtp:fail:syntax after main "per connection"
43187 New event types may be added in future.
43189 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
43190 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
43191 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
43193 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
43194 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
43195 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
43197 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
43198 should define the event action.
43200 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
43201 with the event type:
43203 .itable all 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
43204 .row auth:fail "smtp response"
43205 .row dane:fail "failure reason"
43206 .row dns:fail "failure reason, key and lookup-type"
43207 .row msg:defer "error string"
43208 .row msg:delivery "smtp confirmation message"
43209 .row msg:fail:internal "failure reason"
43210 .row msg:fail:delivery "smtp error message"
43211 .row msg:host:defer "error string"
43212 .row msg:rcpt:host:defer "error string"
43213 .row msg:rcpt:defer "error string"
43214 .row tls:cert "verification chain depth"
43215 .row tls:fail:connect "error string"
43216 .row smtp:connect "smtp banner"
43217 .row smtp:ehlo "smtp ehlo response"
43218 .row smtp:fail:protocol "error string"
43219 .row smtp:fail:syntax "error string"
43223 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
43225 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&,
43226 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
43227 the course of its processing:
43229 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
43232 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
43233 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
43235 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
43236 a useful way of writing to the main log.
43238 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
43239 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
43240 following will be forced:
43241 .itable all 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
43242 .row auth:fail "log information to write"
43243 .row tcp:connect "do not connect"
43244 .row tls:cert "refuse verification"
43245 .row smtp:connect "close connection"
43247 All other message types ignore the result string, and
43248 no other use is made of it.
43250 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
43251 then the &$host_address$& and &$host_port$& variables
43252 will be that of the proxy and not the target system.
43254 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
43255 chain element received on the connection.
43256 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
43259 For dns:fail events from dnsdb lookups, a &"defer_never"& option does not
43260 affect the reporting of DNS_AGAIN.
43262 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43263 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43265 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
43266 "Adding drivers or lookups"
43267 .cindex "adding drivers"
43268 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
43269 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
43270 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
43271 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
43274 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
43275 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
43277 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
43279 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
43281 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
43282 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
43283 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
43285 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
43287 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
43290 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
43291 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
43293 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
43294 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
43295 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
43296 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
43297 simple form that most lookups have.
43299 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
43300 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
43301 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
43303 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
43304 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
43306 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
43309 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
43310 as for other drivers and lookups.
43313 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
43314 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
43315 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
43316 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
43317 searched using a binary chop procedure.
43319 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
43320 the interface that is expected.
43325 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43326 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43328 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43329 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
43330 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
43331 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
43333 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43338 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
43339 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
43343 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
43344 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
43345 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
43348 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43349 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////